ENGLISH
14.5 mm
2010
SERVICE STATION INFORMATION
Fuel recommendation:
See page 1-1
Brake and clutch fluid:
DOT3
Engine oil recommendation:
Engine oil with “Starburst” symbol
Automatic transmission fluid:
SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309
For further details, see “Engine Oil and Filter” in the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
Tire cold pressure:
See the “Tire Information Label” located on the
driver’s door lock pillar.
Suzuki Red: Magenta 100%, Yellow 100%
Suzuki Blue: Cyan 100%, Magenta 70%
takumi Blue: Cyan 100%, Black 85%
Black
! "# $ % &
Keep With Vehicle At All Times.
Contains Important Information
On Safety, Operation & Maintenance.
This owner’s manual applies to the GRAND VITARA series:
79K035
NOTE: The illustrated model is one of the GRAND VITARA series.
© 2009
All rights reserved.
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or
mechanical, for any purpose, without the express written permission of Suzuki Motor Corporation.
79K21-03E
FOREWORD
Your SUZUKI multipurpose vehicle is
designed and built to be capable of performing both on pavement and off road.
You should therefore remember that your
vehicle is distinctly different from ordinary
passenger cars in handling as well as in
structure. As with other vehicles of this
type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an
accident. Be sure to read “Important Vehicle Design Features to Know” and the “onpavement” and “off-road” driving guidelines
which follow. It is very important to familiarize yourself with the proper operation of
this vehicle before you start driving.
All information in this manual is based
on the latest product information available at the time of publication. Due to
improvements or other changes, there
may be discrepancies between information in this manual and your vehicle.
SUZUKI
MOTOR
CORPORATION
reserves the right to make production
changes at any time, without notice and
without incurring any obligation to
make the same or similar changes to
vehicles previously built or sold.
SUZUKI
MOTOR
CORPORATION
believes in conservation and protection of
Earth’s natural resources.
To that end, we encourage every vehicle
owner to recycle, trade in, or properly dispose of, as appropriate, used motor oil,
coolant, and other fluids, batteries and
tires.
IF YOU HAVE ANY PROBLEMS WITH
YOUR SUZUKI:
Please review the New Vehicle Warranty
Information booklet supplied with your
SUZUKI. Should you have a question or
problem regarding the warranty or service
of your vehicle, please take the following
action:
Consult the Service Manager and the
Owner of the Suzuki Automotive Dealership. Explain your problem and ask for
their assistance in resolving your problem.
The Owner of the dealership is in the very
best position to assist you as he or she is
vitally concerned with your continued satisfaction.
If you are still in need of additional information, or if you are dissatisfied, request that
your dealer arrange a meeting with your
District Service Manager.
If, after doing so, you still require further
assistance, and you purchased your
SUZUKI in the continental United States,
please contact the American Suzuki Customer Relations Department by telephone
at 1-800-934-0934 or in writing at:
American Suzuki Motor Corporation
Automotive Customer Relations
3251 East Imperial Highway
Brea, CA 92821-6795
79K21-03E
If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada
please contact the Suzuki Canada Customer Relations Department by telephone
at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in
writing at:
Suzuki Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
100 East Beaver Creek Road
Richmond Hill, On
L4B 1J6
In the event you require assistance related
to your SUZUKI, while temporarily travelling in either the United States or Canada,
you may wish to contact the Suzuki Customer Relations Department directly of the
country in which you are temporarily operating your vehicle.
Please be certain to provide us with the following information: the model, Vehicle
Identification Number, mileage, accessories involved, event dates, your concern,
and any other comments which you may
have. When we receive your correspondence, we will be pleased to contact the
Owner of your dealership and assist in
resolving your concern.
IMPORTANT
WARNING/CAUTION/NOTE
Please read this manual and follow its
instructions carefully. To emphasize special information, the symbol
and the
words WARNING, CAUTION and NOTE
have special meanings. Pay special attention to the messages highlighted by these
signal words:
WARNING
Indicates a potential hazard that
could result in death or injury.
CAUTION
Indicates a potential hazard that
could result in vehicle damage.
75F135
The circle with a slash in this manual
means “Don’t do this” or “Don’t let this happen”.
NOTE:
Indicates special information to make
maintenance easier or instructions clearer.
For owners outside the continental United
States, please refer to the distributor’s
address listed in your Warranty Information
booklet.
79K21-03E
MODIFICATION WARNING
WARNING
Do not modify this vehicle. Modification could adversely affect safety,
handling, performance or durability
and may violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
LEAK DETECTION PUMP
NOTE:
Your vehicle has a pump to regularly check
the vehicle’s evaporative emission control
system for leaks. This check is performed
approximately five hours after the engine is
turned off. During this leak check, you may
hear a sound coming from the vehicle for
several minutes. This sound is normal and
does not indicate a malfunction.
CAUTION
Improper installation of mobile communication equipment such as cellular telephones or CB (Citizen’s Band)
radios may cause electronic interference with your vehicle’s ignition system, resulting in vehicle performance
problems. Consult your SUZUKI
dealer or qualified service technician
for advice on installing such mobile
communication equipment.
79K21-03E
MEMO
79K21-03E
INTRODUCTION
Thank you for choosing SUZUKI and welcome to our growing family. Your choice was a wise one; SUZUKI products are a great value
that will give you years of driving pleasure.
This Owner’s Manual was prepared to help you have a safe, enjoyable, and trouble-free experience with your SUZUKI. In it you will learn
about the vehicle’s operation, its safety features and maintenance requirements. Please read it carefully before operating your vehicle.
Afterwards, keep this Manual in the glove box for future reference.
Should you resell the vehicle, please leave this Manual with it for the next owner.
In addition to the Owner’s Manual, the other booklets provided with your SUZUKI explain the vehicle’s warranties. We recommend you
read them as well to familiarize yourself with this important information.
When planning the regular scheduled maintenance of your SUZUKI, we recommend you visit your local SUZUKI dealership. Their factory-trained technicians will provide the best possible service and use only genuine SUZUKI parts and accessories.
79K21-03E
SERVICE STATION GUIDE
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Fuel (see section 1)
Engine hood (see section 5)
Tire changing tools (see section 8)
Engine oil dipstick
(see section 7)
Automatic transmission fluid dipstick
(see section 7)
Engine coolant (see section 7)
Windshield washer fluid
(see section 7)
Battery (see section 7)
Tire pressure (see Tire Information
Label on driver’s door lock pillar)
Spare tire (see section 8)
1
8
6
10
5 (4A/T)
2
4
7
5 (5A/T)
2
3
9
79K135
79K21-03E
TABLE OF CONTENTS
California Proposition 65 Warning
WARNING
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain product components contain or emit chemicals
known to the State of California to
cause cancer and birth defects or
other reproductive harm.
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
1
BEFORE DRIVING
2
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
3
DRIVING TIPS
4
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
5
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
7
EMERGENCY SERVICE
8
APPEARANCE CARE
9
GENERAL INFORMATION
10
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
11
SPECIFICATIONS
12
INDEX
13
79K21-03E
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS
EXTERIOR
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Rear Window Wiper (P.2-81)
Engine Hood (P.5-63)
Windshield Wiper (P.2-79)
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors
(if equipped) (P.5-78)
Radio Antenna (P.5-8)
Spare Wheel (P.8-3)
Tailgate (P.2-3)
Fuel Filler Cap (P.5-62)
Outside Rearview Mirror (P.2-17)
Door Locks (P.2-1)
EXAMPLE
1
6
2
7
8
3
4
9
5
10
79K001
79K21-03E
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS
INTERIOR
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
Interior Light (P.5-64, P.7-40)
Seat Belts (P.2-26)
Coat hooks (if equipped) (P.5-70)
Side Curtain Air Bags (P.2-46)
Sun Visor (P.5-64)
Overhead Console Box (if equipped)
(P.5-71)
Spot Light (P.5-66, P.7-41)
Inside Rearview Mirror (P.2-17)
Luggage Compartment Cover
(P.5-74)
Rear Seats (P.2-22)
Side Air Bags (P.2-46)
Parking Brake Lever (P.3-7)
Front Seats (P.2-18)
Gearshift Lever (P.3-11)
EXAMPLE
1
9
2
3
10
1
4
11
5
6
12
13
7
8
14
79K132
79K21-03E
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1. Power Window Controls
(if equipped) (P.2-15)
2. Power Mirror Control (if equipped)
(P.2-18)
3. Remote Audio Controls (if equipped)
(P.5-56)
4. Front Air Bags (P.2-45)
5. Cruise Control (P.3-26)
6. Hazard Warning Switch (P.2-79)
7. Heating and Air Conditioning System
(P.5-1)
8. Fuel Lid Opener Lever (P.5-62)
9. Front Seat Heater (if equipped)
(P.2-21)
10. Accessory Socket (if equipped)
(P.5-66)
EXAMPLE
12
3
8
4
5
3
10
9
6
7
11
9
4
1
12
10
79K003
79K21-03E
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1. Lighting Control Lever (P.2-75)/
Turn Signal Control Lever (P.2-78)
2. Instrument Cluster (P.2-54)
3. Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever
(P.2-79)/Rear Window Wiper and
Washer Switch (P.2-81)
4. Rear Window Defroster and Outside
Rearview Mirrors Defroster Switch
(if equipped) (P.2-82)
5. Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped)
(P.2-78)
6. Engine Hood Release Handle
(P.5-63)
7. Horn (P.2-82)
8. Ignition Switch (P.3-3)
9. Transfer Switch (if equipped) (P.3-15)
10. “ESP OFF” Switch (if equipped)
(P.3-34)/Hill descent control Switch
(if equipped) (P.3-35)
EXAMPLE
1
6
5
2
7
6
7
8
3
8
9
4
10
9
11
10
79K136
79K21-03E
Location of Warning Messages: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
14
LOCATION OF WARNING
MESSAGES
Read and follow all of the warnings (labels
etc.) on your vehicle. Make sure you
understand all of them. Keep them on the
vehicle. Do not remove the messages for
any reason. If a label comes off or the
messages become difficult to be read,
have it corrected by your SUZUKI dealer.
1. Air bag warning labels
(on both sun visors)
2. Rollover warning label
3. Passenger seat belt warning label
4. Jacking warning label
5. Jacking warning label
6. Fuel filler cap message
7. Transfer switch warning label
8. Brake fluid cap message
9. Engine cooling fan warning label
10. Radiator cap warning label
11. Air conditioner warning label
12. Battery label
13. Side air bag warning label
14. Rear outboard seat belt warning label
15. Rear center seat belt warning label
16. Luggage compartment cover warning
label
6
16
4
5
15
14
13
14
14
13
13
Driver 1
Passenger
3
2
12
7
8
9
10
11
79K115
79K21-03E
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
1
Fuel Recommendation ........................................................ 1-1
65D394
79K21-03E
Fuel Recommendation: 1, 2
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
Fuel Recommendation
Gasoline Containing MTBE
Fuel Pump Labeling
Unleaded gasoline containing MTBE
(methyl tertiary butyl ether) may be used in
your vehicle if the MTBE content is not
greater than 15%. This oxygenated fuel
does not contain alcohol.
In some states, pumps that dispense oxygenated fuels are required to be labeled for
the type and percentage of oxygenate and
whether important additives are present.
Such labels may provide enough information for you to determine if a particular
blend of fuel meets the requirements listed
above. In other areas, pumps may not be
clearly labeled as to the content or type of
oxygenate and additives. If you are not
sure that the fuel you intend to use meets
these requirements, check with the service
station operator or the fuel supplier.
Gasoline/Ethanol blends
Blends of unleaded gasoline and ethanol
(grain alcohol), also known as gasohol,
may be used in your vehicle if the ethanol
content is not greater than 10%.
60A004
Your vehicle requires regular unleaded
gasoline with a minimum rating of 87 pump
octane ((R + M)/2 method). In some areas,
the only fuels that are available are oxygenated fuels.
Oxygenated fuels which meet the minimum octane requirement and the requirements described below may be used in
your vehicle without jeopardizing the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
NOTE:
Oxygenated fuels are fuels which contain
oxygen-carrying additives such as MTBE
or alcohol.
Gasoline/Methanol blends
Fuels containing 5% or less methanol
(wood alcohol) may be suitable for use in
your vehicle if they contain cosolvents and
corrosion inhibitors. Do NOT USE fuels
containing more than 5% methanol under
any circumstances. Fuel system damage
or vehicle performance problems resulting
from the use of such fuels are not the
responsibility of SUZUKI and may not be
covered under the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
NOTE:
To help clean the air, SUZUKI recommends you use the oxygenated fuels.
However, if you are not satisfied with the
driveability or fuel economy of your vehicle
when you are using an oxygenated fuel,
switch back to the regular unleaded gasoline.
CAUTION
Be careful not to spill fuel containing
alcohol while refueling. If fuel is
spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up
immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is
not covered under the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
1-1
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
BEFORE DRIVING
60G404
Keys ...................................................................................... 2-1
Door Locks .......................................................................... 2-1 2
Keyless Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry
System Transmitter ............................................................. 2-4
Theft Deterrent Light ........................................................... 2-15
Windows .............................................................................. 2-15
Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-17
Front Seats .......................................................................... 2-18
Rear Seats ............................................................................ 2-22
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ........................... 2-26
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ....................... 2-43
Instrument Cluster .............................................................. 2-54
Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-55
Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-65
Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-65
Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-65
Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-66
Brightness Control .............................................................. 2-66
Information Display (if equipped) ...................................... 2-67
Lighting Control Lever ........................................................ 2-75
Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) ................................ 2-78
Turn Signal Control Lever .................................................. 2-78
Hazard Warning Switch ...................................................... 2-79
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ................................ 2-79
Tilt Steering Lock Lever ..................................................... 2-82
Horn ...................................................................................... 2-82
Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors
Defroster (if equipped) Switch ........................................... 2-82
79K21-03E
Keys: 8
Spare Tire Nut Lock: 5
BEFORE DRIVING
Keys
Ignition Key Reminder
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the
ignition switch when the driver’s door is
opened.
EXAMPLE
Door Locks
WARNING
Always lock all doors when driving.
Locking the doors helps to prevent
occupants from being thrown from
the vehicle in the event of an accident. It also helps prevent unintended opening of the doors.
Side Door Locks
UNLOCK
54G489
LOCK
Your vehicle comes with a pair of identical
keys. Keep the spare key in a safe place.
One key can open all of the locks on the
vehicle.
The key identification number is stamped
on a metal tag provided with the keys.
Keep the tag in a safe place. If you lose
your keys, you will need this number to
have new keys made. Write the number
below for your future reference.
KEY NUMBER:
Rear
Front
60A009
To lock a front door from outside the vehicle:
• Insert the key and turn the top of the key
toward the front of the vehicle, or
• Turn the lock knob forward and close the
door.
2-1
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
To unlock a front door from outside the
vehicle, insert the key and turn the top of
the key toward the rear of the vehicle.
Power Door Locking System
(if equipped)
Driver’s side
EXAMPLE
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
LOCK
Rear
79K005
Front
Front passenger’s side
64J003
64J002
To lock a door from inside the vehicle, turn
the lock knob forward. Turn the lock knob
rearward to unlock the door.
To lock a rear side door from outside the
vehicle, turn the lock knob forward and
close the door.
You can lock and unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by:
• Turning the key in the driver’s door lock,
or
• Pushing the power door locking switch
located on the door panel of either front
door.
LOCK
UNLOCK
(when using the key)
To lock all doors simultaneously, insert the
key in the driver’s door lock, and turn the
key to the LOCK side.
To unlock all doors simultaneously, insert
the key in the driver’s door lock and turn
the key to the UNLOCK side twice.
79K006
2-2
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
(when using the power door locking
switch)
To lock or unlock all the doors simultaneously, depress the front or rear of the
switch respectively.
NOTE:
• If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless entry system, you can also lock or
unlock all doors by operating the remote
controller/transmitter. Refer to “Keyless
Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this
section.
• If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless start system, you can also lock or
unlock all doors by pushing the request
switch on the door handle. Refer to “Keyless Start System Remote Controller/
Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in
this section.
Child Lock System (rear doors)
Tailgate
You can lock or unlock the tailgate by using
the key in the driver’s door lock.
NOTE:
When, in parked condition on a road, the
tailgate is open and hides the lights, it is
necessary to indicate the presence of the
vehicle, for example by means of a warning triangle or other devices according to
national requirements for use on the road.
(2)
(1)
79K009
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
Each of the rear doors is equipped with a
child lock which can be used to help prevent unwanted opening of the door from
inside the vehicle. When the lock lever is in
the “LOCK” position (1), the rear door can
only be opened from outside. When the
lock lever is in the “UNLOCK” position (2),
the rear door can be opened from inside or
outside.
If you cannot unlock the tailgate due to a
discharged battery or malfunction, follow
the procedures below to unlock the tailgate
from inside the vehicle.
1) Remove the luggage compartment
cover.
2) Fold the rear seat forward for easier
access. Refer to the “Folding Rear
Seats” section for details on how to fold
the rear seat forward.
WARNING
Be sure to place the child lock system in the “LOCK” position whenever
children are seated in the rear.
2-3
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Keyless Start System Remote
Controller/Keyless Entry
System Transmitter
(2)
Type A
Type B
(1)
64J202
64J203
3) Remove the cap (1) by hand.
4) Break the vinyl using a jack handle or a
flat blade screwdriver to access the
emergency lever (2).
5) Push down on the emergency lever (2)
using a jack handle or a flat blade
screwdriver. To lock the tailgate, push
up on the emergency lever (2).
WARNING
To avoid injury, do not use your finger to push the emergency lever.
After using the emergency lever, be sure to
see your SUZUKI dealer.
66J111
Your vehicle is equipped with either a keyless start system remote controller (Type
A) or a keyless entry system transmitter
(Type B). The remote controller has a keyless entry system and a keyless start system. The transmitter has only a keyless
entry system. For details, refer to the following explanations.
2-4
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Keyless Start System Remote
Controller (Type A)
The remote controller enables the following
operations:
• You can lock or unlock the doors by
operating the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons
on the remote controller. Refer to the
explanation in this section.
• You can lock or unlock the doors (including the tailgate) by pushing the request
switch on the door handle of each door
or the tailgate. For details, refer to the
explanation in this section.
• You can start the engine without using
an ignition key. For details, refer to “Ignition Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR
VEHICLE” section.
(1)
(2)
(3)
“LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button
(2) function
You can lock or unlock all doors (including
the tailgate) simultaneously by operating
the remote controller near the vehicle.
• To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” button (1).
• To unlock the driver’s door, push the
“UNLOCK” button (2) once.
• To unlock other doors, wait a second or
two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2)
a second time. If you “double-click” too
fast, the doors will not unlock.
The turn signal lights will flash once when
the doors are locked.
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.
• If the interior light switch is in the
“DOOR” position, the interior light will
turn on for about 15 seconds and then
fade out. If you push in the ignition
switch or insert the key during this time,
the light will start to fade out immediately.
NOTE:
• The maximum operating distance of the
remote controller is about 5 m (16 ft.),
but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or
CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.
• The door locks cannot be operated with
the remote controller if the ignition switch
is in a position other than “LOCK”, or the
ignition key is inserted in the ignition
switch.
If any door is open, you cannot lock the
door by operating the remote controller,
however unlock the door.
• You cannot lock the door unless all of the
doors are closed completely.
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,
ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have
your dealer program the new remote
controller code in your vehicle’s memory
so that the old code is erased, or perform the programming procedure yourself according to the instructions in this
section.
Be sure the doors are locked after you
operate the “LOCK” button (1).
66J114
(1) “LOCK” button
(2) “UNLOCK” button
(3) “PANIC” button
If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is
operated, the doors will automatically lock
again.
2-5
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
“PANIC” button (3) function
This function is to get the attention of others.
Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than
1 second. The headlights and taillights will
blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn
will sound intermittently for about 30 seconds at the same time.
To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any
button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the
remote controller. You can also insert the
key in the ignition switch and turn to the
“ON” position to cancel the “PANIC” mode.
NOTE:
The “PANIC” button function will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch.
Keyless unlocking/locking using the
request switches
EXAMPLE
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.
• If the interior light switch is in the
“DOOR” position, the interior light will
turn on for about 15 seconds and then
fade out. If you push in the ignition
switch or insert the key during this time,
the light will start to fade out immediately.
Be sure the doors are locked after you
operate the request switch to lock the
doors.
(1)
(1)
78K143
When the remote controller is within the
operating range described in this section,
you can lock or unlock the doors by pushing the request switch (1) on the door handle of each door or the tailgate.
To lock all doors when all doors are
unlocked:
• Push the request switch on one of the
door handles once.
The turn signal lights will flash once when
the doors are locked.
NOTE:
• The door locks cannot be operated by
the request switch under the following
conditions:
– If any door is open or is not completely
closed.
– If the ignition switch is in a position
other than “LOCK”.
– If the ignition key is inserted in the ignition switch.
• If no doors are opened within about 30
seconds after unlocking the doors by
pushing the request switch, the doors
will be locked again automatically.
To unlock a door or all doors:
• Push the request switch on the door
handle once to unlock only one door.
• Push the request switch on the door
handle twice to unlock all doors.
2-6
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
EXAMPLE
(1)
(1)
(1)
• If a spare remote controller is in the vehicle, the request switches may not operate normally.
• The remote controller will only operate a
request switch if it is within the switch’s
operating range. For example, if the
remote controller is within the operating
range of the driver’s door request switch
but not the front passenger’s door
request switch or the tailgate request
switch, the driver’s door switch can be
operated but the front passenger’s door
switch or tailgate switch cannot be operated.
78K001
(1) 80 cm (2 1/2 feet)
When the remote controller is within
approximately 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) from a
front door handle or the tailgate switch, you
can lock or unlock the doors by pushing
the request switch.
NOTE:
• If the remote controller is outside the
request
switch
operating
range
described above, you will not be able to
operate the request switch.
• If the battery of the remote controller
runs down or there are strong radio
waves or noise, the request switch operating range may be reduced or the
remote controller may be inoperative.
• If the remote controller is too close to the
door, the request switches may not operate.
CAUTION
The remote controller is a sensitive
electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller:
• Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by
leaving it on the dashboard under
direct sunlight.
• Keep the remote controller away
from magnetic objects such as a
television.
NOTE:
The keyless start system may not function
correctly in certain environments or under
certain operating conditions such as the
following:
• When there are strong signals coming
from a television, power station or a cellular phone.
• When the remote controller is in contact
with or covered by a metal object.
• When a radio wave type remote keyless
entry is used nearby.
• When the remote controller is placed
near an electronic device such as personal computer.
Some additional precautions you should
take and information you should be aware
of are:
• Make sure the ignition key is stowed in
the remote controller. If the remote controller becomes unreliable, you will not
be able to lock or unlock the doors or
start the engine.
• Be sure that the driver always carries the
remote controller.
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,
ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have
your dealer program the new remote
controller code in your vehicle’s memory
so that the old code is erased, or perform the programming procedure yourself according to the instructions in this
section.
2-7
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
• You can use up to four remote controllers
and ignition keys for your vehicle. Ask
your SUZUKI dealer for details.
• The battery life of the remote controller
is about two years, but it can vary
depending on usage conditions.
63J281
To stow the ignition key into the remote
controller, push the key in the remote controller until you hear a click.
(A)
63J282
To remove the key from the remote controller, push the button (A) in the direction of
the arrow and pull the key out from the
remote controller.
• If you open the driver’s door and lock the
door by turning the lock knob forward or
pushing the power door locking switch,
the driver’s door will be automatically
unlocked.
• If you open a door other than the driver’s
door and lock the front passenger’s door
by turning the lock knob forward or pushing the power door locking switch, the
front passenger’s door will be automatically unlocked.
Reminder function
EXAMPLE
79K116
If the remote controller is not in the vehicle
under the following conditions, a buzzer
sounds intermittently for about 2 seconds
and the keyless start system indicator light
on the instrument cluster blinks in red:
• When the vehicle speed is over 10 km/h
(6 mph).
• When one or more doors are opened
and all of the doors are later closed with
the ignition switch in a position other
than “LOCK”.
NOTE:
• The reminder will not operate when the
remote controller is on the instrument
panel, in the glove box, in a storage
compartment, in the sun visor or on the
floor etc.
• Be sure that the driver always carries the
remote controller.
• Do not leave the remote controller in the
vehicle when leaving the vehicle.
The red indicator light will turn off within
several seconds after the remote controller
is returned to an area of the vehicle other
than the rear luggage area.
If the remote controller is left in the vehicle
and you lock the driver’s door or front passenger’s door as described below, the door
will be automatically unlocked.
2-8
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Replacement of the battery
If the remote controller becomes unreliable, replace the battery.
CAUTION
The transmitter/remote controller is a
sensitive electronic instrument. To
avoid damaging it, do not expose it to
dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts.
To replace the battery of the remote controller:
(1)
66J017
66J016
1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver covered
with a soft cloth in the slot of the remote
controller and pry it open.
2) Replace the battery (1) (Lithium disc
type CR2032 or equivalent) so its + terminal faces the bottom of the case as
shown in the illustration.
3) Close the remote controller firmly.
4) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the remote controller.
5) Dispose of the used battery properly
according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash.
WARNING
Swallowing a lithium battery may
cause serious internal injury. Do not
allow anyone to swallow a lithium
battery. Keep lithium batteries away
from children and pets. If swallowed,
contact a physician immediately.
2-9
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Programming/erasing the remote controller code yourself
Your new vehicle was originally equipped
with two remote controllers.
If you have lost one of the remote controllers, you should change the remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory as
soon as possible for security. If you purchase additional remote controllers, the
new remote controllers need to be programmed into your vehicle’s memory. You
can perform this yourself by using the following procedure:
NOTE:
• You can program up to four remote controller codes into your vehicle’s memory.
The four codes may be the same or different.
• If you try to program a fifth code, the four
remote controller codes that are programmed will be cleared automatically.
• If you program a new remote controller
code, all of the old remote controller
codes that are in your vehicle’s memory
will be erased automatically. When you
program a new remote controller, you
should reprogram any additional remote
controllers at the same time.
• To purchase new remote controllers, see
your SUZUKI dealer.
• Before you begin programming, have all
of your remote controllers available.
To program a new remote controller
1) Close all the doors of the vehicle.
2) Sit in the driver’s seat and confirm that
the driver’s door is unlocked.
3) Insert the key into the ignition switch.
4) Complete steps 1 through 6 described
below within 25 seconds after step 3).
UNLOCK
(2)
LOCK
(1)
79K005
1. Push the power door locking switch
of the driver’s door to the lock position and then push it to the unlock
position.
2. Repeat step 1 two more times.
3. Push the power door locking switch
of the driver’s door to the lock position.
4. Remove the key from the ignition
switch and then insert it again.
5. Repeat step 4 three more times.
6. To start the engine, turn the ignition
switch to the “START” position.
Wait for 3 seconds.
7. Proceed to step 5) within 60 seconds
after the engine has started.
NOTE:
You cannot program the remote controller
if you don’t complete steps 1 through 6
within 25 seconds.
You cannot program the remote controller
if you do not proceed to step 5) within 60
seconds after the engine has started.
5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
position.
A buzzer will sound twice and the door
lock switch will be activated from the
lock position to the unlock position
automatically.
6) Press the “LOCK”, “UNLOCK” or
“PANIC” button on the remote controller.
A buzzer will sound twice and the door
lock switch will be activated from the
lock position to the unlock position
automatically.
If you want to program an additional
remote controller, repeat the procedure
of step 6) using the additional remote
controller.
NOTE:
Complete step 6) within 30 seconds.
You can program up to four remote controllers.
2-10
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
7) To complete programming, remove the
key from the ignition switch or turn the
ignition switch to the “ON” position.
8) Make sure that the keyless start system
and keyless entry system operate properly by operating each remote controller.
If you cannot operate the keyless start system and/or keyless entry system, repeat
this programming procedure again.
If you still cannot operate the systems, see
your SUZUKI dealer.
To change the old remote controller
codes in your vehicle’s memory
If you have lost one of the remote controllers, you should change the remote controller codes in your vehicle’s memory as
soon as possible for security.
To erase the remote controller code(s) in
your vehicle’s memory, you should program the new remote controller code. The
old codes in your vehicle’s memory will be
erased automatically. If you have more
remote controller(s), you must program all
of the remote controller codes at the same
time. You cannot operate the keyless start
system and keyless entry system using
any remote controller that is not programmed at the same time.
For details on how to program, refer to the
programming procedure in this section.
When you complete programming, make
sure that the keyless start system and key-
less entry system operate properly by
operating each remote controller.
Keyless Entry System Transmitter
(Type B)
1. For USA
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
2. For Canada
This device complies with Industry Canada
Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause interference,
and
2) This device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the
device.
The term “IC:” before the certification/registration number only signifies that the
Industry Canada technical specifications
were met.
(1)
(2)
(3)
52D209
(1) “LOCK” button
(2) “UNLOCK” button
(3) “PANIC” button
“LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button
(2) function
You can lock or unlock all doors (including
the tailgate) simultaneously by operating
the transmitter near the vehicle.
• To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” button (1).
• To unlock the driver’s door, push the
“UNLOCK” button (2) once.
• To unlock other doors, wait a second or
two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2)
a second time. If you “double-click” too
fast, the doors will not unlock.
2-11
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
The turn signal lights will flash once when
the doors are locked.
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.
• If the interior light switch is in the
“DOOR” position, the interior light will
turn on for about 15 seconds and then
fade out. If you insert the key into the
ignition switch during this time, the light
will start to fade out immediately.
Be sure the doors are locked after you
operate the “LOCK” button (1).
If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is
operated, the doors will automatically lock
again.
NOTE:
• The maximum operating distance of the
keyless entry system transmitter is about
5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending
on the surroundings, especially near
other transmitting devices such as radio
towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.
• The door locks cannot be operated with
the transmitter, if the ignition key is
inserted in the ignition switch.
• If you lose one of the transmitters, ask
your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible
for a replacement. Be sure to have your
dealer program the new transmitter code
in your vehicle’s memory so that the old
code is erased, or perform the program-
ming procedure yourself according to the
instructions in this section.
CAUTION
Replacement of the battery
If the transmitter becomes unreliable,
replace the battery.
To replace the battery of the transmitter:
The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging
the transmitter:
• Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by
leaving it on the dashboard under
direct sunlight.
• Keep the transmitter away from
magnetic objects such as a television.
“PANIC” button (3) function
This function is to get the attention of others.
Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than
1 second. The headlights and taillights will
blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn
will sound intermittently for about 30 seconds at the same time.
To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any
button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the
transmitter. You can also insert the key in
the ignition switch and turn to the “ON”
position to cancel the “PANIC” mode.
52D210
1) Put the edge of a coin or a flat blade
screwdriver in the slot of the transmitter
and pry it open.
NOTE:
The “PANIC” button function will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch.
2-12
79K21-03E
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8
Windows: 3, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
CAUTION
The transmitter/remote controller is a
sensitive electronic instrument. To
avoid damaging it, do not expose it to
dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts.
(1)
Programming/removing a transmitter
code yourself
Your new vehicle was originally equipped
with two transmitters.
52D211
2) Replace the battery (1) (Lithium disctype CR2025 or equivalent) so its + terminal faces the “+” mark of the transmitter.
3) Close the transmitter firmly.
4) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the transmitter.
5) Dispose of the used battery properly
according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash.
WARNING
Swallowing a lithium battery may
cause serious internal injury. Do not
allow anyone to swallow a lithium
battery. Keep lithium batteries away
from children and pets. If swallowed,
contact a physician immediately.
If you have lost one of the transmitters, you
should change the transmitter code in your
vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for
security. If you purchase additional transmitters, the new transmitters need to be
programmed into your vehicle’s memory.
You can perform this yourself by using the
following procedure:
NOTE:
• You can program up to three transmitter
codes into your vehicle’s memory. The
three codes may be the same or different.
• If you try to program a fourth code, the
oldest code will be cleared automatically.
• To purchase new transmitters, see your
SUZUKI dealer.
• Before you begin programming, have all
of your transmitters available.
To program a new transmitter
1) Confirm that all the doors are closed
and the ignition key is out of the ignition
switch.
2) Open the driver’s door.
3) Insert the key, turn the ignition switch to
the “ON” position, turn the ignition
switch to the “LOCK” position and
remove the key within 10 seconds.
(1)
66J018
4) Push and release the driver’s door
switch (1) 3 times, insert the key, and
turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position within 20 seconds.
5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
position and remove the key within 10
seconds. All doors will lock/unlock to
confirm that this procedure has been
properly completed.
2-13
79K21-03E
Windows: 3, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
To change the old transmitter codes in
your vehicle’s memory
If you have lost one of the transmitters, you
should change the transmitter codes in
your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible
for security.
To remove one of the transmitter codes
from your vehicle’s memory, first replace all
three of the transmitter codes in your vehicle’s memory, then program additional
transmitters as follows:
(2)
52D212
6) Press the “UNLOCK” button (2) on the
transmitter one time within 20 seconds
(after step 5). All the doors will lock/
unlock to confirm that the procedure
has been completed and the transmitter
has been programmed.
7) If you want to program an additional
transmitter, repeat the procedure from
step 1) through step 6).
8) Make sure that the keyless entry system operates properly by operating
each transmitter.
1) Program one of your transmitters three
times, by repeating the programming
procedure shown in this section. This
will replace all the old transmitter codes
in the vehicle’s memory with the code
for the transmitter you are using.
2) If you want to program up to two additional transmitters, repeat the programming procedure shown in this section.
3) Make sure that the keyless entry system operates properly by operating
each transmitter.
1. For USA
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
2. For Canada
This device complies with Industry Canada
Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause interference,
and
2) This device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the
device.
The term “IC:” before the certification/registration number only signifies that the
Industry Canada technical specifications
were met.
2-14
79K21-03E
Windows: 3, 8
Mirrors: 3, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Theft Deterrent Light
Windows
Passenger’s door
EXAMPLE
Power Window Controls
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
(3)
Driver’s side
(1)
(4)
(2)
79K011
78K013
This light will blink with the ignition switch
in the “OFF” or “ACC” position. The blinking light is intended to deter theft by leading others to believe that the vehicle is
equipped with a security system.
(5)
The passenger’s door has a switch (3) to
operate the passenger’s window.
79K010
The power windows can only be operated
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
The driver’s door has switches (1), (2), (4),
(5), to operate the driver’s window, the
front passenger’s window, the rear left window and right window, respectively.
2-15
79K21-03E
Mirrors: 3, 8
BEFORE DRIVING
Lock switch
WARNING
EXAMPLE
CLOSE
OPEN
81A009
To open a window, push the top part of the
switch and to close the window lift up the
top part of the switch.
The driver’s window has an “auto-down”
feature for added convenience (at toll
booths or drive-through restaurants, for
example). This means you can open the
window without holding the window switch
in the “Down” position. Press the driver’s
window switch completely down and
release it. To stop the window before it
reaches the bottom, pull the switch up
briefly.
79K012
The driver’s door also has a lock switch for
the passenger’s window(s). When you
push in the lock switch, the passenger’s
window(s) cannot be raised or lowered by
operating either of the switches (2), (3), (4)
or (5). To restore normal operation, release
the lock switch by pushing again.
• You should always lock the passenger’s window operation when there
are children in the vehicle. Children
can be seriously injured if they get
part of their body caught by the
window during operation.
• To avoid injuring an occupant by
window entrapment, be sure no
part of the occupant’s body such
as hands or head is in the path of
the electric windows when closing
them.
• Always remove the ignition key
when leaving the vehicle even if
only for a short time. Also do not
leave children alone in a parked
vehicle. Unattended children could
use the electric window switches
and get trapped by the window.
NOTE:
If you drive with one of the rear windows
open, you may hear a loud sound caused
by air vibration. To reduce the sound, open
the driver’s or front passenger’s window, or
narrow the rear window opening.
2-16
79K21-03E
Seat Adjustment: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Mirrors
Outside Rearview Mirrors
WARNING
Inside Rearview Mirror
Day driving
• Always adjust the mirror with the
selector set to the day position.
• Only use the night position if it is
necessary to reduce glare from the
headlights of vehicles behind you.
Be aware that in this position you
may not be able to see some
objects that could be seen in the
day position.
Night driving
(1)
64J014
78K033
You can adjust the inside rearview mirror
by hand so as to see the rear of your vehicle in the mirror. To adjust the mirror, set
the selector tab (1) to the day position,
then move the mirror up, down or sideways
by hand to obtain the best view.
When driving at night, you can move the
selector tab to the night position to reduce
glare from the headlights of vehicles
behind you.
Adjust the outside rearview mirrors so you
can just see the side of your vehicle in the
mirrors.
The passenger’s side mirror is a convex
(curved surface) mirror. Objects seen in
this mirror will look smaller and appear farther away than when seen in a flat mirror.
WARNING
Be careful when judging the size or
distance of a vehicle or other object
seen in the side convex mirror. Be
aware that objects look smaller and
appear farther away than when seen
in a flat mirror.
2-17
79K21-03E
Seat Adjustment: 14
Head Restraints: 3
BEFORE DRIVING
Power Mirror Control (if equipped)
Mirrors Defroster (if equipped) Switch” in
this section.
Front Seats
Seat Adjustment
WARNING
(1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(2)
(3)
Never attempt to adjust the driver’s
seat or seatback while driving. The
seat or seatback could move unexpectedly, causing loss of control.
Make sure that the driver’s seat and
seatback are properly adjusted
before you start driving.
(4)
64J015
The switch to control the power rearview
mirrors is located on the driver’s door
panel. You can adjust the mirrors when the
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position. To adjust the mirrors:
WARNING
To avoid excessive seat belt slack,
which reduces the effectiveness of
the seat belts as a safety device,
make sure that the seats are adjusted
before the seat belts are fastened.
1) Move the selector switch to the left or
right to select the mirror you wish to
adjust.
2) Press the outer part of the switch that
corresponds to the direction in which
you wish to move the mirror.
3) Return the selector switch to the center
position to help prevent unintended
adjustment.
NOTE:
If your vehicle is equipped with the outside
rearview mirrors defroster, refer to “Rear
Window Defroster and Outside Rearview
2-18
79K21-03E
Head Restraints: 3
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Adjusting Seat Position
Adjusting Seatbacks
WARNING
All seatbacks should always be in an
upright position when driving, or seat
belt effectiveness may be reduced.
Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are
in the upright position.
78K034
64J016
The adjustment lever for each front seat is
located under the front of the seat. To
adjust the seat position, pull up on the
adjustment lever and slide the seat forward
or rearward. After adjustment, try to move
the seat forward and rearward to ensure
that it is securely latched.
If the driver’s seat is equipped with a seat
height adjuster lever on the outboard side
of the seat, raise or lower the seat by pulling up or down the adjuster lever.
64J018
To adjust the seatback angle of front seat,
pull up the lever on the outboard side of
the seat, move the seatback to the desired
position, and release the lever to lock the
seatback in place.
2-19
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Head Restraints
WARNING
(1)
All head restraints must be reinstalled to properly protect vehicle
occupants.
(3)
WARNING
• Never drive the vehicle with the
head restraints removed.
• Do not attempt to adjust the head
restraint while driving.
(2)
EXAMPLE
78K035
63J256
(1) Head restraint
(2) Bars
(3) Release knob
Head restraints are designed to help
reduce the risk of neck injuries in case of
an accident. Adjust the head restraint to
the position which places the center of the
head restraint closest to the top of your
ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high
as possible.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on
the restraint until it clicks. To lower the
restraint, push down on the restraint while
holding in the release knob (3). If a head
restraint must be removed (for cleaning,
replacement, etc.), push in the release
knob and pull the head restraint all the way
out.
WARNING
All occupants, including the driver,
should not operate a vehicle or sit in
a vehicle’s seat until the head
restraints are placed in their proper
positions in order to minimize the
risk of severe injury in the event of a
crash.
79K087
Each front seats is equipped with a head
restraint.
NOTE:
It may be necessary to recline the seatback to provide enough overhead clearance to remove the head restraint.
2-20
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Front Seat Heater (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
(4)
79K036
To reinstall the head restraint, insert the
head restraint bars into the holes (4) and
push the head restraint down.
86G064
78K138
With the ignition switch in the “ON” position, push in one or both of the seat heater
switches to warm the corresponding
seat(s). The indicator light below the switch
will also come on. To turn off the seat
heater, push in the switch again. The indicator light below the switch will go off.
WARNING
Improperly using the seat heater can
be hazardous. An occupant can suffer burns even if the heating temperature is fairly low, if the occupant is
wearing thin pants, a thin skirt or
shorts and leaves the heater on for
long periods.
Avoid using the seat heater for these
occupants:
• People who have reduced feeling in
their legs, including the elderly or
those with certain disabilities.
• Small children, or anyone with sensitive skin.
• People who are asleep or under the
influence of alcohol or other drugs
which make them tired.
2-21
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
CAUTION
To avoid damaging the heater element:
• Do not subject the front seats to
heavy impacts, such as children
jumping on them.
• Do not cover the seat with any
insulating materials such as blankets or cushions.
Rear Seats
Seat Adjustment
WARNING
To avoid excessive seat belt slack,
which reduces the effectiveness of
the seat belts as a safety device,
make sure that the seats are adjusted
before the seat belts are fastened.
Adjusting Seatbacks
WARNING
All seatbacks should always be in an
upright position when driving, or seat
belt effectiveness may be reduced.
Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are
in the upright position.
64J019
To adjust the seatback angle of the rear
seats:
1) Pull up the lever on the top of a split
folding seat.
2) Move the seatback to one of the lock
positions. The number of the lock positions depends on the vehicle specification.
3) Release the lever to lock the seatback
in position. After adjustment, try moving
the seatback to make sure it is securely
locked.
2-22
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Head Restraints
Head restraints are designed to help
reduce the risk of neck injuries in case of
an accident. Adjust the head restraint to
the position which places the center of the
head restraint closest to the top of your
ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high
as possible.
EXAMPLE
(3)
(1)
WARNING
All occupants, including the driver,
should not operate a vehicle or sit in
a vehicle’s seat until the head
restraints are placed in their proper
positions in order to minimize the
risk of severe injury in the event of a
crash.
WARNING
All head restraints must be reinstalled to properly protect vehicle
occupants.
WARNING
• Never drive the vehicle with the
head restraints removed.
• Do not attempt to adjust the head
restraint while driving.
(2)
EXAMPLE
79K088
Your vehicle is equipped with three head
restraints on the rear seat.
79K095
(1) Head restraint
(2) Bars
(3) Release knob
To raise the rear head restraint, pull
upward on the restraint until it clicks. To
lower the restraint, push down on the
restraint while holding in the release knob
(3). If a head restraint must be removed
(for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in
the release knob and pull the head
restraint all the way out.
When installing a child restraint system,
raise the head restraint to the most upper
position.
2-23
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Folding Rear Seats
The rear seat(s) of your vehicle can be
folded forward to provide additional cargo
space.
3) Lower the adjustable head restraint
fully.
To fold the rear seats forward:
1) Remove the luggage compartment
cover.
(1)
64J088
64J087
4) Pull the release lever forward on the top
of each split seat, and fold the seatbacks forward.
66J211
2) Stow the seat belt buckles of the center
and left seating position into the pocket
of the seat cushion as shown in the
illustration.
CAUTION
Make sure the belt webbing is not
caught by the seat.
5) Pull the lock release strap (1) rearward
to unlatch the seat cushion.
WARNING
When you unlatch the rear seat cushion, be careful that your face or
hands are not injured from the seat
popping up.
CAUTION
When you fold the rear seatback forward, stow the seat belt buckles of
the center and left seating position
into the pocket first. This helps prevent being caught by the seat and
being damaged.
2-24
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
WARNING
Luggage or other cargo should be
stowed in the luggage compartment
with the rear seat in an upright position, whenever possible. If you need
to carry cargo in the passenger compartment with the rear seat back
folded forward, be sure to secure the
cargo or it may be thrown about,
causing injury. Never pile cargo
higher than the seatbacks.
(4)
64J089
6) Fold the entire seat forward.
66J196
8) Hook the strap (4) to the front seat head
restraint and re-tighten the adjuster to
apply a tension on the strap as shown
in the illustration.
To return the seat to the normal position,
follow the procedure below.
CAUTION
(2)
When securing the folded rear seat
with a strap, adjust the strap length
so that the rear seat will not move.
(3)
64J175
66J195
7) Push down the adjuster (2) to make the
strap slack, and then unhook the strap
by pushing down the hook (3).
1) Unhook the strap from the head
restraint and stow the strap to the back
of the seat cushion as shown in the
illustration. Make sure to adjust the
strap length to avoid any slack or twist.
2-25
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
CAUTION
• When returning the rear seat cushion to the normal position, make
sure that there is nothing around
the striker. Any foreign materials
prevent the seat cushion from
being locked securely.
• When returning the rear seat cushion to the normal position, make
sure that there is nothing under the
seat cushion. This prevents damage to the seat cushion.
Seat Belts and Child Restraint
Systems
64J091
2) Pull down the seat cushion until it locks
into place.
65D231S
WARNING
WARNING
When returning the rear seat cushion
to the normal position, be careful that
your finger is not caught between the
lock and the floor.
64J092
3) Raise the seatback until it locks into
place.
An air bag supplements, or adds to,
the frontal crash protection offered
by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained
by wearing seat belts at all times,
whether or not an air bag is mounted
at their seating position, to minimize
the risk of severe injury or death in
the event of a crash.
After returning the seat, try moving the
seat and seatback to make sure they are
securely latched.
2-26
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Above the pelvis
Across the pelvis
65D606
WARNING
• Never allow persons to ride in the
cargo area of a vehicle. In the event
of an accident, there is a much
greater risk of injury for persons
who are not riding in a seat with
their seat belt securely fastened.
• Seat belts should always be
adjusted as follows:
– the lap portion of the belt should
be worn low across the pelvis,
not across the waist.
– the shoulder straps should be
worn on the outside shoulder
only, and never under the arm.
– the shoulder straps should be
away from your face and neck,
but not falling off your shoulder.
(Continued)
as low as possible
across the hips
65D201
WARNING
(Continued)
• Seat belts should never be worn
with the straps twisted and should
be adjusted as tightly as is comfortable to provide the protection
for which they have been designed.
A slack belt will provide less protection than one which is snug.
(Continued)
65D199
WARNING
(Continued)
• Pregnant women should use seat
belts, although specific recommendations about driving should be
made by the woman’s medical advisor. Remember that the lap portion
of the belt should be worn as low
as possible across the hips, as
shown in the diagram.
• Make sure that each seat belt
buckle is inserted into the proper
buckle catch. It is possible to cross
the buckles in the rear seat.
(Continued)
2-27
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Lap-Shoulder Belt
WARNING
(Continued)
• Do not wear your seat belt over
hard or breakable objects in your
pockets or on your clothing. If an
accident occurs, objects such as
glasses, pens, etc. under the seat
belt can cause injury.
• Never use the same seat belt on
more than one occupant and never
attach a seat belt over an infant or
child being held on an occupant’s
lap. Such seat belt use could cause
serious injury in the event of an
accident.
• Periodically inspect seat belt
assemblies for excessive wear and
damage. Seat belts should be
replaced if webbing becomes
frayed, contaminated, or damaged
in any way. It is essential to replace
the entire seat belt assembly after it
has been worn in a severe impact,
even if damage to the assembly is
not obvious.
• Children age 12 and under should
ride properly restrained in the rear
seat, if equipped.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Infants and small children should
never be transported unless they
are properly restrained. Restraint
systems for infants and small children can be purchased commercially and should be used. Make
sure that the system you purchase
meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards. Read and follow all the
directions provided by the manufacturer.
• Avoid contamination of seat belt
webbing by polishes, oils, chemicals and particularly battery acid.
Cleaning may safely be carried out
using mild soap and water.
• For children, if the shoulder belt
irritates the neck or face, move the
child closer to the center of the
vehicle.
• All seatbacks should always be in
an upright position when driving,
or seat belt effectiveness may be
reduced. Seat belts are designed to
offer maximum protection when
seatbacks are in the upright position.
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
The lap-shoulder seat belt has an emergency locking retractor (ELR), which is
designed to lock the seat belt only during a
sudden stop or impact. It also may lock if
you pull the belt across your body very
quickly. If this happens, let the belt go back
to unlock it, then pull the belt across your
body more slowly.
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
The front passenger’s seat belt and the
rear seat belts have emergency locking
retractors (ELRs) that can be temporarily
converted to function as automatic locking
retractors (ALRs). The ALR mode should
be used if you need to secure a child
restraint system in the seat. Refer to the
“Child Restraint Systems” section for
details.
2-28
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
by pulling the shoulder portion of the belt
upward through the latch plate. The length
of the diagonal shoulder strap adjusts itself
to allow freedom of movement.
Safety reminder
Sit up straight and
fully back
Low on hips
60A036
60A038
Low on hips
To fasten the seat belt, sit up straight and
well back in the seat, pull the latch plate
attached to the seat belt across your body
and press it into the buckle until you hear a
“click”.
60A040
To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt
during a collision, position the lap portion
of the belt across your lap as low on your
hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit
2-29
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Seat Belt Reminder
Driver’s seat belt reminder light
EXAMPLE
78K126
60A039
NOTE:
The word “CENTER” is molded into the
buckle for the rear seat center belt. The
buckles are designed so a latch plate cannot be inserted into the wrong buckle.
To unfasten the belt, push the red
“PRESS” button on the buckle and allow
the belt to retract.
79K117
Front passenger’s seat belt reminder
light
66J243
When the driver and front passenger don’t
buckle their seat belts, the driver’s seat belt
2-30
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
reminder light in the instrument cluster and
the front passenger’s seat belt reminder
light in the center of the instrument panel
will come on and a buzzer will sound as a
reminder to the driver and front passenger
to buckle their seat belts.
Flow chart
Ignition Switch “ON”
Seat belt is
buckled
Seat belt is
unbuckled
WARNING
It is absolutely essential that the
driver and passengers wear their seat
belts at all times. Persons who are
not wearing seat belts have a much
greater risk of injury if an accident
occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the
key in the ignition.
The seat belt reminder functions as shown
in the figure below. There are some differences between the driver’s seat belt
reminder and the front passenger’s seat
belt reminder. For more details, refer to the
explanation below.
No reminder
Seat belt is
unbuckled
Reminder 1
30 sec.
Vehicle speed:
below 8 km/h
Vehicle speed:
below 8 km/h
Vehicle speed:
over 8 km/h
Vehicle speed:
over 8 km/h
Vehicle speed:
increase to 8 km/h
Reminder 2
3 min.
Reminder 3
No reminder
52D219
Reminder 1 – 3
For each reminder 1 – 3, the reminder light comes on for about 20 seconds, then blinks for
about 55 seconds. When the reminder light first comes on, a buzzer sounds intermittently
for about 6 seconds.
2-31
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Driver’s seat belt reminder
If the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled
with the ignition key in the “ON” position,
the driver’s seat belt reminder works as follows:
1) The driver’s seat belt reminder light will
come on for about 20 seconds when
the ignition key is turned to the “ON”
position then will blink for about 55 seconds. When the light comes on, a
buzzer will also sound intermittently for
about 6 seconds (Reminder 1).
2) If the vehicle is driven (vehicle speed >
8 km/h), Reminder 2 will operate about
30 seconds after Reminder 1 has finished.
If the vehicle is not driven (vehicle
speed < 8 km/h), Reminder 2 will operate when driving starts (vehicle speed >
8 km/h).
3) Reminder 3 will operate about 3 minutes after Reminder 2 has finished.
4) Even if the driver’s seat belt remains
unbuckled after Reminder 3, there will
be no further reminders.
If the driver has buckled his or her seat belt
and later unbuckles the seat belt, the
reminder system will be activated from
Reminder 1 or Reminder 2 according to
the vehicle speed. (Refer to the flow chart.)
The driver’s seat belt reminder will be automatically canceled when the driver’s seat
belt is buckled or the ignition switch is
turned off.
Front passenger’s seat belt reminder
The front passenger’s seat belt reminder
will activate only when there is a passenger sitting in the front seat. In some situations, however, such as when you place
heavy objects in the front seat, the seat
belt reminder can be activated as if there
were a passenger present. The front passenger’s seat belt reminder works in the
same manner as the driver’s seat belt
reminder, except that it is not activated
until 10 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned to the “ON” position.
Shoulder anchor height adjuster
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
64J198
Adjust the shoulder anchor height so that
the shoulder belt rides on the center of the
outside shoulder. To upward, slide the
anchor up. To downward, slide the anchor
down while pulling the lock knob out. After
adjustment, make sure that the anchor is
securely locked.
WARNING
Be sure that the shoulder belt is positioned on the center of the outside
shoulder. The belt should be away
from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Misadjustment
of the belt could reduce the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash.
2-32
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Seat Belt Inspection
Child Restraint Systems
WARNING
EXAMPLE
65D209
Periodically inspect the seat belts to make
sure they work properly and are not damaged. Check the webbing, buckles, latch
plates, retractors, anchorages and guide
loops. Replace any seat belts which do not
work properly or are damaged.
Be sure to inspect all seat belt
assemblies after any collision. Any
seat belt assembly which was in use
during a collision (other than a very
minor one) should be replaced, even
if damage to the assembly is not
obvious. Any seat belt assembly
which was not in use during a collision should be replaced if it does not
function properly, it is damaged in
any way or the seat belt pretensioners were activated (that is, if the front
air bags were activated).
60G332
Infant restraint - rear seat only
EXAMPLE
65D202
2-33
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Infant restraint - rear seat only
SUZUKI highly recommends that you use
a child restraint system to restrain infants
and small children. Many different types of
child restraint systems are available; make
sure that the restraint system you select
meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
65D584
Booster seat
EXAMPLE
All child restraint systems are designed to
be secured in vehicle seats by either seat
belts (lap belts or the lap portion of lapshoulder belts) or by special rigid lower
anchor bars built into the seats. Whenever
possible, SUZUKI recommends that child
restraint systems be installed on the rear
seat. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in
rear seating positions than in front seating
positions.
If you must use a front-facing child restraint
in the front passenger’s seat, be sure to
move the front passenger’s seat as far
back as possible.
WARNING
Children could be endangered in a
crash if their child restraints are not
properly secured in the vehicle.
When installing a child restraint system, be sure to follow the instructions below. Be sure to secure the
child in the restraint system according to the manufacturer’s instructions.
WARNING
In an accident or sudden stop, the
rear seat armrest (if equipped) could
fall forward. If there is a child in a
rear-facing child restraint in the center seating position, the falling armrest could injure the child. Make sure
the armrest is back in the seat and
locked when not in use.
65D203
2-34
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
BEFORE DRIVING
Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat
Belts (Child Restraint with No Top
Strap)
65D607
65D608
WARNING
NOTE:
There are two types of lap-shoulder belts
depending on the vehicle’s specification,
A-ELR (Automatic-Emergency Locking
Retractor) type and ELR (Emergency
Locking Retractor) type.
The A-ELR type belts have emergency
locking retractors (ELRs) that can be temporarily converted to function as automatic
locking retractors (ALRs).
The ELR type belts have ELRs that cannot
be converted to function as ALRs.
To identify the belt is the A-ELR type or the
ELR type, slowly pull all of the shoulder
webbing out of the retractor. Then let the
webbing retract a little and pull it out, and
repeat this a few times. If the belt is locked
each time you pull the belt, the belt is the
A-ELR type. If the belt is not locked, the
belt is the ELR type.
Do not install a rear-facing child
restraint in the front passenger’s
seat. If the passenger’s air bag
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child
restraint could be seriously injured.
The back of a rear-facing child
restraint would be too close to the
inflating air bag.
Please note that the methods to secure the
child restraint system with the ELR lapshoulder belt and with the A-ELR lapshoulder belt are different.
65D609
CAUTION
Before installing a child restraint system in the rear seat, raise the head
restraint to the most upper position.
2-35
79K21-03E
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
A-ELR type belt
ELR type belt
EXAMPLE
A-ELR type
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
65D233
Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child
restraint system manufacturer.
Make sure that the seat belt is securely
latched.
Try to move the child restraint system in all
directions to make sure it is securely
installed.
83E031
Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child
restraint system manufacturer. If you install
the child restraint system in the front seat,
be sure to slide the seat to the rearmost
position. After making sure that the seat
belt is securely latched:
83E035
1) Pull all of the remaining webbing out of
the retractor. You will hear a click, which
means that the emergency locking
retractor (ELR) has converted to function as an automatic locking retractor
(ALR).
2-36
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
A-ELR type
A-ELR type
EXAMPLE
A-ELR type
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
Move to check
83E032
83E036
2) Allow the extra webbing to retract, and
pull the webbing toward the retractor to
take up any slack. Make sure that the
lap portion of the belt is tight around the
child restraint system and the shoulder
portion of the belt is positioned so that it
cannot interfere with the child’s head or
neck.
3) Make sure that the retractor has converted to the ALR mode by trying to pull
webbing out of the retractor. If the
retractor is in the ALR mode, the belt
will be locked.
65D234
A-ELR type
EXAMPLE
Pull to tighten
WARNING
If the retractor is not in the ALR
mode, the child restraint system can
move or tip over when your vehicle
turns or stops abruptly.
65D235
4) Try moving the child restraint system in
all directions, to make sure it is securely
installed. If you need to tighten the belt,
pull more webbing toward the retractor.
2-37
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
Installation with the LATCH System
To revert from ALR to ELR
EXAMPLE
and Tethers for Children.) The anchors are
located where the rear of the seat cushion
meets the bottom of the seatback.
Install a LATCH-type child restraint system
according to the instructions provided by
the child restraint system manufacturer.
After installing the child restraint system,
try moving it in all directions, especially forward to make sure the flexible straps or
rigid connecting bars are securely latched
to the anchors.
Rigid lower connecting
bar type
65D267
When you unbuckle the seat belt and allow
it to retract to a certain length, the retractor
will automatically revert back to the normal
ELR mode.
Flexible lower connecting
strap type
66J162
Rear seat
NOTE:
Although there are three second row seating positions, you cannot install three
LATCH type child restraints in the rear
seat. You can install one or two LATCH
restraint(s). Be sure to install the LATCH
type child restraint(s) in the outboard seating positions.
If your LATCH restraint has flexible lower
connecting straps, these general instructions apply:
1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward
for easier installation.
2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat.
64J027
Your vehicle is equipped with lower
anchors for securing up to two standard
LATCH-type child restraints in the rear
seats. (LATCH stands for Lower Anchors
2-38
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
owner’s manual. Attach the top tether
strap, if applicable.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
If your LATCH restraint has rigid lower connecting bars, these general instructions
apply:
1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward
for easier installation.
2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat,
inserting the connecting bars through
the slots in the seat cushion or the slots
in the seatback bottom.
EXAMPLE
65D340
3) Snap the strap hooks to the anchors.
Take care not to pinch your fingers.
65D342
5) Make sure the child restraint is securely
fastened by trying to move the child
restraint system in all directions, especially forward.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
The seatback should always be
securely latched in a fairly upright
position when any type of child seat
is installed. An unlatched or reclined
seatback will reduce the intended
effectiveness of the child restraint
system.
54G183
3) Use your hands to carefully align the
connecting bar tips with the anchors.
Take care not to pinch your fingers.
65D341
4) Return the seatback to the normal,
upright position. Tighten the lower
straps as described in the child restraint
2-39
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
EXAMPLE
Installation-Child Restraint with Top
Strap
EXAMPLE
Rear seat
EXAMPLE
Front
54G184
54G185
4) Push the child restraint toward the
anchors so that the connecting bar tips
are partially hooked to the anchors.
Use your hands to confirm the position.
5) Grasp the front of the child restraint and
push the child restraint forcefully to
latch the connecting bars. Make sure
they are securely latched by trying to
move the child restraint system in all
directions, especially forward.
6) Return the seatback if folded. Attach
the top tether strap, if applicable.
WARNING
The seatback should always be
securely latched in a fairly upright
position when any type of child seat
is installed. An unlatched or reclined
seatback will reduce the intended
effectiveness of the child restraint
system.
79K026
Some child restraint systems require the
use of a top strap. Top strap anchor brackets are located on the back of the rear seat
as shown in the illustration. Install the child
restraint system as follows:
1) Remove the luggage compartment
cover.
2) Secure the child restraint on the rear
seat using the procedure described
above for securing a restraint system
that does not require a top strap.
3) Hook the top strap to the anchor
bracket and tighten the top strap
according to the instructions provided
by the child restraint system manufacturer. Be sure to attach the top strap to
the corresponding anchor located
directly behind the child restraint. Do
2-40
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
not attach the top strap to the luggage
restraint loops (if equipped).
WARNING
Do not attach the child restraint top
strap to the luggage restraint loops
(if equipped). Incorrectly attached top
strap will reduce the intended effectiveness of the child restraint system.
how to raise or lower the head
restraint.)
5) Make sure that cargo does not interfere
with routing of the top strap.
Seat Belt Extender
Type 1
65D613
(1) Center of body
(2) Less than 152 mm (6 inches)
(3) Open end of extender buckle
Type 2
86G032
4) When routing the top strap, be sure to
pass it between the head restraint and
the rear seatback as shown. (Refer to
“Head Restraints” section for details on
If a seat belt cannot be fastened securely
because it is not long enough, see your
authorized SUZUKI dealer for a seat belt
extender. Seat belt extenders are available
for each seating position except for the
rear center position. After inspecting the
relationship between the seat belt length,
the occupant’s body size, and the seat
adjustment (the driver’s seat should always
be adjusted as far back as possible while
still maintaining control of the vehicle, and
other adjustable seats should be adjusted
as far back as possible), your dealer can
select the appropriate seat belt extender.
• A seat belt extender should only be used
for the person, vehicle and seating location it was provided for.
• When using the extender, ensure that
both ends are latched securely. Do not
use the extender if the open end of the
extender’s buckle is within 152 mm (6
inches) of the center of the occupant’s
body (See diagram). Use of the extender
when the buckle is too close to the center of the body could increase the risk of
abdominal injury in the event of an accident, and could cause the shoulder belt
to be positioned incorrectly.
• Make sure to use the correct buckle corresponding to your seating position.
• Seat belt extenders are not intended for
use by pregnant women, and should
only be used upon approval by their
medical advisors.
• Remove and stow the extender when it
is not being used.
2-41
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
WARNING
Seat Belt Pretensioner System
(for front seat belt only)
sensors and the electronic controller of the
air bag system also control the seat belt
pretensioners. The pretensioners are triggered only when the air bags are triggered
and the seat belts are fastened. If the seat
belts are not fastened, the respective pretensioner system will not be activated. For
precautions and general information
including servicing the pretensioner system, refer to the “Supplemental Restraint
System (air bags)” section in addition to
this “Seat Belt Pretensioner System” section, and follow all those precautions.
Failure to follow these instructions
may increase the risk of injury in a
crash.
• Only use an extender for the person, vehicle and seating position it
was provided for.
• Do not use if open end of
extender’s buckle is within 152 mm
(6 inches) of center of occupant’s
body (See diagram).
• Remove and stow the extender
when it is not being used.
52D011
WARNING
This section of the owner’s manual
describes your SUZUKI’s SEAT BELT
PRETENSIONER SYSTEM. Please
read and follow ALL these instructions carefully to minimize your risk
of severe injury or death.
Your vehicle is equipped with a seat belt
pretensioner system at the front seating
positions. You can use the pretensioner
seat belts in the same manner as ordinary
seat belts.
The seat belt pretensioner system works
with the SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM (advanced air bags). The crash
The pretensioner is located in each front
seat belt retractor. The pretensioner tightens the seat belt in the event of a frontal
crash or a rollover. The retractors will
remain locked after the pretensioners are
activated. Upon activation, some noise will
occur and some smoke may be released.
These conditions are not harmful and do
not indicate a fire in the vehicle.
The driver and all passengers must be
properly restrained by wearing seat belts
at all times, whether or not a pretensioner
is equipped at their seating position, to
help minimize the risk of severe injury or
death in the event of a frontal crash or a
rollover.
Sit fully back in the seat; sit up straight; do
not lean forward or sideways. Adjust the
belt so the lap portion of the belt is worn
low across the pelvis, not across the waist.
Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” sec-
2-42
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
tion and the instructions and precautions
about the seat belts in this “Seat Belts and
Child Restraint Systems” section for details
on proper seat and seat belt adjustments.
Please note that the pretensioners along
with the front air bags will activate in
severe frontal collisions. Also, the pretensioners along with the side curtain air bags
will activate in severe rollovers. They are
not designed to activate in rear impacts,
side impacts, or minor frontal collisions.
The pretensioners can be activated only
once. If the pretensioners are activated
(that is, if the front air bags and/or the side
curtain air bags are activated), have the
pretensioner system serviced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.
If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument
cluster does not blink or come on briefly
when the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, stays on for more than 10
seconds, or comes on while driving, the
pretensioner system or the air bag system
may not work properly. Have both systems
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer
as soon as possible.
Service on or around the pretensioner system components or wiring must be performed only by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer who is specially trained. Improper
service could result in unintended activation of pretensioners or could render the
pretensioner inoperative. Either of these
two conditions may result in personal
injury.
To prevent damage or unintended activation of the pretensioners, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch
has been in the “LOCK” position for at least
90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your SUZUKI. Do not
touch pretensioner system components or
wiring. The wires are wrapped with yellow
tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are
yellow. When scrapping your SUZUKI, ask
your SUZUKI dealer, body repair shop or
scrap yard for assistance.
Supplemental Restraint
System (air bags)
EXAMPLE
54G022
WARNING
This section of the owner’s manual
describes the protection provided by
your
SUZUKI’s
SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT SYSTEM (air bags).
Please read and follow ALL these
instructions carefully to minimize
your risk of severe injury or death in
the event of a collision.
Your vehicle has advanced front air bags
and side air bags for the driver and right
front passenger. Your vehicle also has side
curtain air bags.
2-43
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
9
7
2
11
10
8
3
4
66J132
6
8
Your vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System consisting of the
following components in addition to a lapshoulder belt at each front seating position.
5
3
10
79K137
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
Driver’s front air bag
Front passenger’s front air bag
Seat belt pretensioners
Air bag controller
Occupant classification module
“PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator
Forward crash sensor
Side air bags
Side curtain air bags
Side crash sensor
Front passenger’s sensor mat
2-44
79K21-03E
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12
BEFORE DRIVING
Front Air Bags
dashboard. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are
molded into the air bag covers to identify
the location of the air bags.
EXAMPLE
Frontal collision range
63J030
If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument
cluster does not blink or come on when the
ignition switch is first turned to the “ON”
position, or the “AIR BAG” light stays on, or
comes on while driving, the air bag system
(or the seat belt pretensioner system) may
not work properly. Have the air bag system
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer
as soon as possible.
63J259
EXAMPLE
60G032
Front air bags are designed to inflate only
in severe frontal collisions.
78K128
The driver’s front air bag is located behind
the center pad of the steering wheel and
the front passenger’s front air bag is
located behind the passenger’s side of the
2-45
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Front air bags will not inflate
Front air bags are not designed to inflate in
rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers or
minor frontal collisions, since they would
offer no protection in those types of accidents. Remember, since air bags deploy
only one time during an accident, seat
belts are needed to restrain occupants
from further movements during the accident.
Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air
Bags
EXAMPLE
Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute
for seat belts. To maximize your protection,
ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be
aware that no system can prevent all possible injuries that may occur in an accident.
65D236
Front air bags will probably not inflate
WARNING
68KM090
An air bag supplements, or adds to,
the crash protection offered by seat
belts. The driver and all passengers
must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or
not air bags are mounted at their
seating position, to minimize the risk
of severe injury or death in the event
of a crash.
65D237
Your vehicle has “dual stage” front air
bags, which adjust the air bag inflation
force according to crash severity. Also,
your vehicle has a front passenger sensing
system, which turns off the front passenger’s air bag and seat belt pretensioner
under certain conditions.
78K037
Side air bags are located in the part of the
front seatbacks closest to the doors. The
words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into the
2-46
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
side air bag cover to identify the location of
the side air bags.
Side air bags will not inflate
Side collision range
64J036
64J034
Side curtain air bags are located in the roof
lining. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are
molded into the pillar to identify the location of the side curtain air bags.
Side air bags are designed to inflate only in
severe side impact collisions.
Side curtain air bags are designed to
inflate in severe side impact collisions and/
or rollovers.
54G027
Side curtain air bags will not inflate
79K037
2-47
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Side air bags and side curtain air bags
will probably not inflate
Front Passenger Sensing System
WARNING
An air bag supplements, or adds to,
the crash protection offered by seat
belts. The driver and all passengers
must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or
not air bags are mounted at their
seating position, to minimize the risk
of severe injury or death in the event
of a crash.
WARNING
54G028
Side air bags and side curtain air bags are
not designed to inflate in frontal or rear collisions or minor side collisions, since they
would offer no protection in these types of
accidents. In a severe side impact, only the
side air bag and side curtain air bag on the
side of the vehicle that is struck will inflate.
In a severe rollover, the side curtain air
bags on both sides of the vehicle will
inflate. Remember, since an air bag
deploys only one time during an accident,
seat belts are needed to restrain occupants from further movements during the
accident.
If the “AIR BAG” light in the instrument cluster ever comes on and
stays on, it means that something
may be wrong with the air bag system. If this ever happens, have the
vehicle
serviced
immediately,
because the air bags may not offer
the protection for which they were
designed.
The front passenger sensing system will
turn off the front passenger’s front air bag
and seat belt pretensioner under certain
conditions. This system works using a sensor mat that is part of the front passenger’s
seat. The front passenger sensing system
is designed to detect whether an occupant
is present in the seat and, if an occupant is
present, to determine whether the front
passenger’s front air bag and seat belt pretensioner should be enabled or disabled
(turned off).
NOTE:
The front passenger’s side air bag and the
side curtain air bag are not controlled by
the front passenger sensing system.
Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute
for seat belts. To maximize your protection,
ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be
aware that no system can prevent all possible injuries that may occur in an accident.
2-48
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
“PASS AIR BAG OFF” Indicator
66J244
The “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator is
located on the center of the instrument
panel.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF”
indicator comes on for several seconds to
let you know the system is working. When
the front passenger sensing system has
turned off the front passenger’s front air
bag including the seat belt pretensioner,
the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will
come on and stay on to remind you that
the front passenger’s front air bag is off.
The front passenger sensing system uses
front seat pressure measurements and
pressure locations to determine whether to
activate or deactivate the front passenger’s
front air bag. The front passenger sensing
system may or may not turn off the front air
bag, depending on the front passenger’s
seating posture and body build. The air
bag should be turned off in the following
situations:
• There is no occupant in the front passenger seat.
• The occupant of the front passenger
seat lifts his or her weight off of the seat
for a period of time.
• The occupant of the front passenger
seat is an infant or small child in a child
restraint system or a small child in a
booster seat.
• A smaller person, such as a child who
has outgrown child restraints or a very
small adolescent is seated in the front
passenger seat.
ing the vehicle, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF”
indicator is still not lit, check to make sure
that the vehicle’s seatback is not pressing
the child restraint into the seat cushion. If
this happens, slightly recline the vehicle’s
seatback and adjust the seat cushion if
possible. Also make sure the child restraint
is not trapped under the vehicle head
restraint. If this happens, adjust the head
restraint. If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator is still not on, secure the child in the
child restraint or booster seat in a rear seat
position in the vehicle and check with your
dealer.
NOTE:
If the front passenger seat is unoccupied,
the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will not
come on but the front passenger’s front air
bag will not deploy and the seat belt pretensioner will not operate.
If you have secured a child in the front passenger seat in a forward-facing child
restraint system or booster seat and the
“PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator light is not
on, turn the vehicle off, remove the child
restraint or booster seat from the vehicle
and reinstall it following the child restraint
or booster seat manufacturer’s directions.
Also refer to “Seat Belts and Child
Restraint Systems” in this section. If, after
reinstalling the child restraint and restart-
2-49
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
front air bag when the system senses a
properly-seated adult in the front passenger’s seat. When the passenger sensing
system has allowed the air bag to be
enabled, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will remain off to remind you that the air
bag is active.
65D607
WARNING
Do not install a rear-facing child
restraint in the front passenger’s
seat. If the passenger’s front air bag
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child
restraint could be seriously injured.
The back of a rear-facing child
restraint would be too close to the
inflating air bag.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in rear
seating positions than in front seating positions. Whenever possible, SUZUKI recommends you install child restraints in the
rear seat.
If a person of adult size is sitting in the
front passenger’s seat and the “PASS AIR
BAG OFF” indicator comes on, it could be
because that person isn’t sitting properly in
the seat. If this happens, unfasten the seat
belts, sit upright in the center of the seat
with the seatback nearly vertical and your
legs outstretched, and refasten the seat
belt.
52D258
When seated as shown in the above illustration, the front passenger sensing system senses a properly-seated occupant
and enables the air bag.
When using a seat belt extender, follow the
instructions in the “Seat Belt Extender”
section.
WARNING
Do not place any heavy objects on
the front passenger’s seat. The pressure sensors in the sensor mat could
be damaged and the front passenger
sensing system may not work properly.
The front passenger sensing system is
designed to enable the front passenger’s
2-50
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
How the System Works
WARNING
The front passenger sensing system
may not work properly in the following situations:
• The occupant is sitting near the
dashboard or is not sitting in the
proper position.
• Objects placed under the seat are
pushing up on the seat cushion.
WARNING
If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator
on the instrument panel turns on
even though there is no occupant or
an adult occupant in the front passenger’s seat, it means that something may be wrong with the
passenger sensing system. Have the
system inspected by an authorized
SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.
WARNING
• Do not spill any liquids on the seat.
Liquids can damage the sensors
under the front seat.
• Have front passenger’s sensor mat
inspected by your dealer after a
collision.
• Do not replace the front seats. If
you replace them, the air bags and
front passenger sensing system
may not work properly.
• Do not use a seat cover. If you use
a seat cover, the front passenger
sensing system may not work properly.
In a frontal collision, the crash sensors will
detect rapid deceleration and send a signal
to the controller. If the controller judges
that the deceleration represents a severe
frontal crash, the controller will trigger the
inflators. The controller also judges:
• Whether the front air bags should deploy
at reduced power or at full power according to crash severity.
• Whether the front passenger’s front air
bag should deploy or not based on classification of the occupant of the front
passenger’s seat.
Since your vehicle is equipped with side air
bags, and side curtain air bags, crash sensors will detect a side collision, and if the
controller judges that the side collision is
severe enough, it will trigger the side air
bag and side curtain air bag inflators.
Your vehicle also has rollover sensors that
work with the controller to predict whether
a rollover may occur and if the controller
judges that a severe rollover is about to
occur, it triggers the side curtain air bag
inflators on both sides of the vehicle.
The inflators inflate the appropriate air
bags with nitrogen or argon gas. The
inflated air bags provide a cushion for your
head (front air bags and side curtain air
bags only) and upper body. The air bag
inflates and deflates so quickly that you
may not even realize that it has activated.
2-51
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
The air bag will neither hinder your view
nor make it harder to exit the vehicle.
Air bags must inflate quickly and forcefully
in order to reduce the chance of serious or
fatal injuries. However, an unavoidable
consequence of the quick inflation is that
the air bag may irritate bare skin, such as
the facial area against a front air bag. Also,
upon inflation, a loud noise will occur and
some powder and smoke will be released.
These conditions are not harmful and do
not indicate a fire in the car. Be aware,
however, that some air bag components
may be hot for a while after inflation.
WARNING
65D610
A seat belt helps keep you in the proper
position for maximum protection when an
air bag inflates. Adjust your seat as far
back as possible while still maintaining
control of the vehicle. Sit fully back in your
seat; sit up straight; do not lean over the
steering wheel or dashboard. Front occupants should not lean on or sleep against
the door. Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” section and the “Seat Belts and
Child Restraint Systems” section in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section for details on
proper seat and seat belt adjustments.
• The driver should not lean over the
steering wheel. The front passenger should not rest his or her body
against the dashboard, or otherwise get too close to the dashboard. For vehicles with side air
bags and side curtain air bags,
occupants should not lean on or
sleep against the door. In these situations, the out-of-position occupant would be too close to an
inflating air bag, and may suffer
severe injury.
• Do not attach any objects to, or
place any objects over, the steering
wheel or dashboard. Do not place
any objects between the air bag
and the driver or front passenger.
These objects may interfere with air
bag operation or may be propelled
by the air bag in the event of a
crash. Either of these conditions
may cause severe injury.
(Continued)
54G582
2-52
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Servicing the Air Bag System
WARNING
(Continued)
• For vehicles with side air bags, do
not place seat covers on the front
seats, because seat covers could
restrict the air bag’s inflation. Also,
do not place any cup holders or
other objects on the door, as these
objects could be propelled by the
air bag in the event of a crash.
Either of these conditions may
cause severe injury.
Note that even though your vehicle may be
moderately damaged in a collision, the collision may not have been severe enough to
trigger the front, side, or side curtain air
bags to inflate. If your car sustains ANY
front-end or side damage, have the air bag
system inspected by an authorized
SUZUKI dealer to ensure it is in proper
working order.
Your vehicle is equipped with a diagnostic
module which records information about
the air bag system if the air bags deploy in
a crash. The module records information
about overall system status, which sensors
activated the deployment, and whether the
front seat belts were in use.
If the air bags inflate, have the air bags and
related components replaced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.
If your vehicle ever gets in deep water and
the driver’s floor is submerged, the air bag
controller could be damaged. If this happens, have the air bag system inspected
by the SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.
Special procedures are required for servicing or replacing an air bag. For that reason,
only an authorized SUZUKI dealer should
be allowed to service or replace your air
bags. Please remind anyone who services
your SUZUKI that it has air bags.
Service on or around air bag components
or wiring must be performed only by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer. Improper service could result in unintended air bag
deployment or could render the air bags
inoperative. Either of these two conditions
may result in severe injury.
To prevent damage or unintended inflation
of the air bag system, be sure the battery
is disconnected and the ignition switch has
been in the “LOCK” position for at least 90
seconds before performing any electrical
service work on your SUZUKI. Do not
touch air bag system components or wires.
The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or
yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow
for easy identification.
Scrapping a car that has an undeployed air
bag can be hazardous. Ask your dealer,
body repair shop or scrap yard for help
with disposal.
If it is necessary to modify the advanced
front air bag system to accommodate a
person with disabilities, owners in the continental United States can call American
Suzuki toll-free at 1-800-934-0934, or write
to:
American Suzuki Motor Corporation
Automotive Customer Relations
3251 East Imperial Highway
Brea, CA 92821-6795
If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada
please contact the Suzuki Canada Customer Relations Department by telephone
at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in
writing at:
Suzuki Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
100 East Beaver Creek Road
Richmond Hill, On
L4B 1J6
2-53
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Instrument Cluster
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Speedometer
Tachometer
Fuel gauge
Temperature gauge
Information display
MODE/ILL knob
TRIP knob
Warning and indicator lights
EXAMPLE
2
1
8
7
5
3
6
8
4
79K118
2-54
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and Indicator Lights
Front Passenger’s Seat Belt
Reminder Light
For details about the seat belt reminder,
refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint
Systems” in this section.
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
WARNING
It is absolutely essential that the
driver and passengers wear their seat
belts at all times. Persons who are
not wearing seat belts have a much
greater risk of injury if an accident
occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the
key in the ignition.
66J246
The front passenger’s seat belt reminder
light is located in the center of the instrument panel. If there is a passenger in the
front seat and the front passenger’s seat
belt is unbuckled about 10 seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”
position, this light will come on and then
blink. When the light comes on, a buzzer
will also sound intermittently for about 6
seconds. The reminder will repeat several
times under certain conditions until the
front passenger’s seat belt is buckled. After
repeating several times, the reminder will
be canceled even if the front passenger’s
seat belt remains unbuckled.
52D305
As an added safety feature, your vehicle
has been equipped with a tire pressure
monitoring system (TPMS) that uses a low
tire pressure warning light to inform you
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the low tire pressure warning light comes on briefly so you can check
that the light is working.
When the low tire pressure warning light is
lit, one or more of your tires is significantly
under-inflated. You should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure as indicated
on the vehicle’s tire information placard.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to
tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping
ability. Each tire, including the spare,
should be checked at least once a month
when cold and set to the recommended
2-55
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
inflation pressure as specified in the vehicle placard and owner’s manual.
The low tire pressure warning light is also
used to inform you of a TPMS malfunction.
When the system detects a malfunction,
this light will flash for approximately one
minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will be repeated
approximately ten minutes after subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
NOTE:
The low tire pressure warning light may not
come on immediately if you have a sudden
loss of air pressure.
WARNING
If the low tire pressure warning light
does not come on when the ignition
is turned to the “ON” position, or
comes on and blinks while driving
there may be a problem with the tire
pressure monitoring system. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light
turns off after blinking, indicating
that the monitoring system has
recovered, make sure to have an
authorized SUZUKI dealer check the
system.
WARNING
The load rating of your tires is
reduced at lower inflation pressures.
If your tires become even moderately
under-inflated, the vehicle load may
exceed the load rating of the tires,
which can lead to tire failure. The low
tire pressure warning light will not
alert you of this condition. The warning light will only come on when one
or more of your tires become significantly under-inflated. Check and
adjust your tire inflation pressure at
least once a month. Refer to “Tires”
in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
WARNING
If the low tire pressure warning light
comes on and stays on, reduce your
speed and avoid abrupt steering and
braking. Stop in a safe place as soon
as possible and check your tires.
• If you have a flat tire, replace it with
the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking
Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY
SERVICE”
section.
Refer
to
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels”
for instructions on how to restore
normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you
have had a flat tire.
• If one or more of your tires is
under-inflated, adjust the inflation
pressure in all of your tires to the
recommended inflation pressure as
soon as possible.
Be aware that driving on a significantly under-inflated tire can cause
the tire to overheat and can lead to
tire failure, and may affect steering
control and brake effectiveness. This
could lead to an accident, resulting in
severe injury or death.
Refer to “Tire Pressure Monitoring System”
in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for additional details on the tire pressure monitoring system. Refer to “Tires” in
the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
2-56
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
section for information on maintaining
proper tire pressure.
WARNING
Remember that stopping distance
may be longer, you may have to push
harder on the pedal, and the pedal
may go down farther than normal.
Brake System Warning Light
65D477
This light comes on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position.
The light also comes on under the following conditions: 1) when the parking brake
is engaged, and 2) when the fluid in the
brake fluid reservoir falls below the specified level. The light should go out after fully
releasing the parking brake, if the fluid
level in the brake fluid reservoir is adequate.
If the brake system warning light comes on
while you are driving the vehicle, it may
mean that there is something wrong with
the vehicle’s brake system. If this happens,
you should:
1) Pull off the road and stop carefully.
NOTE:
Because the disc brake system is selfadjusting, the fluid level will drop as the
brake pads become worn.
Replenishing the brake fluid reservoir is
considered normal periodic maintenance.
2) Test the brakes by carefully starting and
stopping on the shoulder of the road.
3) If you determine that it is safe, drive
cautiously at low speed to the nearest
dealer for repairs,
or
4) Have the vehicle towed to the nearest
dealer for repairs.
WARNING
If any of the following conditions
occur, you should immediately ask
your SUZUKI dealer to inspect the
brake system.
• If the brake system warning light
does not go out after the parking
brake has been fully released.
• If the brake system warning light
does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”
position.
• If the brake system warning light
comes on at any time during vehicle operation.
2-57
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Warning Light
details on how to reactivate the ESP® systems, refer to “SLIP Indicator Light” in the
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
SLIP Indicator Light
For details of the ESP® systems, refer to
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
79K019
65D529
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working. If
the light stays on, or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with
the ABS.
If the ABS light and the brake system
warning light stay on, or come on simultaneously when driving, then there may be
something wrong with both the rear brake
proportioning valve function and anti-lock
function of the ABS system.
If one of these happens, have the system
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. If the
ABS becomes inoperative, the brake system will function as an ordinary brake system that has no ABS.
For details of the ABS, refer to “Anti-Lock
Brake system (ABS)” in the “OPERATING
YOUR VEHICLE” section.
ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler
AG.
WARNING
The ESP® systems cannot prevent
accidents. Always drive carefully.
This light blinks 5 times per second when
one of the following systems is activated.
• Stability control system
• Traction control system
• Hill descent control system (if equipped)
If this light blinks, drive carefully.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working. If
the light stays on, or comes on when driving and remains on, there may be something wrong with the ESP® systems (other
than ABS). You should have the system
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
NOTE:
When you disconnect and re-connect the
battery, ESP® system functions other than
ABS will be deactivated and the slip indicator light will blink 1 time per second. For
2-58
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
“ESP” (Electronic Stability
Program) Warning Light
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light
systems (other than ABS) will turn on
automatically and the light will go out.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a hill
descent control system and a hill hold
control system, these systems will not be
turned off when the “ESP OFF” switch is
pushed to turn off the ESP® systems.
66J032
66J031
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working. If
the light stays on, or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with
the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You
should have the system inspected by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer.
For details of the ESP® systems, refer to
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when this light
comes on.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working.
For details of the ESP® systems, refer to
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
When the “ESP OFF” switch is pushed to
turn off the ESP® systems (other than
ABS), the “ESP OFF” light comes on and
stays on.
NOTE:
• If the vehicle speed is greater than
approximately 30 km/h (19 mph), the
ESP® systems (other than ABS) will turn
on automatically and the light will go out.
• When the transfer switch (if equipped) is
turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the
ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be
canceled automatically. The light will
come on and stay on.
• If the ESP® systems operate continuously such as when driving on slippery
roads, the traction control functions of
the ESP® systems may be canceled
temporarily to avoid overheating the
brake pads, and the light will come on.
After a short period of time, the ESP®
2-59
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Hill descent control Indicator Light
Oil Pressure Light
Charging Light
79K050
50G051
50G052
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working.
This light comes on when the ignition
switch is turned to the “ON” position, and
goes out when the engine is started. The
light will come on and remain on if there is
insufficient oil pressure. If the light comes
on when driving, pull off the road as soon
as you can and stop the engine. Check the
oil level and add oil if necessary. If there is
enough oil, the lubrication system should
be inspected by your SUZUKI dealer
before you drive the vehicle again.
This light comes on when the ignition
switch is turned to the “ON” position, and
goes out when the engine is started. The
light will come on and remain on if there is
something wrong with the battery charging
system. If the light comes on when the
engine is running, the charging system
should be inspected immediately by your
SUZUKI dealer.
When you push the hill descent control
switch and the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled, the hill descent
control indicator comes on. If the hill
descent control indicator blinks, the hill
descent control will not be activated.
For details of the hill descent control system, refer to “Hill descent control System”
in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
CAUTION
• If you operate the engine with this
light on, severe engine damage can
result.
• Do not rely on the Oil Pressure
Light to indicate the need to add
oil. Be sure to periodically check
the engine oil level.
2-60
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light
“AIR BAG” Light
Malfunction Indicator Light
60G049
63J030
65D530
If the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled when
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”
position, this light will come on and then
blink. When the light comes on, a buzzer
will also sound intermittently for about 6
seconds. The reminder will repeat several
times under certain conditions until the
driver’s seat belt is buckled. After repeating
several times, the reminder will be canceled even if the driver’s seat belt remains
unbuckled.
This light monitors inflators, crash sensors,
seat belt pretensioners, the front passenger sensing system, and corresponding
electrical circuits.
This light blinks for several seconds when
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”
position so you can check if the light is
working. The light will come on and stay on
if there is a problem in the air bag system
or the seat belt pretensioner system.
Your vehicle has a computer-controlled
emission control system. A malfunction
indicator light is provided on the instrument
panel to indicate when it is necessary to
have the emission control system serviced.
The malfunction indicator light comes on
when the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position to let you know the light is
working and goes out when the engine is
started.
For details about the seat belt reminder,
refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint
Systems” in this section.
WARNING
It is absolutely essential that the
driver and passengers wear their seat
belts at all times. Persons who are
not wearing seat belts have a much
greater risk of injury if an accident
occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the
key in the ignition.
WARNING
If the “AIR BAG” light does not blink
when the ignition switch is turned to
the “ON” position or stays on or
comes on when driving, the air bag
system or the seat belt pretensioner
system (if equipped) may not work
properly.
Have
both
systems
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
If the malfunction indicator light comes on
or blinks when the engine is running, service to the emission control system is necessary. Bring the vehicle to your SUZUKI
dealer to have the emission control system
serviced right away and avoid hard acceleration until the service is performed.
CAUTION
Continuing to drive the vehicle when
the malfunction indicator light is on
or blinking can cause permanent
damage to the vehicle’s emission
control system, and can affect fuel
economy and driveability.
2-61
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
If the fuel filler cap is not installed fully, the
electrical system gets wet (such as by driving through a deep puddle of water) or the
fuel tank gets nearly empty, the malfunction indicator lamp may come on. If so, the
lamp will go off after driving a few times
after the fuel filler cap is installed fully, the
electrical system dries out or the fuel tank
is filled.
Low Fuel Warning Light
Open Door Warning Light
“CRUISE” Indicator Light
(if equipped)
54G391
This light remains on until all doors (including the tailgate) are completely closed.
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when this light
comes on.
52D113
When the cruise control system is on, this
light will be on.
“SET” Indicator Light (if equipped)
54G343
If this light comes on, fill the fuel tank
immediately.
NOTE:
The activation point of this light varies
depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions
because of fuel moving in the tank.
65D474
When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by
the cruise control system, this light will be
on.
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when this light
comes on.
2-62
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Keyless Start System Indicator
Light (if equipped)
Turn Signal Indicators
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.)
Indicator Light (if equipped)
50G055
62J041
When you push the ignition switch for vehicle with the keyless start system, this light
will come on in blue or red. If this light
comes on in blue, you can turn the ignition
switch without using an ignition key. If this
light comes on in red, you cannot turn the
ignition switch without using an ignition
key. For details, refer to “Ignition Switch” in
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
When you turn on the left or right turn signals, the corresponding green arrow on the
instrument panel will flash along with the
respective turn signal lights.
When you turn on the hazard warning
switch, both arrows will flash along with all
of the turn signal lights.
High Beam Indicator Light
If this light blinks in red, it reminds you that
the remote controller is not in the vehicle.
For details, refer to “Keyless Start System
Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System
Transmitter” in this section.
60B245
With the D.R.L. system, the headlights
light, but are dimmer than the low beam,
when the following three conditions are all
met. Whenever the D.R.L. system is operating, the D.R.L. indicator light remains on.
Conditions for D.R.L. system operation
1) The engine is running.
2) The parking brake is released.
3) The headlights are off, or the lighting
switch is in the “AUTO” position and it is
light around the light sensor.
50G056
This indicator comes on when headlight
high beams are turned on.
2-63
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Illumination Indicator Light
Transfer Position Indicator Light
(if equipped)
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when the transfer
system is operated, or has a problem.
64J045
This indicator light comes on while the
position lights, tail lights and/or the headlights are on.
If the indicators (all lights) continue to blink,
there is a problem in the transfer system
and you should have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
Master Warning Indicator Light
(1)
(2)
(3)
64J044
These indicators show the 4WD operating
mode as described below. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position,
these lights come on briefly to let you know
that the lights are working.
(1): Neutral
(2): 4-wheel drive high range center differential lock mode
(2) & (3): 4-wheel drive low range center
differential lock mode
No indicators: 4-wheel drive high range
mode
78K049
This light blinks or comes on for several
seconds when the ignition switch is turned
to the “ON” position so you can check if the
light is working.
When the information display shows warning and indicator messages, this indicator
light may also come on or blink.
For details, refer to “Information Display” in
this section.
For details, refer to “Using the Transfer
Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
2-64
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Speedometer
Tachometer
EXAMPLE
Fuel Gauge
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
79K119
78K039
64J052
The speedometer indicates vehicle speed
in km/h and mph.
The tachometer indicates engine speed in
revolutions per minute.
This gauge gives an approximate indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
“F” stands for full and “E” stands for empty.
If the indicator gets off the graduation of
“E” (not character “E”), refill the tank as
soon as possible.
CAUTION
Never drive with the engine speed
indicator in the red zone or severe
engine damage can result.
When downshifting to a lower gear,
make sure not to operate with excessive revolution speeds of the engine.
NOTE:
The indicator moves a little depending on
road conditions (for example, slope or
curve) and driving conditions because of
fuel moving in the tank.
If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on,
fill the fuel tank immediately.
2-65
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when this light
comes on.
Temperature Gauge
Brightness Control
CAUTION
Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire, damaging the catalytic converter.
NOTE:
The activation point of the low fuel warning
light (1) varies depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and
driving conditions because of fuel moving
in the tank.
The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler
door is located on the right side of the vehicle.
(1)
64J053
79K120
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position, this gauge indicates the engine
coolant temperature. Under normal driving
conditions, the indicator should stay within
the normal, acceptable temperature range
between “H” and “C”. If the indicator
approaches “H”, overheating is indicated.
Follow the instructions in the “If the Engine
Overheats” of “EMERGENCY SERVICE”
section.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the instrument panel lights
come on.
CAUTION
Continuing to drive the vehicle when
engine overheating is indicated can
result in severe engine damage.
Your vehicle has a system to automatically
dim the brightness of the instrument panel
lights when the position lights or headlights
are on.
You can change the brightness of the
instrument panel lights regardless of
whether the position lights or headlights
are off or on.
To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) clockwise.
To reduce the brightness of the instrument
panel lights, turn the brightness control
knob (1) counterclockwise.
2-66
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Information Display
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
The information display shows the following information.
The information display is shown when the
ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
Display (B)
Warning and Indicator Messages/Fuel
Consumption/Driving
Range/Average
Speed
79K062
NOTE:
• If you do not turn the brightness control
knob within about 5 seconds of activating the brightness control display, the
brightness control display will be canceled automatically.
• When you reconnect the battery, the
brightness of the instrument panel lights
will be reinitialized. Readjust the brightness according to your preference.
NOTE:
If you select the lowest brightness level
when the parking lights or headlights are
on, the instrument panel lights other than
meter lights are turned off.
(A)
(B)
(C)
Display (A)
A/T selector position indicator (for automatic transmission)
(D)
Display (C)
Trip meter/Thermometer
Display (D)
Odometer
(1)
(3)
(2)
79K048
(1) TRIP knob
(2) MODE/ILL knob
(3) Information display
79K063
NOTE:
• When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the message shown in the
above illustration will appear on the display for several seconds.
• Some warning and indicator messages
may appear on the display when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or the “LOCK”
position.
2-67
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
A/T Selector Position
(for automatic transmission)
To switch the display indication, push the
MODE/ILL knob (2) quickly.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
NOTE:
The value of fuel consumption, driving
range and average speed shown in the display are affected by conditions such as the
following;
• road condition
• surrounding traffic condition
• driving condition
• vehicle condition
• a malfunction which causes the malfunction indicator light to come on or blink
(a)
79K121
(b)
The display (A) shows the automatic transmission selector position.
Fuel Consumption/Driving Range/
Average Speed
When there are no warning or indicator
messages on the display (B), you can
select one of the following five indications
to appear on the display, instantaneous
fuel consumption, average fuel consumption, driving range, average speed, or no
indication.
(c)
(d)
(e)
79K065
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Instantaneous fuel consumption
Average fuel consumption
Driving range
Average speed
No indication
2-68
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Instantaneous fuel consumption
If you selected instantaneous fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display does not show the bar
graph when the ignition switch is turned to
the “ON” position. The display shows the
bar graph only when the vehicle is moving.
Average fuel consumption
If you selected average fuel consumption
the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel
consumption from previous driving when
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”
position. Unless you reset the value of
average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of average fuel consumption which includes average fuel
consumption during previous driving.
NOTE:
When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average
fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a while.
You can select when the value of average
fuel consumption is reset from among the
following three methods;
• Reset after refuel: the value of average
fuel consumption will be reset automatically by refueling.
• Reset with trip A: the value of average
fuel consumption will be reset automatically by resetting trip meter A.
• Reset manually: the value of average
fuel consumption will be reset by pushing and holding the MODE/ILL knob (2)
when the display indicates the average
fuel consumption.
To change when the value of average fuel
consumption is reset, refer to “Setting
Mode” later in this section.
NOTE:
If you add only a small amount of fuel
when you select “Reset after refuel”, the
average fuel consumption value may not
be reset.
Driving range
If you selected driving range the last time
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates
“---” for a few seconds and then indicates
the current driving range when the ignition
switch is turned to the “ON” position.
The driving range shown in the display is
the approximate distance you can drive
until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on
current driving conditions.
When the remaining fuel in fuel tank
reaches a low level, the display “---” will
appear.
If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill
the fuel tank immediately regardless of the
value of driving range shown in the display.
As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving
condition, the value is different each time
you refuel.
NOTE:
• If you refuel when the ignition switch is in
the “ON” position, the driving range may
not indicate the correct value.
• When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of driving
range will be shown after driving for a
while.
2-69
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Average speed
If you selected average speed the last time
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates
the last value of average speed from previous driving when the ignition switch is
turned to the “ON” position. Unless you
reset the value of average speed, the display indicates the value of average speed
which includes average speed during previous driving.
Odometer/Trip meter/Thermometer
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, the display (C) shows one of
the following three indications, trip meter A,
trip meter B and thermometer. Also, the
display (D) shows the odometer reading.
EXAMPLE
(f)
To reset the value of average speed, push
and hold the MODE/ILL knob (2) for about
2 seconds when the display indicates an
average speed. The display shows “---”
and then indicates a new average speed
after driving for a short time.
NOTE:
When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average
speed will be shown after driving for a
while.
(i)
(g)
CAUTION
Keep track of your odometer reading
and check the maintenance schedule
regularly for required services.
Increased wear or damage to certain
parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper
mileage intervals.
Trip meter
The trip meter can be used to measure the
distance traveled on short trips or between
fuel stops.
You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B
independently.
(h)
79K122
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Odometer
The odometer records the total distance
the vehicle has been driven.
Trip meter A
Trip meter B
Thermometer
Odometer
To reset the trip meter to zero, push and
hold the TRIP knob (1) for about 2 seconds
when the display shows the trip meter.
To switch the display indication (C), push
the TRIP knob (1) quickly.
2-70
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Thermometer
The thermometer indicates the outside
temperature.
Setting Mode
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
79K069
79K068
79K067
If the outside temperature nears freezing,
the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the display.
NOTE:
The outside temperature indication is not
the actual outside temperature when driving at low speed, or when stopped.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position and the vehicle is stationary, you
can enter the setting mode of the information display by pushing and holding the
MODE/ILL knob (2) for more than 3 seconds.
• To select the setting that you want to
change, turn the MODE/ILL knob (2) left
or right.
• To change the setting, push the MODE/
ILL knob (2).
• To exit the setting mode, select “Back”
and push the MODE/ILL knob (2).
NOTE:
Current settings appear with reversed text
and background colors.
NOTE:
• If you push and hold the MODE/ILL knob
to enter the setting mode when the display (B) shows average fuel consumption or average speed, the value will be
reset simultaneously. If you do not want
to reset the value, push the MODE/ILL
knob quickly to switch the indication of
the display.
• If you turn the ignition switch or start to
move the vehicle when the display
shows the setting mode, the setting
mode will be canceled automatically.
2-71
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Distance units
You can change the units odo/trip meter
distance is displayed in.
NOTE:
When you change the units odo/trip meter
distance is displayed in, the trip meter will
be reset automatically.
Fuel economy units
You can change the units that fuel consumption is displayed in.
Warning and Indicator Messages
The display shows the warning and indicator messages to let you know about certain
vehicle problems.
A tone may also sound to alert you.
the message will appear again after 5
seconds.
If warning and indicator messages appear
on the display, follow the messages.
Master warning indicator
Language
You can change the language of the information display.
Avg. fuel economy reset
You can change when the value of average
fuel consumption is reset.
Temperature units
You can change the units that temperature
is displayed in.
NOTE:
When you change the units that temperature is displayed in, the air conditioning
system temperature display units will be
changed automatically.
Default setting
If you select “YES” and push the MODE/
ILL knob (2), all settings will be reinitialized.
78K049
When the display shows warning and indicator messages, the master warning indicator may also come on or blink.
NOTE:
• When the problem that causes a message to appear is corrected, the message will disappear.
• If a message is displayed, and other
problems requiring a message occur, the
message for each of the problems will be
alternately displayed about every 5 seconds.
• When you push and hold the MODE/ILL
knob for about 2 seconds while a message is displayed, the message will disappear temporarily. If the problem that
caused the message is not corrected,
2-72
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and Indicator messages
Warning and Indicator message
Master Warning
Indicator
Sound
Cause and Remedy
Blinks
Ding
Any door (including the tailgate) is open when the vehicle
is moving.
Close all doors completely.
Off
Off
Any door (including the tailgate) is open when the vehicle
is stopped. (#1)
Close all doors completely.
Blinks
Ding
There may be a problem with the ESP® system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
Blinks
Ding
There may be problem with the hill descent control system and the hill hold control system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
Blinks
Continuous
Beep
Front position lights, license plate lights, instrument lights
and/or head lights are left on.
Turn the lighting switch to the “OFF” position.
79K070
79K070
79K071
79K072
79K073
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-73
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and Indicator message
Master Warning
Indicator
Sound
Cause and Remedy
Blinks
Off
There may be a problem with the 4WD system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
Off
Ding
Fuel is low. (#1)
Fill the fuel tank immediately.
Off
Off
The outside temperature is near freezing. The road may
be icy. (#1)
You should drive carefully.
79K074
79K075
79K067
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
NOTE:
• When you operate the transfer switch (if equipped), the information display may show messages other than those in the above chart.
Refer to “Using the Transfer Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for details.
• When you operate the ESP OFF switch (if equipped), the information display may show messages other than those in the above chart.
Refer to “Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for details.
2-74
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Lighting Control Lever
Your vehicle’s lighting system is controlled
by three main systems: the Lighting switch,
the Auto-On Headlight System (when the
lighting switch is in the “AUTO” position)
and the Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.)
system.
(4)
(3)
(1)
(2)
79K014
65D611
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
52D183
2-75
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
The three systems work together to operate your lights as shown in the following chart:
E/G: Engine
IG: Ignition switch
ON: Lights ON
LIGHT: When it is light around the light sensor (5).
DARK: When it is dark around the light sensor (5).
Lighting
switch
position
IG OFF
Main lights to
be operated
D.R.L.
(1) OFF
(2) AUTO
(3)
(4)
(4)
(3)
IG ON
E/G OFF
E/G OFF
E/G RUNNING
LIGHT
DARK
LIGHT
DARK
LIGHT
DARK
–
–
–
–
ON
ON
(2)
(1)
Position lights,
Tail lights
–
–
–
–
–
–
Head lights
–
–
–
–
–
–
D.R.L.
–
–
–
–
ON
–
Position lights,
Tail lights
–
–
–
ON
–
ON
Head lights
–
–
–
ON
–
ON
D.R.L.
–
–
–
–
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Head lights
–
–
–
–
–
–
D.R.L.
–
–
–
–
–
–
Position lights,
Tail lights
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Head lights
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Position lights,
Tail lights
Lighting Operation
79K015
To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob
on the end of the lever. There are four positions:
OFF (1)
All lights are off.
AUTO (2)
Refer to “Auto-On Headlight system” for
details.
(3)
Front position lights, tail-lights, license
plate light and instrument lights are on, but
headlights are off.
(4)
Front position lights, tail-lights, license
plate light, instrument lights and head
lights are on.
2-76
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Auto-On Headlight System
WARNING
HIGH
It takes about 5 seconds for the light
sensor to react to a change in lighting conditions. To help avoid an accident due to reduced visibility, turn on
your headlights before driving into a
tunnel, parking structure or the like.
LOW
(5)
NOTE:
This system does not react to all types of
ambient light. As the sensor is infrared
type, it will not work correctly with ambient
lights that do not contain infrared rays.
PASS
79K016
With the headlights on, push the lever forward to switch to the high beams or pull
the lever toward you to switch to the low
beams. When the high beams are on, a
light on the instrument panel will come on.
To momentarily activate the high beams as
a passing signal, pull the lever slightly
toward you and release it when you have
completed the signal.
66J026
The Auto-on headlight system automatically turns on all lights that are operated by
the lighting control lever on the steering
column, when the following four conditions
are all met.
Conditions for Auto-on headlight system
operation:
1) It is dark around the light sensor (5).
2) The lighting control lever in the “AUTO”
position.
3) The ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
4) The parking brake is released.
This system is operated by the signal from
the light sensor (5) on the right end of the
instrument panel. Do not cover the sensor
(5). If you do, the system will not work correctly.
2-77
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.)
System
The headlights light, but are dimmer than
the low beam, when the following three
conditions are all met. Also, the D.R.L. indicator light on the instrument panel comes
on.
Front Fog Light Switch
(if equipped)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Conditions for D.R.L. system operation:
1) The engine is running.
2) The parking brake is released.
3) The headlights are off, or the lighting
switch in the “AUTO” position and it is
light around the light sensor.
NOTE:
Be sure to turn the headlights on at night
or at any time of the day when driving or
weather conditions require the headlights
to operate at full brightness and the taillights to be on.
Lights “On” reminder
A buzzer sounds to remind you to turn off
the lights if they are left on when the ignition key is removed and the driver’s door is
opened.
65D611
64J058
The front fog light comes on when the fog
light switch is pushed in with:
• the headlights are on and the beams set
to the low beam position, or
• the auto-on headlight system on and the
beams set to the low beam position.
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
NOTE:
The warning and indicator message and
the illumination indicator light will be shown
on the information display when this
reminder is activated.
2-78
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Turn Signal Operation
With the ignition switch in the “ON” position, move the lever up or down to activate
the right or left turn signals.
Hazard Warning Switch
Windshield Wiper and Washer
Lever
64J054
Push in the hazard warning switch to activate the hazard warning lights. All turn signal lights and both turn signal indicators
will flash simultaneously. To turn off the
lights, push the switch again.
79K017
Normal turn signal
Move the lever all the way upward or downward to signal. When the turn is completed, the signal will cancel and the lever
will return to its normal position.
Use the hazard warning lights to warn
other traffic during emergency parking or
when your vehicle could otherwise become
a traffic hazard.
65D611
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
Lane change signal
Some times, such as changing lanes, the
steering wheel is not turned far enough to
cancel the turn signal. For convenience,
you can flash the turn signal by moving the
lever part way and holding it there. The
lever will return to its normal position when
you release it.
2-79
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Windshield Wipers
Windshield Washer
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
MIST
OFF
INT
LO
HI
63J302
63J301
To turn the windshield wipers on, move the
lever up and down to one of the four operating positions. In the “INT” position (if
equipped), the wipers operate intermittently. The “INT” position is very convenient
for driving in mist or light rain. In the “LO”
position, the wipers operate at a steady
low speed. In the “HI” position, the wipers
operate at a steady high speed. To turn off
the wipers, move the lever back to the
“OFF” position.
Move the lever up and hold it to the “MIST”
position, the windshield wipers will turn on
continuously at low speed.
If the lever is equipped with the “INT TIME”
control, turn the control forward or rearward to adjust the intermittent wiper operation to the desired interval.
63J303
To spray windshield washer fluid, pull the
lever toward you. The windshield wipers
will automatically turn on at low speed if
they are not already on and if the “INT”
position is equipped.
WARNING
• To prevent windshield icing in cold
weather, turn on the defroster to
heat the windshield before and during windshield washer use.
• Do not use radiator antifreeze in
the windshield washer reservoir. It
can severely impair visibility when
sprayed on the windshield, and can
also damage your vehicle’s paint.
2-80
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
CAUTION
To help prevent damage to windshield wiper and washer system
components, you should take the following precautions:
• Do not continue to hold in the lever
when there is no windshield
washer fluid being sprayed or the
washer motor can be damaged.
• Do not attempt to remove dirt from
a dry windshield with the wipers or
you can damage the windshield
and the wiper blades. Always wet
the windshield with washer fluid
before operating the wipers.
• Clear ice or packed snow from the
wiper blades before using the wipers.
• Check the washer fluid level regularly. Check it often when the
weather is bad.
• Only fill the washer fluid reservoir
3/4 full during cold weather to allow
room for expansion if the temperature falls low enough to freeze the
solution.
CAUTION
EXAMPLE
Washer
Wiper
Clear ice or snow from the rear window and rear wiper blade before
using the rear wiper. Accumulated ice
or snow could prevent the wiper
blade from moving, causing damage
to the wiper motor.
Intermittent wiper
63J304
To turn the rear wiper on, twist the rear
wiper switch on the end of the lever forward to the “ON” position. If your vehicle is
equipped with the “INT” position, the rear
wiper operates intermittently when you
twist the switch forward to the “INT” position. To turn the rear wiper off, twist the
switch rearward to the “OFF” position.
To spray window washer fluid, twist the
switch rearward from the “OFF” position, or
twist the switch forward from the “ON” position. The rear wiper will turn on automatically while spraying the window washer
fluid.
2-81
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
Tilt Steering Lock Lever
Horn
Rear Window Defroster and
Outside Rearview Mirrors
Defroster (if equipped) Switch
EXAMPLE
UNLOCK
LOCK
(1)
78K074
When the rear window is fogged, push this
switch to clear the window.
EXAMPLE
64J037
78K130
The lock lever is located under the steering
column. To adjust the steering wheel
height:
Press the horn pad on the steering wheel
to sound the horn. The horn will sound with
the ignition switch in any position.
1) Pull up the lock lever to unlock the
steering column.
2) Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
height and lock the steering column by
pulling down the lock lever.
3) Try moving the steering wheel up and
down to make sure it is securely locked
in position.
WARNING
Never attempt to adjust the steering
wheel height while the vehicle is
moving or you could lose control of
the vehicle.
(2)
64J258
If the outside rearview mirror has the mark
(2), it is also equipped with the outside
rearview mirrors defroster. When you push
the switch (1), both the outside rearview
mirrors defroster and the rear window
defroster will operate simultaneously.
2-82
79K21-03E
BEFORE DRIVING
An indicator light will be lit when the
defroster is on. The defroster will only work
when the engine is running. To turn off the
defroster, push the switch (1) again.
CAUTION
The rear window defroster and the
outside rearview mirrors use a large
amount of electricity. Be sure to turn
off the defroster after the window has
become clear.
NOTE:
• The defogger will work only when the
engine is running.
• The defogger will automatically turn off
after the defogger remains on for 15 minutes to prevent discharging of the battery.
2-83
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Exhaust Gas Warning ......................................................... 3-1
Daily Inspection Checklist .................................................. 3-2
Ignition Switch ..................................................................... 3-3
Parking Brake Lever ........................................................... 3-7 3
Pedals ................................................................................... 3-8
Starting the Engine ............................................................. 3-9
Engine Block Heater (if equipped) ..................................... 3-10
Using the Transmission ..................................................... 3-11
Using the Transfer Switch (if equipped) ........................... 3-15
Cruise Control ..................................................................... 3-26
Braking ................................................................................. 3-28
Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) ................................. 3-31
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
(if equipped) ......................................................................... 3-37
60G408
79K21-03E
Exhaust Gas Warning: NO
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Exhaust Gas Warning
WARNING
52D334
WARNING
Avoid breathing exhaust gases.
Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, a potentially lethal gas that is
colorless and odorless. Since carbon
monoxide is difficult to detect by
itself, be sure to take the following
precautions to help prevent carbon
monoxide from entering your vehicle.
• Do not leave the engine running in
garages or other confined areas.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not park with the engine running for a long period of time, even
in an open area. If it is necessary to
sit for a short time in a parked vehicle with the engine running, make
sure the air intake lever is set to
“FRESH AIR” and the fan is at high
speed.
• Avoid operating the vehicle with
the rear door, tailgate or rear window open. If it is necessary to operate the vehicle with the rear door,
tailgate or rear window open, make
sure the folding sunroof (if
equipped) and all the windows are
closed, and the fan is at high speed
with the air intake selector set to
“FRESH AIR”.
• To allow proper operation of your
vehicle’s ventilation system, keep
the air inlet grille in front of the
windshield clear of snow, leaves or
other obstructions at all times.
• Keep the exhaust tailpipe area clear
of snow and other material to help
reduce the buildup of exhaust
gases under the vehicle. This is
particularly important when parked
in blizzard conditions.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Have the exhaust system inspected
periodically for damage and leaks.
Any damage or leaks should be
repaired immediately.
3-1
79K21-03E
Daily Inspection Checklist: NO
Starting the Engine: 1
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Daily Inspection Checklist
Before Driving
60A187S
1) Make sure that windows, mirrors, lights
and reflectors are clean and unobstructed.
2) Visually check the tires for the following
points:
– the depth of the tread groove
– abnormal wear, cracks and damage
– loose wheel nuts
– existence of foreign material such as
nails, stones, etc.
Refer to “Tires” in “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section for details.
3) Look for fluid, oil leaks.
NOTE:
It is normal for water to drip from the air
conditioning system after use.
4) Make sure the hood is fully closed and
latched.
5) Check the headlights, turn signal lights,
brake lights and horn for proper operation.
6) Lock all doors.
7) Adjust the seat and adjustable head
restraints (if equipped).
8) Check the brake pedal and the parking
brake lever.
9) Adjust the mirrors.
10)Make sure that you and all passengers
have properly fastened your seat belts.
11)Make sure that all warning lights come
on as the key is turned to the “ON” position.
12)Check all gauges.
13)Make sure that the BRAKE SYSTEM
WARNING light turns off when the
parking brake is released.
ing for proper latch operation. See the
item “All Latches, Hinges and Locks” of
“CHASSIS AND BODY” in the “Periodic
Maintenance
Schedule”
in
the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
section for lubrication schedule.
WARNING
Make sure the hood is fully closed
and latched before driving. If it is not,
it can fly up unexpectedly during
driving, obstructing your view and
resulting in an accident.
Once a month, or each time you fill your
fuel tank, check the tire pressure using a
tire pressure gauge. Also check the tire
pressure of the spare tire.
Once a week, or each time you fill your fuel
tank, perform the following under-hood
checks:
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
Engine oil level
Coolant level
Brake fluid level
Power steering (if equipped) fluid level
Windshield washer fluid level
Battery solution level
Hood latch operation
Pull the hood release handle inside the
vehicle. Make sure that you cannot
open the hood all the way without
releasing the secondary latch. Be sure
to close the hood securely after check-
3-2
79K21-03E
Starting the Engine: 1
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Ignition Switch
Vehicle Without Keyless Start System
Manual transmission
EXAMPLE
Push
Turn to “LOCK”
60A055
65D611
60B041
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
The ignition switch has the following four
positions:
LOCK
This is the normal parking position. It is the
only position in which the key can be
removed.
It locks the ignition, and prevents normal
use of the steering wheel after the key is
removed.
• Manual transmission vehicles
You must push in the key to turn it to the
“LOCK” position. It locks the ignition, and
prevents normal use of the steering
wheel after the key is removed.
• Automatic transmission vehicles
The gearshift lever must be in the “P”
(Park) position to turn the key to the
“LOCK” position. It locks the ignition and
prevents normal use of the steering
wheel and gearshift lever.
To release the steering lock, insert the key
and turn it clockwise to one of the other
positions. If you have trouble turning the
key to unlock the steering, try turning the
steering wheel slightly to the right or left
while turning the key.
3-3
79K21-03E
Starting the Engine: 1
Engine Block Heater: 1
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
ACC
Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off.
Vehicle With Keyless Start System
(3)
ON
This is the normal operating position. All
electrical systems are on.
START
This is the position for starting the engine
using the starter motor. The key should be
released from this position as soon as the
engine starts.
Ignition key reminder
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the
ignition switch when the driver’s door is
opened.
(2)
(4)
(1)
EXAMPLE
79K116
56KN076
The ignition switch can be operated without using an ignition key when the remote
controller is in an area of the vehicle other
than the rear luggage area. To turn the
ignition switch, first push in the switch.
• Manual transmission vehicle
You must push in the ignition switch to
turn it from the “LOCK” position to the
“ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK”
position from the “ACC” position, turn the
ignition switch counterclockwise while
pushing in the switch.
• Automatic transmission vehicle
To turn the ignition switch, push the
switch.
If the keyless start system blue indicator
light illuminates on the instrument cluster,
you can turn the ignition switch. If the red
indicator light illuminates, you cannot turn
the ignition switch.
NOTE:
• The ignition switch can be turned to the
“ACC” position when the keyless start
system blue indicator light illuminates.
The blue indicator light will illuminate for
several seconds when you push in the
ignition switch and then will turn off to
protect the system. In this case, you
must release the ignition switch and
push it in again to illuminate the blue
indicator light.
• If the keyless start system red indicator
light illuminates, the remote controller
may not be in the vehicle or the battery
3-4
79K21-03E
Engine Block Heater: 1
Using the Transmission: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
of the remote controller may be unreliable.
NOTE:
• If the battery of the remote controller
runs down or there are strong radio
waves or noise, the operating range may
be narrower or the remote controller may
be inoperative.
• If the remote controller is too close to the
door, it may not operate.
• The ignition switch may not turn when
the remote controller is on the instrument panel, in the glove box, in a storage compartment, in the sun visor or on
the floor.
CAUTION
The remote controller is a sensitive
electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller:
• Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by
leaving it on the dashboard under
direct sunlight.
• Keep the remote controller away
from magnetic objects such as a
television.
You can also turn the ignition switch by
inserting the ignition key into the slot.
The ignition switch has the following four
positions:
If you leave any of the doors open with the
ignition switch in the “ACC” position for a
while (and no key inserted), the engine
may not start when you turn the ignition
switch to “START”. If the engine does not
start, close all doors completely or turn the
ignition switch back to the “LOCK” position,
then start the engine.
LOCK (1)
This is the normal parking position. It is the
only position in which the key can be
removed. It locks the ignition, and prevents
normal use of the steering wheel.
For vehicles with an automatic transmission, the gearshift lever must be in the “P”
(Park) position to turn the key to the
“LOCK” position.
To release the steering lock, turn the ignition switch clockwise to one of the other
positions. If you have trouble turning the
ignition switch to unlock the steering, try
turning the steering wheel slightly to the
right or left while turning the switch.
• Manual transmission vehicle
You must push in the ignition switch to
turn it from the “LOCK” position to the
“ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK”
position from the “ACC” position, turn the
ignition switch counterclockwise while
pushing in the switch.
• Automatic transmission vehicle
To turn the ignition switch, push the
switch.
ACC (2)
Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off.
3-5
79K21-03E
Using the Transmission: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
ON (3)
This is the normal operating position. All
electrical systems are on.
You can also turn the ignition switch by
inserting the ignition key into the slot.
START (4)
This is the position for starting the engine
using the starter motor. The switch should
be released from this position as soon as
the engine starts.
Ignition switch reminder
(When using the keyless start system)
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to return the ignition switch to the
“LOCK” position if it is in the “ACC” position
when the driver’s door is opened.
(1)
80JM139
The ignition switch cap (1) is installed to
make the ignition switch turn easily.
If you use the ignition key to turn the ignition switch, remove the cap (1) by pinching
both side of the cap and pull it out.
NOTE:
If you remove the cap, be careful not to
lose it.
81A297S
WARNING
• Never return the ignition switch to
the “LOCK” position and remove
the ignition key while the vehicle is
moving. The steering wheel will
lock and you will not be able to
steer the vehicle.
(Continued)
Ignition key reminder
(When using the ignition key)
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the
ignition switch when the driver’s door is
opened.
3-6
79K21-03E
Using the Transmission: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
(Continued)
• Always return the ignition switch to
the “LOCK” position and remove
the ignition key and the remote
controller (if equipped) when leaving the vehicle even if only for a
short time. Also do not leave children or pets alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could
cause accidental movement of the
vehicle or could tamper with power
windows or a power sunroof. Children or pets could also suffer from
heatstroke in warm or hot weather,
which could result in severe injury
or even death.
CAUTION
• Do not turn the starter motor for
more than 15 seconds at a time. If
the engine does not start, wait 15
seconds before trying again. If the
engine does not start after several
attempts, check the fuel and ignition systems or consult your
SUZUKI dealer.
• Do not leave the ignition switch in
the “ON” position if the engine is
not running or the battery will discharge.
Parking Brake Lever
cult to shift out of “P” when you are ready
to drive the vehicle. When preparing to
drive the vehicle, move the gearshift lever
out of the “P” position before releasing the
parking brake.
EXAMPLE
(1)
WARNING
(2)
(3)
64J081
(1) To set
(2) To release
(3) To release
The parking brake lever is located between
the seats. To set the parking brake, hold
the brake pedal down and pull the parking
brake lever all the way up. To release the
parking brake, hold the brake pedal down,
pull up slightly on the parking brake lever,
push the button on the end of the lever with
your thumb and lower the lever to its original position.
For automatic transmission vehicles,
always set the parking brake before moving the gearshift lever to the “P” (Park)
position. If you park on an incline and shift
into “P” before you set the parking brake,
the weight of the vehicle may make it diffi-
• Never drive your vehicle with the
parking brake set: rear brake effectiveness can be reduced from overheating, brake life may be
shortened or permanent brake
damage may result.
• If the parking brake does not hold
the vehicle securely or does not
fully release, have your vehicle
inspected immediately by an authorized SUZUKI dealer.
WARNING
Always set the parking brake fully
before leaving your vehicle or it may
move, causing injury or damage.
When parking, make sure the gearshift lever for manual transmission
vehicles is in 1st gear or “R”
(Reverse) and the gearshift lever for
automatic transmission vehicles is in
“P” (Park). Never leave the transfer
lever (if equipped) in “N” (Neutral)
when you are parked. Remember,
even though the transmission is in
gear or in Park, you must set the
parking brake fully.
3-7
79K21-03E
Using the Transmission: 10
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Pedals
Clutch Pedal (1)
(For manual transmission)
The clutch pedal is used to disengage the
drive to the wheels when starting the
engine, stopping or shifting the gearshift
lever or transfer lever (if equipped).
Depressing the pedal disengages the
clutch.
Manual transmission
EXAMPLE
CAUTION
(3)
(2)
(1)
64J082
Automatic transmission
Do not drive with your foot resting on
the clutch pedal. It could result in
excessive clutch wear, clutch damage, or unexpected loss of engine
braking.
WARNING
Do not “ride” the brakes by applying
them continuously or resting your
foot on the pedal. This will result in
overheating of the brakes which
could cause unpredictable braking
action, longer stopping distances or
permanent brake damage.
Accelerator Pedal (3)
This pedal controls the speed of the
engine. Depressing the accelerator pedal
increases power output and speed.
Brake Pedal (2)
Your SUZUKI vehicle is equipped with front
and rear disc brakes. Depressing the brake
pedal applies both sets of brakes.
EXAMPLE
You may hear occasional brake squeal
when you apply the brakes. This is a normal condition caused by environmental
factors such as cold, wet, snow, etc.
WARNING
(2)
(3)
If brake squeal is excessive and
occurs each time the brakes are
applied, you should have the brakes
checked by your SUZUKI dealer.
64J083
3-8
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Starting the Engine
NOTE:
Automatic transmission vehicles have a
starter interlock device which is designed
to keep the starter from operating if the
transmission is in any of the drive positions.
Before Starting the Engine
WARNING
Make sure that the parking brake is
set fully and the transmission is in
Neutral (or Park for vehicles with an
automatic
transmission)
before
attempting to start the engine.
Starting a Cold Engine
64J140
1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully.
2) Manual Transmission – Shift into “N”
(Neutral) and depress the clutch pedal
all the way to the floor.
Hold the clutch pedal while starting the
engine.
Automatic Transmission – If the gearshift lever is not in “P” (Park) position,
shift into “P”. (If you need to re-start the
engine while the vehicle is moving, shift
into “N”.)
NOTE:
The engine of manual transmission vehicle
will not start unless the clutch pedal is
depressed.
1/3 of its travel and try cranking the engine
again. Release the key and accelerator
pedal when the engine starts.
If the engine still does not start, try holding
the accelerator pedal all the way to the
floor while cranking. This should clear the
engine if it is flooded.
If you are unable to start the engine using
this procedure, consult your SUZUKI
dealer.
Starting a Warm Engine
Use the same procedure as for “Starting a
Cold Engine”.
With your foot off the accelerator pedal,
crank the engine by turning the ignition key
to “START”. Release the key when the
engine starts.
CAUTION
• Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or
the starter system can be damaged.
• Do not crank the engine for more
than 15 seconds at a time. If the
engine doesn’t start on the first try,
wait about 15 seconds before trying again.
If the engine does not start after 15 seconds of cranking, wait about 15 seconds,
then press down the accelerator pedal to
3-9
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Engine Block Heater
(if equipped)
NOTE:
Activate the heater at least four hours
before you start the engine. However, as
the heating time varies depending on the
ambient temperature and other factors,
adjust the time by observing the engine
cranking condition.
EXAMPLE
3) Close the engine hood securely before
starting the engine.
WARNING
79K040
The engine block heater will help you start
the engine more easily in very cold
weather (–18°C (0°F) or below). To use the
engine block heater:
1) Turn off the engine.
2) Open the engine hood.
3) Untie the block heater cord and remove
the block heater plug cap. When the
engine block heater is not in use,
ensure the heater cord is secured to
prevent contact with any moving parts.
4) Using a heavy-duty, three-prong
grounded extension cord, plug the
female end into the block heater socket
and the male end into a normal,
grounded 110-volt AC outlet.
To avoid serious personal injury
caused by electrical shock or fire:
• Do not plug the cord into a nongrounded outlet. Only use a properly grounded three-prong 110-volt
AC outlet.
• Do not use a 2-wire (non-grounded)
extension cord.
• Only use a heavy-duty, three-prong
extension cord rated for at least 15
amps.
After using the block heater:
1) Unplug the extension cord and reinstall
the plug cap.
2) Tie the block heater cord back to its
original position.
CAUTION
Secure the block heater cord back to
its original position or to the routed
position. A loose cord could get
caught in the engine accessory drive
belt(s) or other moving parts.
3-10
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Using the Transmission
5-Speed Automatic Transmission
WARNING
Manual Transmission
65D449
Starting off
To start off, depress the clutch pedal all the
way to the floor and shift into 1st gear.
After releasing the parking brake, gradually
release the clutch. When you hear a
change in the engine’s sound, slowly press
the accelerator while continuing to gradually release the clutch.
Shifting
All forward gears are synchronized, which
provides for quiet, and easy shifting.
Always push in the clutch pedal fully before
shifting gears. Make sure the engine speed
does not rise into the red zone of the
tachometer.
• Reduce your speed and downshift
to a lower gear before going down
a long or steep hill. Downshifting
will allow the engine to provide
braking. Avoid riding the brakes or
they may overheat, resulting in
brake failure.
• When driving on slippery roads, be
sure to slow down before downshifting.
Large
and
sudden
changes in engine speed may
cause loss of traction, which could
cause you to lose control.
• Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before you shift
into reverse.
66J003
D:
5-speed automatic transmission mode
4:
4-speed automatic transmission mode
CAUTION
• To help avoid clutch damage, do
not use the clutch pedal as a footrest while driving or use the clutch
to keep the vehicle stationary on a
hill. Depress the clutch fully when
shifting.
• When shifting or starting off, do not
race the engine. Racing the engine
can shorten engine life and affect
smooth shifting.
The 4-speed mode is suitable for the following driving conditions:
• Driving on hilly, winding roads
– You can drive more smoothly with less
frequent gearshifting
• Going down a steep hill
– Some engine braking is provided
NOTE:
With the transfer switch in the “4L LOCK”
position, the 5-speed automatic transmission will remain in the 4-speed mode.
3-11
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Gearshift lever
Use the gearshift lever positions as
described below:
speed is, the more you will need to press
the accelerator pedal to get a downshift.
P (Park)
Use this position to lock the transmission
when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Shift into Park only when
the vehicle is completely stopped.
4 (Low 3)
Use this position for driving on moderate
uphill and downhill gradients. The engine
braking effect on moderate downhills can
be used in this position. The transmission
shifts up only to 4th gear.
WARNING
If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle,
never leave the transfer switch in “N”
(Neutral) position when parked.
Otherwise the vehicle may roll even if
the transmission is in Park.
66J004
The gearshift lever is designed that it cannot be shifted out of the “P” position unless
the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
and the brake pedal is depressed.
WARNING
Always depress the brake pedal
before shifting from “P” (Park) (or
“N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is stationary) to a forward or reverse gear, to
help prevent the vehicle from moving
unexpectedly when you shift.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to back the vehicle from
stop. Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before shifting into
Reverse.
N (Neutral)
Use this position for starting the engine if
the engine stalls and you need to restart it
while the vehicle is moving. You may also
shift into Neutral and depress the brake
pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during
idling.
3 (Low 2)
Use this position to provide extra power
when climbing hills, or to provide engine
braking when going down hills.
L (Low 1)
Use this position to provide maximum
power when climbing steep hills or driving
through deep snow or mud, or to provide
maximum engine braking when going
down steep hills.
NOTE:
If you move the gearshift lever to a lower
gear while driving faster than the maximum
allowable speed for the lower gear, the
transmission will not actually downshift
until your speed drops below the maximum
speed for the lower gear.
D (Drive)
Use this position for all normal driving.
With the selector in “D” range, you can get
an automatic downshift by pressing the
accelerator pedal. The higher the vehicle
3-12
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
4-Speed Automatic Transmission
Gearshift lever
CAUTION
Be sure to take the following precautions to help avoid damage to the
automatic transmission:
• Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before shifting into
“P” or “R”.
• Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”,
“D”, “4”, “3” or “L” when the
engine is running above idle speed.
• Do not rev the engine with the
transmission in a drive position
(“R”, “D”, “4”, “3” or “L”) and the
rear wheels not moving.
• Do not use the accelerator to hold
the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehicle’s brakes.
EXAMPLE
64J142
79K027
D:
4-speed automatic transmission mode
3:
3-speed automatic transmission mode
The 3-speed mode is suitable for the following driving conditions:
• Driving on hilly, winding roads
– You can drive more smoothly with less
frequent gearshifting
• Going down a steep hill
– Some engine braking is provided
The gearshift lever is designed that it cannot be shifted out of the “P” position unless
the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
and the brake pedal is depressed.
WARNING
Always depress the brake pedal
before shifting from “P” (Park) (or
“N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is stationary) to a forward or reverse gear, to
help prevent the vehicle from moving
unexpectedly when you shift.
NOTE:
With the transfer switch in the “4L LOCK”
position, the 4-speed automatic transmission will remain in the 3-speed mode.
3-13
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Use the gearshift lever positions as
described below:
D (Drive)
Use this position for all normal driving.
P (Park)
Use this position to lock the transmission
when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Shift into Park only when
the vehicle is completely stationary.
With the gearshift lever in “D” range you
can get an automatic downshift by pressing the accelerator pedal. The higher the
vehicle speed is, the more you need to
press the accelerator pedal to get a downshift.
WARNING
If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle,
never leave the transfer switch in “N”
(Neutral) position when parked.
Otherwise the vehicle may roll even if
the transmission is in Park.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to reverse the vehicle
from stop. Make sure that vehicle is completely stationary before shifting into
Reverse.
N (Neutral)
Use this position for starting the engine if
the engine stalls and you need to restart it
while the vehicle is moving. You may also
shift into Neutral and depress the brake
pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during
idling.
3 (Low 3)
Use this position for driving on moderate
uphill and downhill gradients. The engine
braking effect on moderate downhills can
be used in this position. The transmission
shifts up only to 3rd gear.
2 (Low 2)
Use this position to provide extra power
when climbing hills, or to provide engine
braking when going down hills.
CAUTION
Be sure to take the following precautions to help avoid damage to the
automatic transmission:
• Make sure that the vehicle is completely stationary before shifting
into “P” or “R”.
• Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”,
“D”, “3”, “2”, or “L” when the
engine is running above idle speed.
• Do not rev the engine with the
transmission in a drive position
(“R”, “D”, “3”, “2”, or “L”) and the
rear wheels not moving.
• Do not use the accelerator to hold
the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehicle’s brakes.
L (Low 1)
Use this position to provide maximum
power when climbing steep hills or driving
through deep snow or mud, or to provide
maximum engine braking when going
down steep hills.
NOTE:
If you move the gearshift lever to a lower
gear while driving faster than the maximum
allowable speed for the lower gear, the
transmission will not actually downshift
until your speed drops below the maximum
speed for the lower gear.
3-14
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
If You Cannot Shift Automatic
Transmission Gearshift Lever Out
of “P” (PARK)
5) With inserting the key or the flat end rod
into the slot in the hole, shift the gearshift lever to the desired position.
Using the Transfer Switch
(if equipped)
This procedure is for emergency use only.
If repeated use of this procedure is necessary, or the procedure does not work as
described, take the vehicle to your dealer
for repair.
(1)
78K043
66J168
Vehicles with an automatic transmission
have an electrically operated park-lock feature. If the vehicle’s battery is discharged,
or there is some other electrical failure, the
automatic transmission cannot be shifted
out of Park in the normal way. Jump starting may correct the condition. If not, follow
the procedure described below. This procedure will permit shifting the transmission
out of Park.
Your vehicle is equipped with a four-mode
full-time 4x4 system. You can use the
transfer switch to select any of the four
modes: N, 4H, 4H LOCK, 4L LOCK.
1) Be sure the parking brake is firmly
applied.
2) If the engine is running, stop the
engine.
3) Make sure the key is in the “ON” or
“ACC” position.
4) Remove the cover (1) on the hole.
3-15
79K21-03E
Using the Transfer Switch: 10
Braking: 6
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
(4)
(2)
(3)
(6)
(7)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(9)
(5)
Front differential
Engine
Transmission
High/Low clutch
Transfer case
Center differential
Differential lock clutch
Chain
Rear propeller shaft
Rear differential
Front propeller shaft
(8)
(10)
(1)
(11)
64J143
3-16
79K21-03E
Braking: 6
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Description of Transfer Switch Positions
In this position, engine power is not supplied to the front or rear axles. Only use
this position for towing your vehicle.
When you turn the transfer switch to the
“N” position, “N” indicator will come on with
the buzzer sound.
N (Neutral)
WARNING
Never leave the transfer switch in “N”
(Neutral) when parked.
When the transfer switch is in “N”
(Neutral), the vehicle may roll even if
the transmission is in gear or in Park.
64J223
3-17
79K21-03E
Braking: 6
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
4H (4-wheel drive high range)
In this position, engine power is supplied to
the front and rear axles. Use this position
for normal driving.
64J220
3-18
79K21-03E
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS):
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
4H LOCK (4-wheel drive high range center differential lock)
In this position, engine power is supplied to
the front and rear axles and you get better
traction than when driving in “4H”. Use this
position when you need better traction
than “4H” provides, such as when driving
on slippery roads etc.
64J221
3-19
79K21-03E
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS):
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
4L LOCK (4-wheel drive low range center differential lock)
In this position, engine power is supplied to
the front and rear axles and you get better
traction and more low-speed torque than
when driving in “4H”. Use this position
when you need better traction than “4H”
provides and more low-speed torque than
“4H LOCK” provides, such as when climbing or descending steep, slippery hills etc.
NOTE:
When the transfer switch (if equipped) is
turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the
ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be
canceled to provide improved vehicle traction, and the “ESP OFF” indicator light will
come on.
When the transfer switch (if equipped) is
turned to the “4L LOCK” position, braketraction control can be activated. Braketraction control brakes the spinning wheel
to distribute drive power to the other
wheels for increased climbing ability or for
better performance on a rolling hill or a
slippery surface.
ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler
AG.
64J222
3-20
79K21-03E
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS):
Break-In: 6
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Transfer Switch Operation
Operate the transfer switch according to
the appropriate procedure described
below:
From N to 4H
Stop the vehicle completely, place the
transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress
the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully
(if equipped), then push in and turn the
switch to shift into “4H”.
From 4H to 4H LOCK
You can operate the transfer switch either
when the vehicle is stopped or while the
vehicle is moving.
Position the front wheels straight ahead
and turn the switch to shift into “4H LOCK”.
If the vehicle is moving, we recommend
that the speed be less than 100 km/h (60
mph) during this operation.
CAUTION
Do not operate the transfer switch
while tires are racing.
NOTE:
If it is difficult to shift between “4H” and “4H
LOCK” while the vehicle is moving, try
accelerating and decelerating your vehicle
several times after turning the transfer
switch. Be sure to wait until traffic conditions allow you to accelerate and decelerate safety before using this procedure.
From 4H LOCK to 4L LOCK
Stop the vehicle completely, place the
transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress
the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully
(if equipped), then push in and turn the
switch to shift into “4L LOCK”.
From 4H to N
(1)
From 4L LOCK to 4H LOCK
Stop the vehicle completely, place the
transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress
the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully
(if equipped), then push in and turn the
switch to shift into “4H LOCK”.
From 4H LOCK to 4H
You can operate the transfer switch either
when the vehicle is stopped or while the
vehicle is moving.
Position the front wheels straight ahead
and turn the switch to shift into “4H”. If the
vehicle is moving, we recommend that the
speed be less than 100 km/h (60 mph) during this operation.
CAUTION
Do not operate the transfer switch
while tires are racing.
64J209
Stop the vehicle completely, place the
transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress
the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully
(if equipped), then push in and turn the
switch to the mark (1) at the left of the “N”
position, and hold the switch in this position for 5 seconds until the “N” indicator
blinks, then turn the switch to the “N” position.
When you turn the transfer switch to the
“N” position, “N” indicator will come on with
the buzzer sound.
NOTE:
If it is difficult to shift between “4H” and “4H
LOCK” while the vehicle is moving, try
accelerating and decelerating your vehicle
several times after turning the transfer
switch. Be sure to wait until traffic conditions allow you to accelerate and decelerate safety before using this procedure.
3-21
79K21-03E
Catalytic Converter: NO
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION
CAUTION
• Be sure to stop the vehicle completely before operating the transfer switch to shift between “N” and
“4H”, or between “4H LOCK” and
“4L LOCK”.
• Do not shift between “4H” and “4H
LOCK” unless the front wheels are
in the straight-ahead position and
we recommend that the vehicle
speed be less than 100 km/h (60
mph).
Do not operate the transfer switch
while tires are racing.
• Do not operate your vehicle in “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry, hard
surfaces.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not operate the vehicle while a
4WD mode indicator is blinking
except when shifting between “4H”
and “4L LOCK”.
If you operate the vehicle while a
4WD mode indicator is blinking, a
buzzer will sound and the transfer
will shift to “N” (Neutral) to prevent
transfer case damage.
In this case, use the following procedure.
1) Release your foot from the accelerator pedal and depress the
brake pedal to stop the vehicle
completely.
2) Depress the clutch pedal fully (if
equipped) or shift the automatic
transmission gearshift lever to the
“N” position.
3) If the transfer does not shift from
“N” although you perform 1) and
2), turn the transfer switch to the
position previously selected and
operate the switch again.
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when the transfer
system is operated, or has a problem.
3-22
79K21-03E
Catalytic Converter: NO
Improving Fuel Economy: NO
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
The basic operation for transfer switch
Current Position
Current Indicator
N
Target Position
Target Indicator
4H
–
N
4H
–
4H LOCK
4H
–
4H LOCK
4L LOCK
4L LOCK
4H LOCK
N: Neutral
4H: 4-wheel drive high range mode
4H LOCK: 4-wheel drive high range center differential lock mode
4L LOCK: 4-wheel drive low range center differential lock mode
3-23
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Warning and Indicator messages
Transfer Switch
Warning and Indicator messages
Operation
In any position
Master Warning
Indicator
Sound
Cause and Remedy
Blinks
Off
There may be a problem with the 4WD
system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer.
Blinks
Series of
Beeps
This message informs you that the
transfer switch is in “N”, which is used
only for towing your vehicle.
Move the transfer switch to a different
position unless you are planning to tow
your vehicle.
Off
Off
This message informs you the 4WD
mode is switching.
Blinks
Off
Tires are slipping.
Turn the transfer switch to “4H LOCK”
position.
79K074
In “N” position
79K077
Switching between
“4H” and
“4H LOCK”
79K078
In “4H” position
79K079
3-24
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Transfer Switch
Operation
Warning and Indicator messages
Switching between
“4H LOCK” and
“4L LOCK”
Switching between
“4H” and “N”
Master Warning
Indicator
Sound
Cause and Remedy
Off
Series of
Beeps
(For automatic transmission)
The desired transfer gear has not been
engaged.
Release your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Depress the brake pedal.
Shift the automatic transmission gearshift lever to the “N” position.
Off
Series of
Beeps
(For manual transmission)
The desired transfer gear has not been
engaged.
Release your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Depress the brake pedal and clutch
pedal.
Off
Beep or
Off
The desired transfer gear has not been
engaged.
Turn the transfer switch back to the previously selected position, and operate
the transfer switch again.
Off
Off
This message informs you the 4WD
mode is switching.
Do not move your vehicle.
79K080
79K081
79K082
79K083
3-25
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Cruise Control (if equipped)
To Set Cruising Speed
WARNING
To help avoid loss of vehicle control,
do not use the cruise control system
when driving in heavy traffic, on slippery or winding roads, or on steep
downgrades.
1) Turn on the cruise control system by
pushing the “ON/OFF” switch (1). When
the “CRUISE” indicator light comes on,
you can set cruising speed.
2) Accelerate or decelerate to the desired
speed.
3) Push the “SET/COAST” switch (3) and
turn on the “SET” indicator light. Take
your foot off the accelerator pedal and
the set speed will be maintained.
WARNING
If the cruising speed is set by accident, you cannot decelerate or could
loose control of the vehicle. This
could lead to an accident, resulting in
severe injury or death.
(2)
79K032
(4)
(1)
The cruise control system allows you to
maintain a steady speed without keeping
your foot on the accelerator pedal. The
controls for operating the cruise control
system are on the steering wheel.
You can use the cruise control system with
the following conditions:
• For manual transmission vehicle, the
gear position is in 4th or 5th.
• For 4-Speed automatic transmission
vehicle, the gearshift lever is in “D” or “3”
position.
• For 5-Speed automatic transmission
vehicle, the gearshift lever is in “D” or “4”
position.
• The vehicle speed is between approximately 45 km/h (28 mph) or higher.
(3)
79K049
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
“ON/OFF” switch
“CANCEL” switch
“SET/COAST” switch
“RES/ACC” switch
Turn off the cruise control system
and make sure the “CRUISE” indicator light is off when the system is not
in use.
NOTE:
If the transfer switch (if equipped) is in the
“4L LOCK” position, you cannot use the
cruise control system. Refer to “Using the
Transfer Switch (if equipped)” in this section.
3-26
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
To Change Speed Temporarily
“CRUISE” indicator light
When the cruising speed is maintained,
you can temporarily accelerate or decelerate.
To accelerate, depress the accelerator
pedal. When you take your foot off the
pedal, your vehicle will return to the set
speed.
52D113
When you push the “ON/OFF” switch, the
system is on and a “CRUISE” indicator
light on the instrument cluster will be on.
“SET” indicator light
65D474
When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by
the cruise control system, a “SET” indicator light on the instrument cluster will be
on.
To decelerate, depress the brake pedal.
The set speed will be canceled and “SET”
indicator light will go off. To resume the
previously set speed, push the “RES/ACC”
switch (4) and turn on the “SET” indicator
light again when vehicle speed is above 45
km/h (28 mph). The vehicle will accelerate
to and maintain the previously set speed.
NOTE:
For 4-Speed/5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, when the cruising speed is
maintained, you cannot decelerate by
using the engine brake if you shift the gearshift lever from “D” to “3” position for 4Speed automatic transmission vehicle, and
from “D” to “4” position for 5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle.
To decelerate while the cruise control is on,
depress the brake pedal or push the “SET/
COAST” switch (3).
To Change Cruising Speed
Using the accelerator pedal
To reset at a faster cruising speed, accelerate to the desired speed using the accelerator pedal and push the “SET/COAST”
switch (3). The new speed will be maintained.
Using the brake pedal
To reset at a slower cruising speed, decelerate to the desired speed using the brake
pedal and push the “SET/COAST” switch
(3). The new speed will be maintained.
NOTE:
When the brake pedal is depressed, the
“SET” indicator light goes off until reset the
cruising speed.
Using the cruise control switch
To reset at a faster cruising speed, press
repeatedly or hold in the “RES/ACC”
switch (4). Vehicle speed will steadily
increase. When you release the switch, the
new speed will be maintained.
To reset at a slower cruising speed, press
repeatedly or hold in the “SET/COAST”
switch (3) until the vehicle has slowed to
the desired speed, then release the switch.
The new speed will be maintained.
NOTE:
You can adjust the set speed by approximately 1.5 km/h (1.0 mph) by pushing a
cruise control switch quickly.
3-27
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Cancellation of the Cruise Control
The “SET” indicator light will go off and the
cruise control will be canceled temporarily
with following procedures:
• Push the “CANCEL” switch (2).
• Depress the brake pedal.
• For manual transmission, depress the
clutch pedal.
• For 4-Speed automatic transmission
vehicle, shift the gearshift lever into “2”
or “L” position.
• For 5-Speed automatic transmission
vehicle, shift the gearshift lever into “3”,
“2”, or “L” position.
• The vehicle speed falls more than 20
km/h (12.5 mph) below the set speed.
• Any time the vehicle speed falls below
40 km/h (25 mph).
• When the vehicle skids and ESP® (if
equipped) is activated.
To resume the previously set speed, push
the “RES/ACC” switch (4) and turn on the
“SET” indicator light. Besides, the vehicle
speed has to be above 45 km/h (28 mph)
when the vehicle is not in the above conditions.
NOTE:
If you turn off the cruise control system, the
previously set speed in the memory is
cleared. Reset your cruising speed again.
Braking
60G165
The distance needed to bring any vehicle
to a halt increases with the speed of the
vehicle. The braking distance needed, for
example, at 60 km/h (37 mph) will be
approximately 4 times greater than the
braking distance needed at 30 km/h (19
mph). Start to brake the vehicle when there
is plenty of distance between your vehicle
and the stopping point, and slow down
gradually.
To turn off the cruise control system, push
the “ON/OFF” switch (1) and make sure
the “CRUISE” indicator light is off.
Also, if the malfunction indicator light in the
instrument cluster comes on or blinks, the
cruise control system will be turned off.
3-28
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
If water gets into the brake drums,
brake performance may become poor
and unpredictable. After driving
through water or washing the underside of the vehicle, test the brakes
while driving at a slow speed to see if
they have maintained their normal
effectiveness. If the brakes are less
effective than normal, dry them by
repeatedly applying the brakes while
driving slowly until the brakes have
regained their normal effectiveness.
WARNING
Even without reserve power in the
brake system, you can still stop the
vehicle by pressing the brake pedal
harder than normally required. However, the stopping distance may be
longer.
Brake Assist System
When you slam the brakes on, the brake
assist system judges as an emergency
stop and provides more powerful braking
for a driver who cannot hold down the
brake pedal firmly.
Power-Assisted Brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes. If
power assistance is lost due to a stalled
engine or other failures, the system is still
fully operational on reserve power and you
can bring the vehicle to a complete stop by
pressing the brake pedal once and holding
it down. The reserve power is partly used
up when you depress the brake pedal and
reduces each time the pedal is pressed.
Apply smooth and even pressure to the
pedal. Do not pump the pedal.
NOTE:
If you quickly and forcefully depress the
brakes, you may hear a clicking sound in
the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that the brake assist system is activated properly.
ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It
will also help you maintain steering control
when braking on slippery surfaces or when
braking hard.
The ABS works automatically, so you do
not need any special braking technique.
Just push the brake pedal down without
pumping. The ABS will operate whenever it
senses that the wheels are locking up.
You may feel the brake pedal pulsate while
the ABS is operating.
NOTE:
The ABS will not work if vehicle speed is
under about 6 km/h (4 mph).
3-29
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
• On some types of loose surfaces
(such as gravel, snow-covered
roads, etc.), the stopping distance
required for an ABS-equipped vehicle may be slightly greater than for
a comparable vehicle with a conventional brake system. With a
conventional brake system, skidding tires are able to “plow” the
gravel or snow layer, shortening
the stopping distance. ABS minimizes this resistance effect. Allow
for extra stopping distance when
driving on loose surfaces.
• On regular paved roads, some drivers may be able to obtain slightly
shorter stopping distances with
conventional brake systems than
with ABS.
• In both of the above conditions,
ABS will still offer the advantage of
helping you maintain directional
control. However, remember that
ABS will not compensate for bad
road or weather conditions or poor
driver judgment. Use good judgment and do not drive faster than
conditions will safely allow.
WARNING
or
(1)
(Continued)
If the warning light comes on briefly
then turns off, the system is normal.
If the warning light still stays on,
have the system inspected by your
SUZUKI dealer immediately. If the
ABS system becomes inoperative,
the brake system will function as an
ordinary brake system that has no
ABS.
(2)
(3)
65D451
(1) ABS warning light Type 1
(2) ABS warning light Type 2
(3) Brake system warning light
WARNING
If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2)) on
the instrument panel comes on and
stays on while driving, there may be a
problem with the ABS system.
If this happens:
1) Pull off the road and stop carefully.
2) Turn the ignition switch to “LOCK”
and then start the engine again.
(Continued)
WARNING
If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2))
and the Brake system warning light
(3) on the instrument panel simultaneously stay on or come on when
driving, both anti-lock function and
rear brake force control function
(Proportioning valve function) of the
ABS system may have failed. This
could cause the rear wheels to skid
or the vehicle to spin during braking
on a slippery road or hard braking on
a dry paved road. If both warning
lights come on, drive carefully, avoiding hard braking as much as possible, and ask your SUZUKI dealer to
inspect the ABS system immediately.
3-30
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
How the ABS Works
A computer continuously monitors wheel
speed. The computer compares the
changes in wheel speed when braking. If
the wheels slow suddenly, indicating a
skidding situation, the computer will
change braking pressure several times
each second to prevent the wheels from
locking. When you start your vehicle or
when you accelerate after a hard stop, you
may hear a momentary motor or clicking
sound as the system resets or checks
itself.
WARNING
The ABS may not work properly if
tires or wheels other than those
specified in the owner’s manual are
used. This is because the ABS works
by comparing changes in wheel
speed. When replacing tires or
wheels, use only the size and type
specified in this owner’s manual.
Electronic Stability Program
(ESP®)
The ESP® has the following three systems:
ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler
AG.
The vehicle stability control system helps
provide integrated control of systems such
as anti-lock brakes, traction control, engine
control, etc. This system automatically
controls the brakes and engine to help prevent the vehicle from skidding when cornering on a slippery road surface or when
turning the steering wheel abruptly.
The Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)
helps to control the vehicle during cornering if front wheels or rear wheels skid. It
also assists you in maintaining traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces. It does this by regulating the
engine’s output, and by selectively applying the brakes. In addition, ESP® helps to
avoid skidding by controlling braking pressure.
WARNING
ESP®
The
cannot enhance the vehicle’s driving stability in all situations
and does not control your vehicle’s
entire braking system. The ESP® cannot prevent accidents, including
those resulting from excessive speed
in turns, or hydroplaning. Only a safe
and attentive driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESP®equipped vehicle must never be used
as a substitute for careful driving.
Stability Control System
Traction Control System
The traction control system automatically
helps prevent the spinning of wheels when
the vehicle is started or accelerated on
slippery road surfaces. The system operates only if it senses that some of the
wheels are spinning or beginning to lose
traction. When this happens, the system
operates the front or rear brakes and
reduces engine power to limit wheel spin.
NOTE:
You may hear a clicking sound in the
engine compartment for a few seconds
when you start the engine or just after the
vehicle begins to move. This means that
the above systems are in the self-check
mode. This sound does not indicate a malfunction.
3-31
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS)
ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It
will also help you maintain steering control
when braking on slippery surfaces or when
braking hard. The ABS works automatically, so you do not have to use any special
braking technique. Just push the brake
pedal down without pumping. The ABS will
operate whenever it senses that wheels
are locking up. You may feel the brake
pedal pulsate while the ABS is operating.
(For more information on ABS, see “Braking” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE”
section.)
NOTE:
If the ABS system is activated, you may
hear a clunking noise and/or feel pulsating
in the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that the brake fluid pressure is being
controlled properly.
WARNING
• The ESP® may not work properly if
tires or wheels other than those
specified in the Owner’s Manual are
used. When replacing tires or
wheels, use only the size and type
specified in this Owner’s Manual.
• The ESP® may not work properly if
tires are not inflated to the recommended tire inflation pressure.
• The ESP® may not work properly if
tires are fitted with tire chains.
• The ESP® may not work properly if
the tires are excessively worn. Be
sure to replace tires when the tread
wear indicators in the grooves
appear on the tread surface.
• The ESP® is not a substitute for
winter tires or tire chains on a snow
covered road.
WARNING
• The ESP® may not work properly if
engine related parts such as the
muffler are not equivalent to standard equipment or are extremely
deteriorated.
• Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension since the ESP® may not
operate correctly.
The ESP® indicator lights are described
below:
SLIP Indicator Light
79K019
The SLIP indicator light in the instrument
cluster blinks 5 times per second when one
of the following systems is activated.
• Stability control system
• Traction control system
• Hill descent control system (if equipped)
CAUTION
If the SLIP indicator light comes on
and stays on while driving, there may
be a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should
have the systems inspected by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer.
NOTE:
When the SLIP indicator light comes on
and stays on while driving, indicating a
malfunction of the ESP® systems (other
than ABS), the brake system will function
as an ordinary ABS with no additional
ESP® functions.
3-32
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
When you disconnect and re-connect the
battery, ESP® system functions other than
ABS will be deactivated and the slip indicator light will blink 1 time per second. In this
case, use the following procedure to reactivate the ESP® systems:
1) Drive your vehicle straight ahead without tire slippage at a speed greater than
approximately 15 km/h (9 mph) for a
few seconds
2) The slip indicator light will go out and
the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will
be re-activated
It may take more than few seconds before
the slip indicator light goes out depending
on the road surface condition.
“ESP” Warning Light
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light
66J031
66J032
When the ESP® systems (other than ABS)
have a system malfunction, the “ESP”
warning light in the instrument cluster
comes on.
You should turn the ESP® on during your
ordinary driving, so that you have the benefits of all of the ESP® systems.
CAUTION
If the “ESP” warning light comes on,
or stays on while driving, there may
be a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should
have the systems inspected by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer.
It may be required to turn the ESP® systems (other than ABS) off if your vehicle is
stuck in sand, mud, or snow, or when driving in extreme off-road conditions where
wheel spin is necessary.
NOTE:
When the “ESP” warning light comes on,
or stays on while driving, indicating a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than
ABS), the brake system will function as an
ordinary ABS that has no additional ESP®
functions.
NOTE:
The information display shows the warning
and indicator message when this light
comes on.
3-33
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
“ESP OFF” switch
(without hill descent control)
(1)
78K045
(1) “ESP OFF” switch
(with hill descent control)
(1)
78K046
(1) “ESP OFF” switch
When the “ESP OFF” switch located at the
center of the instrument panel is pushed
and held to turn off the ESP® systems
(other than ABS), the “ESP OFF” indicator
light in the instrument cluster comes on.
When you push and hold the “ESP OFF”
switch again, the “ESP OFF” indicator light
will go out and all of the ESP® systems will
be activated.
light will come on. After a short period of
time, the ESP® systems (other than
ABS) will turn on automatically and the
“ESP OFF” indicator light will go out.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a hill
descent control system and a hill hold
control system, these systems will not be
turned off when the “ESP OFF” switch is
pushed to turn off the ESP® systems.
NOTE:
• When the vehicle speed is greater than
approximately 30 km/h (19 mph), the
ESP® systems (other than ABS) will turn
on automatically and the “ESP OFF”
indicator light will go out.
• When the transfer switch (if equipped) is
turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the
ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be
canceled to provide improved vehicle
traction, and the “ESP OFF” indicator
light will come on.
When the transfer switch (if equipped) is
turned to the “4L LOCK” position, braketraction control can be activated. Braketraction control brakes the spinning
wheel to distribute drive power to the
other wheels for increased climbing ability or for better performance on a rolling
hill or a slippery surface.
• If the ESP® systems operate continuously, such as when driving on slippery
roads, the traction control functions of
the ESP® systems may be canceled
temporarily to avoid overheating the
brake pads, and the “ESP OFF” indicator
NOTE:
If you push the “ESP OFF” switch when the
transfer switch is in the “4H” position, the
ESP® systems will not be turned off, and
the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the information display.
You should turn the transfer switch to the
“4H LOCK” position to turn off the ESP®
systems. Refer to “Using the Transfer
Switch” in this section.
79K084
ABS Warning Light / Brake System
Warning Light
See “Braking” in the “OPERATING YOUR
VEHICLE” section.
3-34
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Hill descent control System
(if equipped)
Hill descent control switch
The hill descent control system is designed
to reduce the driver’s workload when going
down steep, rough and/or slippery hills
where the vehicle cannot decelerate
enough by engine braking alone. The hill
descent control system helps to control
vehicle speed by automatically engaging
the vehicle’s brakes, as needed, so you
can concentrate on steering the vehicle.
(1)
WARNING
Do not rely excessively on the hill
descent control system. The hill
descent control system may not control vehicle speed on a hill under all
load or road conditions. Always be
prepared to control vehicle speed by
applying the brakes. Failure to pay
attention and control vehicle speed
using the brakes when necessary
may result in loss of control or an
accident.
79K051
(1) Hill descent control switch
To activate the hill descent control system:
1) Turn the transfer switch to the “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK” position.
2) Shift the gearshift lever into a forward
gear or reverse gear.
3) Push the hill descent control switch (1)
when the vehicle speed is under 25 km/
h (15 mph). The hill descent control
indicator on the instrument cluster will
come on and the hill descent control
system will be activated.
approximately 5 km/h (3 mph) when going
down a hill.
The brake/tail lights come on and the slip
indicator light blinks while the hill descent
control system applies the brakes to maintain the vehicle speed.
If the accelerator or brake pedal is
depressed while the hill descent control
system is activated, the system will stop
working temporarily. As soon as the accelerator or brake pedal is released, the hill
descent control system begins to function
again if the hill descent control operating
conditions are fulfilled. However, when the
vehicle speed exceeds 25 km/h (15 mph),
the hill descent control system will be
deactivated automatically.
To deactivate the hill descent control system, push the hill descent control switch
again.
If the transfer switch is in the “4H LOCK”
position, vehicle speed is maintained at
approximately 10 km/h (6 mph) when
going down a hill.
If the transfer switch is in the “4L LOCK”
position, the vehicle speed is maintained at
3-35
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Hill descent control Indicator Light
CAUTION
• When the hill descent control system is used continuously for a long
time, the temperature of the brake
system may increase and the hill
descent control system may be
deactivated temporarily to protect
the device of the brake system. The
hill descent control indicator blinks
to let you know the system is deactivated. Depress the brake pedal
and stop the vehicle in a safe place.
When the temperature of the brake
system goes down, the hill descent
control indicator will come on and
the system is activated again.
• The hill descent control system
may be activated when the gearshift lever is in the “N” (Neutral)
position, but engine braking will
not work. Always use the hill
descent control system with the
gearshift lever in a forward gear or
reverse gear.
NOTE:
You may hear a sound coming from the
engine when the hill descent control system is activated. This sound is normal and
does not indicate a malfunction.
79K050
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so
you can check that the light is working.
NOTE:
If any of the following conditions occur,
there may be a problem with the hill
descent control system or the ESP® system. Have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized SUZUKI dealer.
• The hill descent control indicator does
not come on or blink when you push the
hill descent control switch.
• The hill descent control indicator stays
on when driving without pushing the hill
descent control switch.
When you push the hill descent control
switch and the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled, the hill descent
control indicator comes on. If the hill
descent control indicator blinks, the hill
descent control will not be activated.
79K072
NOTE:
If the hill descent control indicator blinks
when you push the hill descent control
switch, following conditions may not be fulfilled.
• The transfer switch is in the “4H LOCK”
or “4L LOCK” position
• The gearshift lever is in a forward gear
or reverse gear
• The vehicle speed is under 25 km/h (15
mph)
• The brake system is under normal operating temperature
If the message shown in the above illustration appears on the information display,
there may be a problem with the hill
descent control system and the hill hold
control system. Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
NOTE:
You cannot activate the hill descent control
system while this message is displayed.
3-36
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Hill hold control System
(if equipped)
The hill hold control system is designed to
assist you in starting to move up steep or
slippery hills. When you start to move up a
hill, the system helps to prevent the vehicle
from rolling downward temporarily (for
approximately 2 seconds) while you move
your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal.
WARNING
• Do not rely excessively on the hill
hold control system. The hill hold
control system may not prevent the
vehicle from rolling downward on a
hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to
depress the brake pedal to prevent
the vehicle from rolling downward.
Failure to pay attention and
depress the brake pedal to hold the
vehicle on a hill when necessary,
may result in loss of control or an
accident.
• The hill hold control system is not
designed to stop the vehicle on a
hill.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• After you release your foot from the
brake pedal, start the vehicle to
move up immediately. If you release
your foot from the brake pedal over
2 seconds, the hill hold control system will be canceled. If so, the vehicle may roll downward depends on
the degree of the slope which can
result in an accident. And, the
engine may stall and the power
assist for the steering and brakes
will not work so steering and braking will be much harder than usual
which can result in an accident or
vehicle damage.
79K072
If the message shown in the above illustration appears on the information display,
there may be a problem with the hill
descent control system and the hill hold
control system. Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
NOTE:
The hill hold control system will not activate while this message is displayed.
The hill hold control system activates for
approximately 2 seconds if your foot is
moved from the brake pedal when the following condition are all fulfilled.
1) The transfer switch is in a position other
than “N”.
2) The gearshift lever is in a forward gear
or reverse gear.
3) The parking brake is released.
NOTE:
You may hear a sound coming from the
engine when the hill hold control system is
activated. This sound is normal and does
not indicate a malfunction.
3-37
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) (if equipped)
The tire pressure monitoring system is
designed to alert you when one or more of
the tires on your vehicle is significantly
under-inflated. A Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) sensor containing a
unique identification code is mounted on
each wheel. The TPMS sensors transmit
tire pressure signals to a central receiver
which relays the information to a tire pressure monitoring system controller. When
the inflation pressure of one or more tires
indicates significant under-inflation, the low
tire pressure warning light shown below
comes on.
NOTE:
The TPMS controller is not programmed to
recognize the ID code of the TPMS sensor
in your spare tire. The tire pressure monitoring system will only work with the spare
tire if you bring your vehicle to an authorized SUZUKI dealer to register the ID
code of the spare tire sensor. Refer to
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” in this
section.
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
WARNING
52D305
WARNING
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If
your vehicle has tires of a different
size than the size indicated on the
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the
proper tire inflation pressure for
those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated.
(Continued)
(Continued)
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the
proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire
pressure, even if under-inflation has
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
3-38
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
The tire pressure monitoring system
is not a substitute for regular tire
pressure inspections. Check tire
inflation pressures monthly when
cold and set to the recommended
inflation pressure as specified on the
vehicle’s tire information placard and
in the owner’s manual. Refer to
“Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section.
WARNING
If the low tire pressure warning light
does not come on when the ignition
is turned to the “ON” position, or
comes on and blinks while driving
there may be a problem with the tire
pressure monitoring system. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light
turns off after blinking, indicating
that the monitoring system has
recovered, make sure to have an
authorized SUZUKI dealer check the
system.
WARNING
The load rating of your tires is
reduced at lower inflation pressures.
If your tires become even moderately
under-inflated, the vehicle load may
exceed the load rating of the tires,
which can lead to tire failure. The low
tire pressure warning light will not
alert you of this condition. The warning light will only come on when one
or more of your tires become significantly under-inflated. Check and
adjust your tire inflation pressure at
least once a month. Refer to “Tires”
in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
WARNING
If the low tire pressure warning light
comes on and stays on, reduce your
speed and avoid abrupt steering and
braking. Stop in a safe place as soon
as possible and check your tires.
• If you have a flat tire, replace it with
the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking
Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY
SERVICE”
section.
Refer
to
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels”
for instructions on how to restore
normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you
have had a flat tire.
• If one or more of your tires is
under-inflated adjust the inflation
pressure in all of your tires to the
recommended inflation pressure as
soon as possible.
Be aware that driving on a significantly under-inflated tire can cause
the tire to overheat and can lead to
tire failure, and may affect steering
control and brake effectiveness. This
could lead to an accident, resulting in
severe injury or death.
The low tire pressure warning light can
come on due to normal causes such as
natural air leaks and pressure changes
caused by changes in temperature or
atmospheric pressure. Adjusting the air
pressure in the tires to the pressure shown
3-39
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
on the tire information placard should
cause the low tire pressure warning light to
turn off.
If the light turns on again shortly after
adjusting the pressure in your tires, you
may have a flat tire. If you have a flat tire,
replace it with the spare tire. Refer to
“Jacking Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. Refer to
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” for
instructions on how to restore normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you have had a flat tire.
NOTE:
• When the tire inflation pressure is
adjusted in high altitude areas, the low
tire pressure light may not turn off even
after tire inflation pressure adjustment.
In this case, adjust the inflation pressure
to a slightly higher pressure than is
shown on the tire information placard.
• The low tire pressure warning light may
turn off temporarily after coming on. This
could be due to surface temperature
increases after long distance driving or
traveling to a high temperature area.
Even if the tire pressure warning light
turns off after coming on, make sure to
check the inflation pressure of all tires.
• To reduce the chance that the low tire
pressure warning light will come on due
to normal changes in temperature and
atmospheric pressure, it is important to
check and adjust the tire pressures
when the tires are cold. Tires that
appear to be at the specified pressure
when checked after driving, when the
tires are warm, could have pressure
below the specification when the tires
cool down. Also, tires that are inflated to
the specified pressure in a warm garage
may have pressure below the specification when the vehicle is driven outside in
very cold temperature. If you adjust the
tire pressure in a garage that is warmer
than the outside temperature, you
should add 1 psi to the recommended
cold tire inflation pressure for every 10°F
difference between garage temperature
and outside temperature.
For tire inflation pressure information, refer
to “Tire Inflation Pressure” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
TPMS Malfunction Indicator
WARNING
Your vehicle has also been equipped
with a TPMS malfunction indicator to
indicate when the system is not operating properly.
WARNING
The TPMS malfunction indicator is
combined with the low tire pressure
telltale. When the system detects a
malfunction, the telltale will flash for
approximately one minute and then
remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long
as the malfunction exists.
When you turn off the engine, however, the
malfunction indicator resets. It takes about
ten minutes after restarting the engine for
the malfunction to be detected again and
for the light to start flashing.
WARNING
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions
may occur for a variety of reasons,
including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on
the vehicle that prevent the TPMS
from functioning properly. Always
check the TPMS malfunction telltale
after replacing one or more tires or
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that
the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
3-40
79K21-03E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION
• The tire pressure sensors can be
damaged by the installation or
removal of tires. When tires must
be repaired or replaced, we highly
recommend that you have them
repaired or replaced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer.
• Do not use liquid sealants for a flat
tire as air pressure sensors can be
damaged.
• If the low tire pressure warning
light comes on frequently, there
may be something wrong with one
of the tires or with the monitoring
system.
Have
your
vehicle
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer.
TPMS Limitations
The tire pressure monitoring system may
not function properly under certain circumstances. In the following situations, the low
tire pressure warning light may come on
and remain on or may blink.
• When you replace a flat tire with the
spare tire.
• When you include the spare tire during a
tire rotation.
• When the TPMS sensor is damaged during a tire replacement or liquid sealants
are used to repair a flat tire.
• When the TPMS sensor’s electronic signal is disturbed in one of the following
ways:
– Electric devices or facilities using similar radio wave frequencies are nearby.
– A lot of snow or ice covers the vehicle,
in particular, around the wheels or
wheel housings.
– Snow tires or tire chains are used.
• When you use non-genuine SUZUKI
wheels or tires.
Replacing Tires and/or Wheels
If you get a flat tire, Suzuki recommends
that you have an authorized SUZUKI
dealer mount a new tire on the wheel that
had the flat tire, and reinstall this tire on the
vehicle in place of the spare. The TPMS is
already set up to recognize the ID code of
the original wheel, and normal TPMS operation will be restored.
If you wish to operate your vehicle with the
spare tire installed, you must have an
authorized SUZUKI dealer set up the
TPMS to recognize the ID code of the
spare tire TPMS sensor.
If you need to replace any wheels on your
vehicle, your dealer must make sure that
TPMS sensors are installed in the new
wheels and must set up the TPMS to recognize the new sensors.
WARNING
Only use tires and wheels recommended by SUZUKI as standard or
optional equipment for your vehicle.
Use of tires or wheels not recommended by SUZUKI can result in
TPMS failure. Refer to “Tires” in the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
section for additional information.
For Vehicles Sold in U.S.A.
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Traveling to CANADA
Please note that service for the tire pressure monitoring system may not be available in CANADA should there be any
problems or malfunctions in the system.
3-41
79K21-03E
DRIVING TIPS
DRIVING TIPS
Important Vehicle Design Features To Know ................... 4-1
Break-In ................................................................................ 4-2
Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-2
Improving Fuel Economy ................................................... 4-3
On-Pavement Driving .......................................................... 4-4
Off-Road Driving ................................................................. 4-6
4
60G409
79K21-03E
Important Vehicle Design Features To Know: NO
DRIVING TIPS
Important Vehicle Design
Features To Know
EXAMPLE
WARNING
52D078S
WARNING
• Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times.
Even though air bags are equipped
at the front seating positions, the
driver and all passengers should
be properly restrained at all times,
using the seat belts provided. Refer
to the “Seat Belts and Child
Restraint Systems” section for
instructions on proper use of the
seat belts.
• Never drive while under the influence of alcohol or other drugs.
Alcohol and drugs can seriously
impair your ability to drive safely,
greatly increasing the risk of injury
to yourself and others. You should
also avoid driving when you are
tired, sick, irritated or under stress.
Your multipurpose vehicle has handling characteristics that differ from
those of a conventional passenger
car. For the safety of you and your
passengers, please read the following section very carefully.
Multipurpose vehicles such as your new
SUZUKI have higher ground clearance and
a narrower track than conventional passenger cars, to make them capable of performing in a wide variety of off-road
applications. Specific design characteristics give them a higher center of gravity
than ordinary cars. An advantage of the
higher ground clearance is a better view of
the road allowing you to anticipate problems. They are not designed for cornering
at the same speed as conventional passenger cars any more than low-slung
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If at all
possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers. As with other vehicles of this
type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or vehicle rollover.
65D218
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.
Important Differences Between
Your Multipurpose Vehicle and
Ordinary Passenger Cars
Higher Ground Clearance
The higher ground clearance of your vehicle enables it to clear off-road obstacles,
such as rocks and tree stumps, that ordinary passenger cars cannot drive over. An
unavoidable result of this higher ground
clearance is that the vehicle also has a
higher center of gravity. Consequently,
your vehicle will handle differently than a
vehicle with a lower center of gravity.
Multipurpose vehicles have a significantly
higher rollover rate than other types of
vehicles.
4-1
79K21-03E
Important Vehicle Design Features To Know: NO
On-Pavement Driving: NO
DRIVING TIPS
Shorter Wheelbase
Along with its higher ground clearance,
your vehicle has a shorter wheelbase and
shorter front and rear overhangs than
many passenger cars. These features
combine to allow you to drive your vehicle
over hillcrests without hanging up on them
or damaging the frame and chassis components. The shorter wheelbase also
makes the steering of your vehicle more
responsive than that of vehicles with longer
wheelbases.
Narrower Body Width and Track
Your vehicle is narrower than the average
passenger car so that it can pass through
tight spaces.
Without the essential characteristics
described above: higher ground clearance,
shorter wheelbase and narrower body
width and track – your vehicle could not
provide you with excellent off road driving
performance. However, it is also true that
on-pavement driving, handling and steering will be different from what drivers experience with a conventional passenger car.
Break-In
Catalytic Converter
CAUTION
The future performance and reliability of the engine depends on the care
and restraint exercised during its
early life. It is especially important to
observe the following precautions
during the initial 960 km (600 miles)
of vehicle operation.
• After starting, do not race the
engine. Warm it up gradually.
• Avoid prolonged vehicle operation
at a constant speed. Moving parts
will break in better if you vary your
speed.
• Start off from a stop slowly. Avoid
full throttle starts.
• Avoid hard stopping, especially
during the first 320 km (200 miles)
of driving.
• Do not drive slowly with the transmission in a high gear.
• Drive the vehicle at moderate
engine speeds.
• Do not tow a trailer during the first
960 km (600 miles) of vehicle operation.
EXAMPLE
54G236
The purpose of the catalytic converter is to
minimize the amount of harmful pollutants
in your vehicle’s exhaust. Use of leaded
fuel in vehicles equipped with catalytic
converters is prohibited by federal law,
because lead deactivates the pollutantreducing components of the catalyst system.
The converter is designed to last the life of
the vehicle under normal usage and when
unleaded fuel is used. No special maintenance is required on the converter. However, it is very important to keep the engine
properly tuned. Engine misfiring, which
can result from an improperly tuned
engine, may cause overheating of the catalyst. This may result in permanent heat
damage to the catalyst and other vehicle
components.
4-2
79K21-03E
On-Pavement Driving: NO
Off-Road Driving: NO
DRIVING TIPS
Improving Fuel Economy
CAUTION
To minimize the possibility of catalyst
or other vehicle damage:
• Maintain the engine in the proper
operating condition.
• In the event of an engine malfunction, particularly one involving
engine misfire or other apparent
loss of performance, have the vehicle serviced promptly.
• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
motion.
• Do not try to start the engine by
pushing or towing the vehicle or
coasting down a hill.
• Do not idle the engine with any
spark plug wires disconnected or
removed, such as during diagnostic testing.
• Do not idle the vehicle for prolonged periods if idling seems
rough or there are other malfunctions.
• Do not allow the fuel tank to get
near the empty level.
The following instructions will help you
improve fuel economy.
Avoid excessive idling
If you are to wait for more than a minute
while you are parked, stop the engine and
start it again later. When warming up a
cold engine, allow the engine to idle until
the temperature gauge pointer comes up
to the “C” position. In this position, the
engine is sufficiently warm for starting off.
54G584S
WARNING
Be careful where you park and drive;
the catalytic converter and other
exhaust components can get very
hot. As with any vehicle, do not park
or operate this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as dry
grass or leaves can come in contact
with a hot exhaust system.
Avoid “jackrabbit” starts
Fast starts away from lights or stop signs
will consume fuel unnecessarily and
shorten engine life. Start off slowly.
Avoid unnecessary stops
Avoid unnecessary deceleration and stopping. Try to maintain a slow, steady speed
whenever possible. Slowing down and then
accelerating again uses more fuel.
Keep a steady cruising speed
Keep as constant a speed as road and traffic conditions will permit.
4-3
79K21-03E
Off-Road Driving: NO
DRIVING TIPS
On-Pavement Driving
Keep the air cleaner clean
Government data show that most rollover
accidents for multi-purpose vehicles are
caused when a driver loses control of the
vehicle and leaves the paved portion of the
roadway striking a ditch, curb or other offroad object that causes the vehicle to overturn. The following driving practices may
reduce the risk of rollover.
EXAMPLE
60A183S
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there
will be greater intake resistance, resulting
in decreased power output and increased
fuel consumption.
Keep weight to a minimum
The heavier the load, the more fuel the
vehicle consumes. Take out any luggage
or cargo when it is not necessary.
Keep tire pressure correct
Underinflation of the tires can waste fuel
due to increased running resistance of the
tires. Keep your tires inflated to the correct
pressure shown on the label located below
the driver’s side door latch striker.
Vehicle Slides Off-Road
You can reduce the risk of this kind of rollover accident by always keeping the vehicle under control. Typically, drivers lose
control of vehicles, often resulting in rollover accidents, when the driver is impaired
because of alcohol or other drugs, falls
asleep at the wheel or is otherwise inattentive, or is driving too fast for the road conditions.
Rollovers On the Roadway
If, for any reason, your vehicle slides sideways or spins out of control at highway
speeds, while on the paved portion of the
roadway, the risk of rollover is greatly
increased. This condition can be created
when two or more wheels drop off onto the
shoulder and you steer sharply in an
attempt to reenter the roadway. To reduce
the risk of rollover in these circumstances,
if conditions permit, you should hold the
steering wheel firmly and slow down
before pulling back into the travel lanes
with controlled steering movements.
All Types of Rollover Accidents
As with many kinds of automobile accidents, rollovers can be greatly reduced by
doing what all prudent drivers should do,
i.e., don’t drink and drive, don’t drive when
tired and don’t do anything behind the
wheel that could cause a loss of attention
to the driving task.
Additional guidelines are set out below for
your on-road driving.
Know Your Vehicle
Take time to familiarize yourself with the
unique handling characteristics of your
vehicle by first driving around in an area
away from traffic. Practice turning the vehicle at a variety of speeds and in different
directions. Get a feel for the greater steering response that your vehicle has over a
conventional car.
Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times
The driver and all passengers should be
properly restrained at all times, using the
seat belts provided. Refer to the “Seat
Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section
for instructions on proper use of the seat
belts.
4-4
79K21-03E
Off-Road Driving: NO
DRIVING TIPS
Don’t Make Sharp Turns
As mentioned before, small multipurpose
vehicles have specific design characteristics that allow them to perform in a wide
variety of applications. These characteristics also change the cornering behavior
relative to conventional passenger cars.
Remember, small multipurpose vehicles
have more responsive steering and a
higher center of gravity than conventional
passenger cars. If at all possible, avoid
making sharp turns in your vehicle.
Slow Down on Curves
Learn to approach curves cautiously and
at a conservative speed. Do not attempt to
take curves at the same speeds that you
would in a vehicle with a lower center of
gravity. Just as you would not drive a
sports car on a trail, you should not
attempt to drive your vehicle around curves
like a sports car.
Slow Down and Use Caution on Slippery Roads
Under wet road conditions you should
drive at a lower speed than on dry roads
due to possible slippage of tires during
braking. When driving on icy, snowcovered
or muddy roads, reduce your speed and
avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt braking
or sharp steering movements. Use 4-wheel
drive high range (4H) (if equipped) for better traction.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Do not operate your vehicle in “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry, hard
surfaces. Operating your vehicle in
“4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry,
hard surfaces puts severe stress to
the drive train, especially during tight
cornering, and can damage it. Also,
you may have some difficulty steering.
Unevenly worn tires can cause problems in the operation of the transfer
switch. Be sure to rotate the tires
according to the maintenance schedule. Refer to “Tires” and “Maintenance
Schedule”
in
the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
section for proper tire rotation procedures.
NOTE:
Avoid operating your vehicle in “4H LOCK”
or “4L LOCK” on wet pavement as much
as possible. Operating your vehicle in “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on wet pavement
may cause severe damage to the drive
train.
NOTE:
Operating your vehicle in “4H” on dry and
tight corner may cause some vibration on
your vehicle. This is not caused by the
vehicle malfunction, but caused by working
of the limited slip differential gear in the
center differential.
4-5
79K21-03E
DRIVING TIPS
Off-Road Driving
Your vehicle has specific design characteristics for off-road driving. When you leave
the pavement, you will encounter driving
surfaces of all kinds which may change
continually as you drive. In most cases, offroad driving requires the use of 4-wheel
drive. If your vehicle is a 2-wheel drive
vehicle, you should limit your off-road driving only to hard, flat, nonslippery surfaces.
2-wheel drive vehicles have far less traction on off-road surfaces than 4-wheel
drive vehicles. It is important when driving
off-road to follow the guidelines below.
Use Caution on Steep Inclines
Always inspect hills before you attempt to
drive up them. Know what is on the other
side and how you will get back down. If you
have any doubt that it is safe, do not
attempt to drive over a hill. Never drive
your vehicle up an extremely steep incline.
Coming down a steep hill can be trickier
than getting up one. Keep the vehicle
heading straight down the hill and use low
gear. Do not lock the brakes. If the vehicle
begins to slide, accelerate slightly to regain
steering control.
Do Not Turn on or Drive Across the Side
of Hills
Turning on or driving across the side of a
hill can be extremely hazardous. Most of
the vehicle’s weight will be transferred to
the downhill tires, which could result in the
vehicle rolling sideways. Whenever possible, avoid this potential hazard. Also, if you
have to exit your vehicle on a side-hill,
always get out on the uphill side.
Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times
You and your passengers should use the
seat belts at all times when driving offroad. For proper seat belt use, refer to the
“Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems”
section in this manual.
Avoid Sudden Reactions in Mud, Ice or
Snow
Be careful when off-road conditions are
slick. Reduce your speed and avoid sudden movements of the vehicle. If your vehicle is a 2-wheel drive vehicle, do not drive
in deep snow or mud. If your vehicle is a 4wheel drive vehicle, be aware that driving
in deep snow or mud can cause a loss of
traction and an increase in the resistance
to the vehicle’s forward motion. Use 4WD
low gear (4L) and maintain a steady but
moderate speed with a light touch on the
steering wheel and brakes.
Do not drive in the field covered with
grown grass
If you drive in the field covered with grass,
it may cause unexpected accident or vehicle damage by getting caught in grown
grass.
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
If your vehicle gets stuck in snow, mud or
sand, follow the directions below:
1) (For vehicles equipped with transfer
switch) Turn the transfer switch to “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK”.
2) Shift the transmission back and forth
between a forward range (or first gear
for manual transmission) and reverse.
This will create a rocking motion which
may give you enough momentum to
free the vehicle. Press gently on the
accelerator to keep wheel spin to a minimum. Remove your foot from the
accelerator while shifting.
Do not race the engine. Excessive
wheel spin will cause the tires to dig
deeper, making it more difficult to free
the vehicle.
3) If your vehicle remains stuck after a few
minutes of rocking, get another vehicle
to pull you out.
4-6
79K21-03E
DRIVING TIPS
Tire Chains
WARNING
• Do not allow anyone to stand near
the vehicle when you are rocking it,
and do not spin the wheels faster
than an indicated 40 km/h (25 mph)
on the speedometer. Personal
injury and/or vehicle damage may
result from spinning the wheels too
fast.
• Be sure to turn the transfer switch
from “4H” to “4H LOCK” or “4L
LOCK” when the tires slip in “4H”.
The continuing tires slip in “4H”
can cause the limited slip differential gear damage in the center differential.
CAUTION
Release the accelerator pedal when
operating the gearshift lever. Operating the lever with the engine racing
can damage the gears.
CAUTION
Do not continue rocking the vehicle
for more than a few minutes. Prolonged rocking can cause engine
overheating, transmission or transfer case damage or tire damage.
Tire chains should only be used if they are
needed to increase traction or are required
by law. Make sure that the chains you use
are small-link chains or cable-type chains
and are the correct size for your vehicle’s
tires. Also make sure that there is enough
clearance between the fenders and the
chains as installed on the tires.
Install the chains on the rear tires tightly,
according to the chain manufacturer’s
instructions. Retighten the chains after
driving about 1.0 km (1/2 mile) if necessary. With the chains installed, drive slowly.
CAUTION
If you hear the chains hitting against
the vehicle body while driving, stop
and tighten them.
Do not drive through deep or rushing
water
Driving in deep or rushing water can be
hazardous. You could lose control of the
vehicle and the occupants could drown.
Also, your vehicle could be seriously damaged. To avoid these risks, observe the following instructions and precautions.
• Do not drive through deep or rushing
water. Deep or rushing water, such as
fast-moving streams or floodwaters,
could carry your vehicle away from your
intended path. The water is too deep if it
covers your wheel hubs, axles or
exhaust tailpipe. Know the depth of the
water before you attempt to drive
through it.
• If water blocks the tailpipe, the engine
may not start or run. If the water is deep
enough to get drawn into the engine
intake system, the engine will be badly
damaged.
• Submerged brakes will have poor braking performance. Drive slowly and carefully. Driving slowly will also help avoid
water splashing onto the ignition system,
which could cause the engine to stall.
• Even when driving through shallow or
still waters, drive carefully since the
water may be hiding ground hazards
such as holes, ditches or bumps.
4-7
79K21-03E
DRIVING TIPS
WARNING
In addition to following the driving
tips in this section, it is important to
observe the following precautions for
on-road and off-road driving.
• Driver and passengers should wear
seat belts at all times.
• Do not let anyone else drive your
vehicle unless they are also aware
of the vehicle characteristics and
handling differences described in
this section.
• Avoid loaning your vehicle to anyone unless you accompany them.
• Make sure your tires are in good
condition and always maintain the
specified tire pressure. Refer to
“Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE”
section
for
details.
• Do not use tires other than those
specified by SUZUKI. Never use different sizes or types of tires on the
front and rear wheels. For information regarding the specified tires,
refer to the Tire Inflation Pressure
Label located on the driver’s side
door pillar or the “SPECIFICATIONS” section.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Never use oversized tires or special
shocks and springs to raise (jack
up) your vehicle. This will raise the
center of gravity of the vehicle and
change its handling characteristics. Oversized tires may also rub
against the fender over bumps,
causing vehicle damage or tire failure.
• After driving through water, mud or
sandy ground, test the brakes while
driving at a slow speed to see if
they have maintained their normal
effectiveness. If the brakes are less
effective than normal, dry them by
repeatedly applying the brakes
while driving slowly until the
brakes have regained their normal
effectiveness.
• Do not use “4H LOCK” or “4L
LOCK” drive for normal driving.
• After extended operation in mud,
sand or water, have the brakes
inspected by your authorized
SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.
4-8
79K21-03E
DRIVING TIPS
MEMO
4-9
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
60G407
Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System
(Climate Control) ................................................................. 5-1
Radio Antenna ..................................................................... 5-8
Audio Systems (Type A) ..................................................... 5-8
Audio Systems (Type B) ..................................................... 5-36
Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-62
Engine Hood ........................................................................ 5-63
Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-64 5
Interior Light Switch ........................................................... 5-64
Luggage Compartment Light ............................................. 5-65
Spot Light ............................................................................ 5-66
Accessory Socket (if equipped) ......................................... 5-66
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray (if equipped) ..................... 5-67
Sunroof (if equipped) .......................................................... 5-68
Assist Grips (if equipped) .................................................. 5-70
Coat Hooks (if equipped) .................................................... 5-70
Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-71
Overhead Console Box (if equipped) ................................ 5-71
Cup Holder and Storage Bin (if equipped) ........................ 5-72
Front Seat Back Pocket (if equipped) ............................... 5-73
Shopping Hook (if equipped) ............................................. 5-73
Armrest ................................................................................ 5-73
Floor Mats (if equipped) ..................................................... 5-74
Luggage Compartment Cover ............................................ 5-74
Underfloor Bins (if equipped) ............................................ 5-77
Luggage Restraint Loops (if equipped) ............................ 5-78
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors (if equipped) ............... 5-78
HomeLink® (if equipped) .................................................... 5-80
Frame Hooks ....................................................................... 5-83
79K21-03E
Parking Brake Lever: 6
Pedals: 6
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System
(Climate Control)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Air Outlet
EXAMPLE
Windshield defroster outlet
Side defroster outlet
Side outlet
Center outlet
Floor outlet
Center outlet
1
Open
1
2
EXAMPLE
3
4
2
3
Close
5
64J199
5
5
5
66J250
5-1
79K21-03E
Pedals: 6
Gearshift Lever: 10
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Description of Controls
Side outlet
(8)
(1)
(2)
(7)
(5)
(4)
(6)
(9)
(3)
79K020
63J045
When “Open”, air comes out from the side
outlets regardless of the air flow selector
position.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Temperature selector
Blower speed selector
Air intake selector
Air flow selector
Defrost switch
“OFF” switch
“AUTO” switch
Air conditioning switch
LCD display
5-2
79K21-03E
Gearshift Lever: 10
Fuel Filler Cap: 5
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Blower speed selector (2)
Air conditioning switch (8)
Temperature selector (1)
(1)
(2)
A/C: OFF
A/C: ON
(8)
78K047
79K021
78K048
Turn the temperature selector (1) to adjust
the temperature.
The air conditioning switch (8) is used to
turn on and off the air conditioning system.
To turn on the air conditioning system,
push in the switch and “A/C” will appear on
the LCD display. To turn off the air conditioning system, push in the switch again
and “A/C” will go off.
The blower speed selector (2) is used to
turn on the blower and to select blower
speed.
If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the
blower speed will vary automatically as the
climate control system maintains the
selected temperature.
5-3
79K21-03E
Fuel Filler Cap: 5
Folding Seats: 14
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
RECIRCULATED AIR (a)
When this mode is selected, outside air is
shut off and inside air is recirculated. This
mode is suitable when driving through an
area with polluted air such as a tunnel, or
when attempting to quickly cool down the
vehicle.
Air intake selector (3)
(a)
Air flow selector (4)
FRESH AIR (b)
When this mode is selected, outside air is
introduced.
(b)
“FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR”
are selected alternately each time the air
intake selector is pushed.
(3)
79K022
Push the air intake selector (3) to change
between the following modes.
If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the air
intake will vary automatically as the climate
control system maintains the selected temperature.
NOTE:
If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an
extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore,
you should occasionally select “FRESH
AIR”.
(4)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
79K023
Push the air flow selector (4) to change
among the following functions. The indication of the selected mode appears on the
LCD display.
If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the air
flow will vary automatically as the climate
control system maintains the selected temperature.
5-4
79K21-03E
Folding Seats: 14
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Heat (e)
Ventilation (c)
Defrost switch (5)
64J069
64J071
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the center and side air outlets.
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and the side outlets, a
small amount of air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and the side
defroster outlets.
Bi-level (d)
Heat & defrost (f)
(5)
78K050
Push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the
defroster.
64J070
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out
of the center and side outlets. When the
temperature selector (1) is in the fully
COLD position or fully HOT position, however, the air from the floor outlets and the
air from the center and side outlets will be
the same temperature.
64J072
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the
side outlets.
5-5
79K21-03E
Folding Seats: 14
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
System Operating Instructions
Defrost
inside temperature below outside temperature.
Automatic operation
To turn the climate control system off, push
the “OFF” switch (6).
66J241
NOTE:
If the “AUTO” on the LCD display blinks,
there is a problem in the heating system
and/or air conditioning system. You should
have the system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer.
(7)
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the windshield defroster outlets, the side
defroster outlets and the side outlets.
NOTE:
When the defrost switch (5) is pushed to
turn on the defroster, the air conditioning
system will come on and the “FRESH AIR”
mode will be selected automatically. In
very cold weather, however, the air conditioning system will not turn on.
(6)
78K051
You can let the climate control system work
automatically. To set the system for fullyautomatic operation, follow the procedure
below.
1) Start the engine.
2) Push the “AUTO” switch (7).
3) Set the desired temperature by turning
the temperature selector (1).
The blower speed, air intake and air flow
are controlled automatically to maintain the
set temperature.
You can use the air conditioning switch (8)
to manually turn the air conditioner on or
off according to your preference. When
you turn the air conditioning switch off, the
climate control system cannot lower the
NOTE:
• To find the temperature at which you are
most comfortable, start with the 22°C
(72°F) setting.
• If you turn the temperature selector (1)
until “HI” or “LO” appears on the LCD
display, the climate control system will
operate at the maximum cooling or heating and the blower will run at full speed.
• To avoid blowing cold air in cold weather
or hot air in hot weather, the system will
delay turning on the blower until warmed
or chilled air is available.
• If your vehicle has been left in the sun
with the windows closed, it will cool
faster if you open the windows briefly.
• Even under the automatic operation, you
can set individual selectors to the manual mode. The manually selected functions are maintained, and the other
functions remain under automatic operation.
5-6
79K21-03E
Armrest: 14
Sun Visor: 5
Interior Light Switch: 7
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Maintenance
• To return the blower speed selector (2),
air intake selector (3), and air flow selector (4) to automatic operation, push the
“AUTO” switch.
If you do not use the air conditioner for a
long period, such as during winter, it may
not give the best performance when you
start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.
Operate the air conditioner at least once a
month for one minute with the engine
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil
and helps protect the internal components.
(F)
(G)
64J074
EXAMPLE
64J080
Be careful not to cover the interior temperature sensor (F) located between the
steering wheel and the climate control
panel, or the solar sensor (G) located at
the top of the driver’s side dashboard.
These sensors are used by the automatic
system to regulate temperature.
Manual operation
You can manually control the climate control system. Set the selectors to the
desired positions.
NOTE:
If you need maximum defrosting:
• push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the
defroster (the air conditioning system will
come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will
be selected automatically),
• set the blower speed selector to HIGH,
• adjust the temperature selector to the
“HI” indication on the LCD display, and
• adjust the side outlets so the air blows
on the side windows.
Your air conditioner is equipped with air filters. Clean or replace them as specified in
the “Maintenance Schedule” in the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Have this job done by your SUZUKI
dealer as the lower glove box must be lowered for this job.
NOTE:
Your vehicle uses the air conditioning
refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called
“R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around
1993 for automotive applications. Other
refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used
in your vehicle.
CAUTION
Using the wrong refrigerant may
damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or
replace the R-134a with other refrigerants.
5-7
79K21-03E
Interior Light Switch: 7
Spot Light: 7
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Radio Antenna
Audio Systems (type A)
Type 2
There are two types of audio system as
shown below:
Type 1
79K104
63J055
The radio antenna on the roof is removable. To remove the antenna, turn it counterclockwise. To reinstall the antenna, turn
it clockwise firmly by hand.
CAUTION
AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER
WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
79K103
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER
WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
To avoid damage to the radio
antenna:
• Remove the antenna before using
an automatic car wash.
• Remove the antenna when it is possible for the antenna to hit something such as a low ceiling in a
parking garage or putting a car
cover over your car.
• Remove the antenna before putting a car cover over your vehicle.
5-8
79K21-03E
Luggage Compartment Light: 7
Front Door Light:
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Precautions
• When the inside of the car is very cold
and the player is used soon after switching on the heater, moisture may form on
the disc or the optical parts of the player
and proper playback may not be possible. If moisture forms on the disc, wipe it
off with a soft cloth. If moisture forms on
the optical parts of the player, do not use
the player for about one hour. This will
allow the condensation to disappear normally.
• Driving on extremely bumpy roads which
cause severe vibrations may cause
sound to skip.
• This unit uses a precision mechanism.
Even in the event that trouble arises,
never open the case, disassemble the
unit, or lubricate the rotating parts.
Please bring the unit to an authorized
SUZUKI dealer or a Clarion service
Department.
Cautions on Handling
Never touch the surface.
(A)
52D274
52D347
This unit has been designed specifically for
playback of compact discs bearing the
mark (A).
No other discs can be played.
To remove fingermarks and dust, use a
soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from
the center of the compact disc to the circumference.
Removing the disc
Proper way to hold
the compact disc
(B)
(C)
(B)
52D275
52D277
To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the
case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges.
New discs may have some roughness
around the edges. The unit may not work
or the sound may skip if such discs are
used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to
remove the roughness (C) from edges of
the disc before insertion inside the unit.
Always handle the compact disc by the
edges.
5-9
79K21-03E
Front Seat Heater: 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
52D348
52D350
Never stick labels on the surface of the
compact disc or mark the surface with a
pencil or pen.
Do not use compact discs that have large
scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc.
Use of such discs will cause damage or
prevent the system from operating properly.
NOTE:
• Do not use commercially available CD
protection sheets or discs equipped with
stabilizers, etc.
These may get caught in the internal
mechanism and damage the disc.
• CD-R discs may not be able to playback
in this unit due to the recording conditions.
• CD-RW discs cannot playback in this
unit.
52D349
Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray,
or thinner to clean compact discs.
52D351
Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source.
5-10
79K21-03E
Assist Grips: 3
Coat Hooks:
Sunroof: 5, 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Basic Operations
Display
(A)
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
79K086
(5)
(6)
(2)
(1)
(1) Power on/off knob
Volume control knob
(2) Tone/balance/fader control knob
(3) Preset button 5
(4) Preset button 6
(5) Clock button H
(6) Clock button M
(3) (4)
(A) Clock display
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(5)
(6)
(1)
(2)
(3) (4)
79K105
5-11
79K21-03E
Sunroof: 5, 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Turning power on/off
Press the power on/off knob (1).
The unit starts in the function mode it was
in when the power was turned off last.
Adjusting the volume
Turn the volume control knob (1).
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;
turning it counterclockwise decreases the
volume.
• When minutes are between 30 and 59,
the clock will reset to the next hour.
(example: 12:38 ➔ 1:00)
Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2).
Each time it is pressed, sound adjustment is changed as follows:
NOTE:
While driving, adjust the volume to an
extent that sound and/or noise coming
from outside the car can be heard.
Bass adjustment (BASS 0)
Adjusting the clock
1) Press the clock button H (5) to adjust
the hours.
Press the clock button M (6) to adjust
the minutes.
2) Hold the button depressed to automatically increment the number.
3) To reset the clock to an hour signal,
press the clock button H (5) while holding the clock button M (6) depressed.
Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0)
NOTE:
When the clock has not been set, the time
“12:00” will flash in the display.
Clock reset is effected as follows:
• When minutes are between 00 and 29,
the clock will reset to the current hour.
(example: 12:23 ➔ 12:00)
Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0)
Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control)
The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function
automatically
adjusts
(increases/
decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control
is provided with three selectable levels
(LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume
adjustment increases together with the
LEVEL number,
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode
is selected.
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) to select the desired AVC
adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL
2)
Adjusting the contrast of the display
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) and preset button 5 (3), preset
button 6 (4) simultaneously.
2) To adjust the contrast of the display,
turn the power on/off knob (1).
Fader adjustment (FADER 0)
AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2)
Original mode
66J224
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) to adjust the sound.
Cancel the dimmer condition
Each time you press the power on/off knob
(1) for two seconds with the lighting switch
on, the background brightness of the audio
display will switch between normal and
dimmed.
5-12
79K21-03E
Sunroof: 5, 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to the Radio
Display
(C)
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(A)
(1)
(D)
66J097
(2)
(3)
(6)
(B)
(4)
(5)
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Band switch button (FM/AM)
Seek up button
Seek down button
Manual tuning knob
Preset buttons (1 to 6)
Auto store button (AS)/
Scan button (SCAN)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Band
Preset channel number
Stereo indicator
Frequency
(2)
(3)
(6)
(1)
(4)
(5)
79K106
5-13
79K21-03E
Engine Hood: 5
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting the reception band
Press the band switch button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the reception band is switched as follows:
66J098
Seek tuning
Press the seek up button (2) or the seek
down button (3).
The unit stops searching for a station at a
frequency where a broadcast station is
available.
Manual tuning
Turn the manual tuning knob (4).
The frequency being received is displayed.
Preset memory
1) Select the desired station.
2) Select the preset button (5) to which
you want to store the station and press
and hold the button for 2 seconds or
longer.
Auto store
Press and hold the auto store button (6) for
2 seconds or longer.
Six stations in total are automatically
stored to the preset buttons (5) in sequential order, starting from the lower frequencies.
Scan tuning
1) Press the scan button (6).
Stations are automatically sought for in
a sequential order, starting from a station being currently received, and scan
stops for 5 seconds at a frequency
where there is a station available.
2) Press the scan button (6) again to stop
scanning at the frequency being currently received.
Receiving a stereo broadcast station
If a stereo broadcast station is received,
the stereo indicator will light.
NOTE:
• When the auto store is performed, the
station previously stored in the memory
at the position is overwritten.
• When there are fewer than 6 stations
that can be stored even if 2 rounds of
auto store operation are performed, the
stations previously stored at the remaining preset buttons (5) are not overwritten.
5-14
79K21-03E
Cup Holder and Storage Bin: 3, 14
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Radio Reception
Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio
signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may
interfere or deflect radio reception, causing
poor reception. Poor reception or radio
static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage
power lines.
Listening to a CD
CAUTION
(A)
52D274
• CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A)
cannot be used.
• Some discs previously recorded in CDR\CD-RW format may not be used.
• Never insert your finger or hand
into the CD insertion slot. Never
insert foreign objects.
• Never insert a CD with glue coming
out from adhesive tape or a rental
CD label or with a trace indicating
that adhesive tape or a rental CD
label has been removed. This may
cause the CD not to eject or result
in a malfunction.
52D291
• A CD is inserted with its label facing
upward.
• When there is a CD already loaded in
the unit, another CD cannot be loaded at
the same time. Do not use force when
inserting the CD into the CD insertion
slot.
• If a blank disc (non-recorded CD-R) is
loaded in the unit, the disc will be
ejected.
5-15
79K21-03E
Overhead Console Box:
Accessory Socket: 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Type 1
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built in CD Player)
Display
(D)
(A)
(B)
(C)
66J100
(1)
(6)
(3)
(2)
(4)
(5)
79K107
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
CD insertion slot
CD eject button
Disc button (CD/AUX)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Repeat button (RPT)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Mode indicator
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
NOTE:
About Single CDs (8 cm CDs)
• No adapter is required to play a single
CD.
• A single CD is inserted from the center
of the CD insertion slot.
• Since an ejected single CD is not automatically reloaded, be sure to remove
the ejected single CD.
5-16
79K21-03E
Accessory Socket: 8
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray: 3, 8
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Loading a CD
Insert a CD in the CD insertion slot (1).
When a CD is loaded, play starts and the
CD indicator (A) lights.
Ejecting a CD
Press the CD eject button (2).
If you left a CD ejected for a period of
about 15 seconds, it will be automatically
drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload function)
The backup eject function:
This function allows you to eject a CD with
the power turned off by pressing the CD
eject button (2).
Listening to a CD
When a CD is inserted, it is automatically
played back.
When a CD is already inside the unit,
press the disc button (3) to play back the
CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD
indicator (A) is lit on the display unit.
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (4) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (5) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (5) is
pressed once, the track being currently
played will return to the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (4) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (5) to rewind a
track.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (6).
The repeat indicator (D) lights and the
track currently being played is played
repeatedly.
Press the repeat button (6) again to cancel
repeat play.
CAUTION
If you forcefully try to push an ejected
CD inside the unit before auto reloading, the disc surface might be
scratched.
5-17
79K21-03E
Frame Hooks: 5, 6
Tire Changing Tools: 3, 5
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Type 2
AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Changer)
Display
(F)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
66J102
(3)
(1)
(4)
(8)
(6)
(7)
(5)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Load button (LOAD)
Disc select buttons (1 to 6)
CD insertion slot
CD eject button
Disc button (CD/AUX)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Repeat button (RPT)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
Mode indicator
Disc number
Track number
Play time
CD indicator
Repeat indicator
79K108
5-18
79K21-03E
Tire Changing Tools: 3, 5
Shopping Hook:
Front Seat Back Pocket: 3
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
About Single CDs (8 cm CDs)
• Since the unit is not compatible with a
single CD, do not load it into the unit.
• Keep in mind the fact that a single CD
cannot be played even using a single CD
adaptor for the unit.
• When a single CD is loaded into the unit
accidentally, it will be ejected immediately. Please be sure to remove it.
If you forcefully try to push it into the unit
without removing it, the CD cannot be
ejected. This will result in a damage to
the mechanism. Please never do this.
Loading one CD
1) Press the load button (1), then press
one of the disc select buttons (2) that
corresponds to the slot into which you
want to load a CD.
66J143
Both the indication “In” and the selected
disc number in the CD indicator will blink
for about 15 seconds.
2) Load the CD into the CD insertion slot
(3). When the CD is loaded, play starts.
The disk number in the CD indicator will
light.
CAUTION
You can load a CD only while the indication “In” is blinking for about 15
seconds. During that period, the
shutter located in the depth of the CD
insertion slot (3) is opened. After 15
seconds time has elapsed, the indication “In” disappears from the display and the shutter closes, making it
impossible to load a CD. If you try to
load the CD with the shutter closed,
the CD may damage the shutter.
Never do this.
Loading multiple CDs
1) Press the load button (1) for 2 seconds
or longer.
The indication “CD ALL” appears in the
display, and then the indication “In” and
a disc number in the CD indicator will
blink for about 15 seconds.
2) Load a CD into the CD insertion slot
(3).
3) The indication “In” and the next disc
number will blink in the display. Load
the next CD.
4) After loading the required number of
CD’s, press any disc select button (2) to
select the desired CD to listen to. If no
select button is pressed, play will start
from the first loaded CD.
Only the numbers in the CD indicator that
correspond to the loaded slots will light.
Ejecting one CD
1) Select the CD you want to remove with
the disc select buttons (2).
2) Press the CD eject button (4).
If you leave the ejected CD without
removing it, it will be drawn into the unit
automatically after about 15 seconds.
(Auto reload function)
The buck up eject mechanism:
This function allows you to eject the CD
loaded in the unit with the unit turned off
only by pressing the CD eject button (4).
5-19
79K21-03E
Underseat Tray: 3
Luggage Restraint Loops: 5
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Ejecting all the CDs
Press the CD eject button (4) for 2 seconds
or longer. All the CDs will be ejected from
the unit in a sequential manner.
• Please prepare a location where
removed CDs can be stored.
• If you leave the ejected CD without
removing it, it will be drawn into the unit
automatically after about 15 seconds.
(Auto reload function)
The buck up eject mechanism:
This function allows you to eject the CD
loaded in the unit with the unit turned off
only by pressing the CD eject button (4).
CAUTION
If you try to push an ejected CD
inside the unit forcibly before auto
reloading, the disc surface might be
scratched.
Listening to a CD
1) When a CD is inserted, it is automatically played back.
When a CD is already inside the unit,
press the disc button (5) to play back
the CD. When a CD is inside the unit,
the CD indicator (A) is lit on the display
unit.
2) If you want to play another CD, select it
with the disc select buttons (2).
Play starts from the point on the disc
that the unit played last (Last position
memory).
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (6) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (7) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (7) is
pressed once, the track being currently
played will return to the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (6) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (7) to rewind a
track.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (8).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
DISC REPEAT
66J144
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (8) several times to change the repeat
play mode to OFF.
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (F) lights.
The track currently being played is
played repeatedly.
• DISC REPEAT
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (F) lights.
When all the tracks on the disc currently
being played finish playing, play starts
again at the beginning of the disc.
5-20
79K21-03E
Luggage Compartment Cover: 5
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to an MP3/WMA Disc
Display (Type 1)
(D)
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(A)
(E) (F)
(C)
(B)
(2)
(5)
66J104
(3)
(4)
Display (Type 2)
(D)
(1)
(A)
(B)
(E) (F)
(C)
(G)
66J105
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(2)
(5)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Sound control knob
Repeat button (RPT)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Display button (DISP)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
(G)
Folder number
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
WMA indicator
MP3 indicator
CD indicator
79K109
5-21
79K21-03E
Underfloor Bins:
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors: 5, 13
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
What is MP3/WMA?
MP3 (MPEG1/2 Audio Layer-III) and WMA
(Windows MediaTM Audio) are the compression formats of digital audio. The
former is developed by MPEG (Motion Picture Experts Group), and the latter is
developed by Microsoft Corporation. Using
these compression formats, you can
record the contents of about 10 music CDs
on a single CD media (This figures refer to
data recorded on a 650 MB CD-R or CDRW at a fixed bit rate of 128 kbps and a
sampling frequency of 44.1 kHz).
Points to remember when making MP3/
WMA files
Common
• High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds.
• Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not
recommended because playing time is
not displayed properly and sound may
be skipped.
• The playback sound quality differs
depending on the encoding circumstances. For details, refer to the user
manual of your own encoding software
and writing software.
MP3
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to
“128 kbps or more” and “fixed”.
WMA
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to
“64 kbps or more” and “fixed”.
• Do not set the copy protect attribute on
the WMA file to enable this unit to play
back.
NOTE:
Never assign the “.mp3”, or “.wma” file
name extension to a file that is not in the
MP3/WMA format. This may not only produce noise from the speaker damage, but
also damage your hearing.
Recording MP3/WMA files on a CDmedia
• You are recommended to minimize the
chances of making a disc that contains
both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA files.
• If CD-DA files are on the same disc as
MP3 or WMA files, the songs may not
play in the intended order, or some
songs may not play at all.
• When storing MP3 data and WMA data
on the same disc, use different folders
for each data.
• Do not record files other than MP3/WMA
files and unnecessary folder on a disc.
• The name of an MP3/WMA file should
be added by rules as shown in the following descriptions and also comply with
the rules of each file system.
• The file extension “.mp3” or “.wma”
should be assigned to each file depending on the file format.
• You may encounter trouble in playing
MP3/WMA files or displaying the information of MP3/WMA files recorded with
certain writing software or CD recorders.
• This unit does not have a play list function.
• Although Multi-session recording is supported, the use of Disc-at-Once is recommended.
5-22
79K21-03E
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors: 5, 13
HomeLink:
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Compression formats
MP3
• Bit rate
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 32 k - 320 kbps
MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 8 k - 160 kbps
• Sampling frequency
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 44.1 k/48 k/32
kHz
MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 22.05 k/24 k/16
kHz
Maximum number of files/folders
• Maximum number of files:
CD Player: 999(files + folders)
6-CD Player: 512(files + folders)
• Maximum number of files in one folder:
255
• Maximum depth of trees: 8
• Maximum number of folders: 255
(Root folder is included.)
MP3/WMA MODE
Selecting a folder
Turn the sound control knob (1) to select a
folder.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (2).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
Type 1
WMA (Ver.7, Ver.8, Ver.9*)
• Bit rate
32 k - 192 kbps
• Sampling frequency
44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz
* WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are
not supported.
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
FOLDER REPEAT
66J128
Supported file systems
ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Apple Extension
to ISO 9660, Joliet, Romeo
Type 2
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
FOLDER REPEAT
DISC REPEAT
66J145
5-23
79K21-03E
HomeLink:
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (2) several times to change the repeat
play mode to OFF.
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
The track currently being played is
played repeatedly.
• FOLDER REPEAT
The indication “FOLDER RPT” appears
in the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
All the tracks in the folder currently being
played are played repeatedly.
• DISC REPEAT
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
When all the tracks on the disc currently
being played finish playing, play starts
again at the beginning of the disc.
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (4) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (4) is
pressed once, the track currently being
played will start again at the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a
track.
Displaying CD titles
Press the display button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, the title
changes as follows:
OFF
FOLDER TITLE
ALBUM TITLE
FILE TITLE
ARTIST TITLE
TRACK TITLE
66J146
Forwarding a title
If there is a title with 12 letters or more,
each press will show next letters in the display. (No scrolling is made.)
Press and hold the display button (5) for 2
seconds or longer. A title is changed.
5-24
79K21-03E
HomeLink:
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option)
Display
(C)
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(A)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(8)
(6)
66J107
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(5)
(2)
(7)
XM button
Category button (CAT)
Seek up button
Seek down button
Manual tuning knob
Display button (DISP)
Preset button (1 to 6)
Scan button (SCAN)
(A) Band
(B) Channel number
(C) Category indicator
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
If you want to purchase XM Satellite Radio
Service, contact your SUZUKI dealer.
It is necessary to buy a special tuner to
receive XM broadcasting.
(3)
(4)
(1)
(8)
(6)
(B)
Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM
Satellite Radio anywhere in the United
States except Hawaii, Alaska, and Canada.
(5)
(2)
(7)
79K110
5-25
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
XM MODE
Selecting a band
Press the XM button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the band
changes in the following order.
XM1
XM2
Selecting a category
Press the seek up button (3) or seek down
button (4) to select a category.
Displaying the category
Press the category button (2) to have the
currently selected category appear on the
display.
XM3
Selecting a channel
Turn the manual tuning knob (5) to select a
channel.
66J129
Selecting a category
Press the seek up button (3) or the seek
down button (4). The category is changed.
Turning the category function on/off
Press and hold the category button (2) for
2 seconds or longer, and “CATEGORY
ON” appears on the display, the CAT indicator (C) lights up and the CATEGORY
function is activated.
Press and hold the category button (2) for
2 seconds or longer again, and “CATEGORY OFF” appears on the display and
the CAT indicator (C) turns off, indicating
that the CATEGORY function has been
turned off.
NOTE:
The first time you use the radio, turn the
category function on.
NOTE:
When the category function is on, only
those channels included in the selected
category can be selected.
Selecting the item to be displayed
Press the display button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the item
on display changes in the following order.
CH NUMBER
TITLE
CH NAME
and hold the button for 2 seconds or
longer.
Scan tuning
1) Press the scan button (8).
Stations are automatically searched for
in a sequential order, starting from the
station being currently received, and
scan tuning stops for 5 seconds at the
frequency where there is a station available.
2) Press the scan button (8) again to stop
scanning at the frequency currently
being received.
Satellite Radio Reception
Satellite radio receives signals from two
satellites in orbit over the equator. Therefore, satellite radio reception can be interrupted when there are objects south of
your vehicle. To help compensate for this,
ground-based repeaters are placed in
major metropolitan areas, but depending
on the geographic situation (for example, if
mountains or buildings are on the south
side of your vehicle), you may experience
reception problems.
NAME
66J130
Preset memory
1) Select the desired station.
2) Select the preset button (7) to which
you want to store the station and press
5-26
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to Audio for AUX (Option)
Display
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(A)
66J221
(1) Aux button (CD/AUX)
(A) Mode indicator
Aux function
This system has an external input terminal
so you can listen to audio from an external
device connected to this unit.
(1)
Press the aux button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
selected mode is switched as follows:
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
CD
AUX
66J123
(1)
79K111
5-27
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option)
Display
(G)
(E) (F)
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(A) (B)
(C)
(D)
(5)
66J113
(3)
(4)
(1)
(6)
(2)
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Disc button (CD/AUX)
Disc select buttons (1 to 6)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Repeat button (RPT)
Category button (CAT)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
(G)
Mode indicator
Disc number
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
Random indicator
CD changer number
(3)
(4)
(5)
(1)
(6)
(2)
79K112
5-28
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting a CD changer mode
Press the disc button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
selected CD plays as follows:
Built-in CD player
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (4) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (4) is
pressed once, the track currently being
played will start again at the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a
track.
CD changer 1
To cancel random play, press the category
button (6) several times to change the random play mode to OFF.
• TRACK RANDOM
The tracks in the disc that is loaded are
played at random.
• DISC RANDOM
The tracks in all discs are played at random.
NOTE:
The random play can be operated with the
External CD Changer (Option) only.
CD changer 2
52D300
• When only one CD changer is connected to this unit, CD changer 2 is
skipped.
• When no CD is loaded in the built-in CD
player, the built-in CD player is skipped.
Selecting a disc
Press the disc select button (2) corresponding to the disc number you want to
listen to.
Play starts from the first track on the disc. If
a disc number having no disc is pressed,
the selection will be invalid.
Random play
Press the category button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
changes in the following order.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
TRACK RANDOM
OFF
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
DISC RANDOM
DISC REPEAT
66J131
66J144
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (5) several times to change the repeat
play mode to OFF.
5-29
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (E) lights.
The track being currently played is
played repeatedly.
Remote Audio Controls
(if equipped)
To control the volume:
• To increase the volume, push the upper
part of the switch (1). The volume continues to increase until you release the
switch.
• To decrease the volume, push the lower
part of the switch (1). The volume continues to decrease until you release the
switch.
• To mute, push the switch (2).
• DISC REPEAT
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (E) lights.
When all the tracks on a disc being currently played finish playing, play starts
again at the beginning of the disc.
To select the mode (AM1, AM2, FM1, FM2,
XM (option), CD, External CD-changer
(option), AUX (option)), push the switch
(3).
You can also turn on the audio system by
pushing the switch (3).
(2)
(3)
(1)
(4)
79K052
You can control basic functions of the
audio system with the switches on the
steering wheel.
To change the radio station:
• To advance to the next preset station,
push the upper part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To select the previous preset station,
push the lower part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To scan to a higher frequency radio station, push and hold the upper part of the
switch (4).
• To scan to a lower frequency radio station, push and hold the lower part of the
switch (4).
5-30
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
To change the selection on a CD:
• To advance to the next track on a CD,
push the upper part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To select the previous track on a CD,
push the lower part of the switch (4).
Anti-Theft Feature
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(2)
(1)
(3)
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(2)
(1)
(3)
79K113
5-31
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
(1) Power on/off knob
(2) Track up button/Fast forward button
(3) Preset buttons (1 to 6)
The anti-theft feature is intended to discourage theft or the audio system by preventing the system from operating when it
is moved to a different vehicle.
This feature works by allowing you to enter
a Personal Identification Number (PIN).
When the audio system is disconnected
from its power source, such as when the
audio system is removed or the battery is
disconnected, the system will not operate
again unless the PIN is reentered.
Setting the Anti-Theft Function
NOTE:
Establish your PIN by combining numbers
from 1 to 6 into any 4-digit number. If you
forget your PIN, when you remove the battery for repair etc., you will no longer be
able to operate the audio system.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66J117
5) Input the same 4-digit number you previously entered.
66J117
3) Input the four digit PIN using preset buttons 1 to 6.
1) Turn off the power by pressing the
power on/off knob (1).
66J120
6) The power of the audio system will turn
off.
66J118
66J118
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while
pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “ENTRY 0000” will blink
and the audio system enter PIN-input
mode.
4) After you enter your four digit PIN, the
display will return to “0000”.
NOTE:
Write down your PIN for the future use.
Canceling Your Established PIN
Setting
This operation is to be done when you
want to cancel the anti-theft function or
change your PIN.
1) Turn off the power by pressing the
power on/off knob (1).
5-32
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Confirming Your Personal Identification Number (PIN)
When the main power source is disconnected such as when you exchange your
battery, etc, you will have to confirm your
PIN to be able to use the audio system.
66J121
To confirm your PIN:
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while
pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “DELETE 0000” will blink
and the audio system will enter the cancel mode.
EXAMPLE
66J122
registered PIN, the power of the audio
system will turn off, and you will be able
to operate the audio system.
NOTE:
• If you input your PIN incorrectly, “----” will
be displayed and the anti-theft function
lock mode is entered. If you enter an
incorrect PIN fewer than 6 times, the
locking time will be for 15 seconds; if you
enter an incorrect PIN more than 6
times, the locking time will be for 15 minutes.
• If you forget your PIN and enter a wrong
PIN, you cannot perform any further
operation.
1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC”
position.
EXAMPLE
66J124
3) Input your PIN. The power of the audio
system will turn off and your PIN will be
deleted.
To change your PIN, first delete your
current PIN, then set a new one.
66J125
2) Input your PIN.
If the PIN that you input matches the
5-33
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Troubleshooting
Applicable to every device
Phenomenon
Power is not turned on.
(No sound is produced)
Cause
Remedy
Fuse is blown.
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.
Connections are not properly made.
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.
Radio
Phenomenon
Cause
Remedy
Too much noise.
Not tuned correctly to the frequency of a station.
Tune correctly to the station frequency.
Stations cannot be selected by
seek tuning.
There is no station with strong radio waves.
Select stations by manual tuning.
CD
Phenomenon
Cause
Remedy
Compact disc cannot be loaded.
Another compact disc is already loaded.
Eject the compact disc before loading a new
one.
Sound skips or is noisy.
Compact disc is dirty.
Clean the compact disc with a soft cloth.
Compact disc is heavily scratched or warped.
Replace with a compact disc with no scratches.
Water droplets may form on the internal lens
when the car is parked in a humid place.
Let dry for about 1 hour with the power on.
Sound is bad directly after power
is turned on.
5-34
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Error display
This unit has a number of self-diagnostic functions to protect the system.
If a problem should occur, the display shows the type of error. Refer to the table below and take proper measures to correct the problem.
If the problem is corrected, the unit will operate normally.
Error display
Measures to be taken
CD/CD changer “Mechanical error”.
This error display indicates a mechanical failure in the CD changer
(failure to change or eject a disc).
The mechanism is probably damaged. Contact your authorized
SUZUKI dealer.
CD/CD changer “Focus error”.
The pick-up-focus is not properly functioning during playback due to
damage on the disc or for other reasons.
Check disc for damage.
CD/CD changer “Disc error”.
The CD is inserted upside down or only an eight-centimeter CD
adapter is equipped.
Check disc for correct loading.
If an error display not listed above appears, turn off the unit and contact your SUZUKI dealer.
5-35
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Audio Systems (type B)
Precautions
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER
WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL
(Built-in CD Player)
79KA001
• When the inside of the car is very cold
and the player is used soon after switching on the heater, moisture may form on
the disc or the optical parts of the player
and proper playback may not be possible. If moisture forms on the disc, wipe it
off with a soft cloth. If moisture forms on
the optical parts of the player, do not use
the player for about one hour. This will
allow the condensation to disappear normally.
• Driving on extremely bumpy roads which
cause severe vibrations may cause
sound to skip.
• This unit uses a precision mechanism.
Even in the event that trouble arises,
never open the case, disassemble the
unit, or lubricate the rotating parts.
Please bring the unit to an authorized
SUZUKI dealer or a Clarion service
Department.
Cautions on Handling
(A)
52D274
This unit has been designed specifically for
playback of compact discs bearing the
mark (A).
No other discs can be played.
Removing the disc
Proper way to hold
the compact disc
52D275
To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the
case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges.
Always handle the compact disc by the
edges.
5-36
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
prevent the system from operating properly.
Never touch the surface.
52D348
52D347
To remove fingermarks and dust, use a
soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from
the center of the compact disc to the circumference.
Never stick labels on the surface of the
compact disc or mark the surface with a
pencil or pen.
(B)
(C)
(B)
52D349
Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray,
or thinner to clean compact discs.
52D351
Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source.
NOTE:
• Do not use commercially available CD
protection sheets or discs equipped with
stabilizers, etc.
These may get caught in the internal
mechanism and damage the disc.
• CD-R discs may not be able to playback
in this unit due to the recording conditions.
• CD-RW discs cannot playback in this
unit.
52D277
New discs may have some roughness
around the edges. The unit may not work
or the sound may skip if such discs are
used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to
remove the roughness (C) from edges of
the disc before insertion inside the unit.
52D350
Do not use compact discs that have large
scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc.
Use of such discs will cause damage or
5-37
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Basic Operations
Display
(A)
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
79K086
(1) Power on/off knob
Volume control knob
(2) Tone/balance/fader control knob
(3) Preset button 5
(4) Preset button 6
(5) Clock button H
(6) Clock button M
(5)
(6)
(1)
(2)
(A) Clock display
(3)
(4)
79KA002
5-38
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Turning power on/off
Press the power on/off knob (1).
The unit starts in the function mode it was
in when the power was turned off last.
Adjusting the volume
Turn the volume control knob (1).
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;
turning it counterclockwise decreases the
volume.
• When minutes are between 30 and 59,
the clock will reset to the next hour.
(example: 12:38 ➔ 1:00)
Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2).
Each time it is pressed, sound adjustment is changed as follows:
NOTE:
While driving, adjust the volume to an
extent that sound and/or noise coming
from outside the car can be heard.
Bass adjustment (BASS 0)
Adjusting the clock
1) Press the clock button H (5) to adjust
the hours.
Press the clock button M (6) to adjust
the minutes.
2) Hold the button depressed to automatically increment the number.
3) To reset the clock to an hour signal,
press the clock button H (5) while holding the clock button M (6) depressed.
Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0)
NOTE:
When the clock has not been set, the time
“12:00” will flash in the display.
Clock reset is effected as follows:
• When minutes are between 00 and 29,
the clock will reset to the current hour.
(example: 12:23 ➔ 12:00)
Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0)
Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control)
The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function
automatically
adjusts
(increases/
decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control
is provided with three selectable levels
(LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume
adjustment increases together with the
LEVEL number,
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode
is selected.
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) to select the desired AVC
adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL
2)
Adjusting the contrast of the display
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) and preset button 5 (3), preset
button 6 (4) simultaneously.
2) To adjust the contrast of the display,
turn the power on/off knob (1).
Fader adjustment (FADER 0)
AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2)
Original mode
66J224
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control
knob (2) to adjust the sound.
5-39
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to the Radio
Display
(C)
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A)
(B)
(D)
66J097
(2)
(3)
(6)
(1)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Band switch button (FM/AM)
Seek up button
Seek down button
Manual tuning knob
Preset buttons (1 to 6)
Auto store button (AS)/
Scan button (SCAN)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Band
Preset channel number
Stereo indicator
Frequency
(5)
79KA003
5-40
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting the reception band
Press the band switch button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the reception band is switched as follows:
66J098
Seek tuning
Press the seek up button (2) or the seek
down button (3).
The unit stops searching for a station at a
frequency where a broadcast station is
available.
Manual tuning
Turn the manual tuning knob (4).
The frequency being received is displayed.
Preset memory
1) Select the desired station.
2) Select the preset button (5) to which
you want to store the station and press
and hold the button for 2 seconds or
longer.
Auto store
Press and hold the auto store button (6) for
2 seconds or longer.
Six stations in total are automatically
stored to the preset buttons (5) in sequential order, starting from the lower frequencies.
Scan tuning
1) Press the scan button (6).
Stations are automatically sought for in
a sequential order, starting from a station being currently received, and scan
stops for 5 seconds at a frequency
where there is a station available.
2) Press the scan button (6) again to stop
scanning at the frequency being currently received.
Receiving a stereo broadcast station
If a stereo broadcast station is received,
the stereo indicator will light.
NOTE:
• When the auto store is performed, the
station previously stored in the memory
at the position is overwritten.
• When there are fewer than 6 stations
that can be stored even if 2 rounds of
auto store operation are performed, the
stations previously stored at the remaining preset buttons (5) are not overwritten.
5-41
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Radio Reception
Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio
signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may
interfere or deflect radio reception, causing
poor reception. Poor reception or radio
static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage
power lines.
Listening to a CD
CAUTION
(A)
52D274
• CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A)
cannot be used.
• Some discs previously recorded in CDR\CD-RW format may not be used.
• Never insert your finger or hand
into the CD insertion slot. Never
insert foreign objects.
• Never insert a CD with glue coming
out from adhesive tape or a rental
CD label or with a trace indicating
that adhesive tape or a rental CD
label has been removed. This may
cause the CD not to eject or result
in a malfunction.
52D291
• A CD is inserted with its label facing
upward.
• When there is a CD already loaded in
the unit, another CD cannot be loaded at
the same time. Do not use force when
inserting the CD into the CD insertion
slot.
• If a blank disc (non-recorded CD-R) is
loaded in the unit, the disc will be
ejected.
5-42
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
Display
(D)
(A)
(B)
(C)
66J100
(1)
(6)
(3)
(2)
(4)
(5)
79KA004
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
CD insertion slot
CD eject button
Disc button (CD/AUX)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Repeat button (RPT)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Mode indicator
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
NOTE:
About Single CDs (8 cm CDs)
• No adapter is required to play a single
CD.
• A single CD is inserted from the center
of the CD insertion slot.
• Since an ejected single CD is not automatically reloaded, be sure to remove
the ejected single CD.
5-43
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Loading a CD
Insert a CD in the CD insertion slot (1).
When a CD is loaded, play starts and the
CD indicator (A) lights.
Ejecting a CD
Press the CD eject button (2).
If you left a CD ejected for a period of
about 15 seconds, it will be automatically
drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload function)
The backup eject function:
This function allows you to eject a CD with
the power turned off by pressing the CD
eject button (2).
CAUTION
If you forcefully try to push an ejected
CD inside the unit before auto reloading, the disc surface might be
scratched.
Listening to a CD
When a CD is inserted, it is automatically
played back.
When a CD is already inside the unit,
press the disc button (3) to play back the
CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD
indicator (A) is lit on the display unit.
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (4) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (5) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (5) is
pressed once, the track being currently
played will return to the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (4) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (5) to rewind a
track.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
64J287
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (6) to change the repeat play mode to
OFF.
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
The track currently being played is
played repeatedly.
5-44
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to an MP3/WMA Disc
Display
(D)
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A)
(B)
(E) (F)
(C)
66J104
(2)
(5)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Sound control knob
Repeat button (RPT)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Display button (DISP)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
Folder number
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
WMA indicator
MP3 indicator
79KA005
5-45
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
What is MP3/WMA?
MP3 (MPEG1/2 Audio Layer-III) and WMA
(Windows MediaTM Audio) are the compression formats of digital audio. The
former is developed by MPEG (Motion Picture Experts Group), and the latter is
developed by Microsoft Corporation. Using
these compression formats, you can
record the contents of about 10 music CDs
on a single CD media (This figures refer to
data recorded on a 650 MB CD-R or CDRW at a fixed bit rate of 128 kbps and a
sampling frequency of 44.1 kHz).
Points to remember when making MP3/
WMA files
Common
• High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds.
• Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not
recommended because playing time is
not displayed properly and sound may
be skipped.
• The playback sound quality differs
depending on the encoding circumstances. For details, refer to the user
manual of your own encoding software
and writing software.
MP3
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to
“128 kbps or more” and “fixed”.
WMA
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to
“64 kbps or more” and “fixed”.
• Do not set the copy protect attribute on
the WMA file to enable this unit to play
back.
NOTE:
Never assign the “.mp3”, or “.wma” file
name extension to a file that is not in the
MP3/WMA format. This may not only produce noise from the speaker damage, but
also damage your hearing.
Recording MP3/WMA files on a CDmedia
• You are recommended to minimize the
chances of making a disc that contains
both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA files.
• If CD-DA files are on the same disc as
MP3 or WMA files, the songs may not
play in the intended order, or some
songs may not play at all.
• When storing MP3 data and WMA data
on the same disc, use different folders
for each data.
• Do not record files other than MP3/WMA
files and unnecessary folder on a disc.
• The name of an MP3/WMA file should
be added by rules as shown in the following descriptions and also comply with
the rules of each file system.
• The file extension “.mp3” or “.wma”
should be assigned to each file depending on the file format.
• You may encounter trouble in playing
MP3/WMA files or displaying the information of MP3/WMA files recorded with
certain writing software or CD recorders.
• This unit does not have a play list function.
• Although Multi-session recording is supported, the use of Disc-at-Once is recommended.
5-46
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Compression formats
MP3
• Bit rate
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 32 k - 320 kbps
MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 8 k - 160 kbps
• Sampling frequency
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 44.1 k/48 k/32
kHz
MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 22.05 k/24 k/16
kHz
WMA (Ver.7, Ver.8, Ver.9*)
• Bit rate
32 k - 192 kbps
• Sampling frequency
44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz
* WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are
not supported.
Maximum number of files/folders
• Maximum number of files:
999(files + folders)
• Maximum number of files in one folder:
255
• Maximum depth of trees: 8
• Maximum number of folders: 255
(Root folder is included.)
MP3/WMA MODE
Selecting a folder
Turn the sound control knob (1) to select a
folder.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (2).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
FOLDER REPEAT
66J128
Supported file systems
ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Apple Extension
to ISO 9660, Joliet, Romeo
5-47
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (2) several times to change the repeat
play mode to OFF.
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
The track currently being played is
played repeatedly.
• FOLDER REPEAT
The indication “FOLDER RPT” appears
in the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (D) lights.
All the tracks in the folder currently being
played are played repeatedly.
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (4) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (4) is
pressed once, the track currently being
played will start again at the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a
track.
Displaying CD titles
Press the display button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, the title
changes as follows:
OFF
FOLDER TITLE
ALBUM TITLE
FILE TITLE
ARTIST TITLE
TRACK TITLE
66J146
Forwarding a title
If there is a title with 12 letters or more,
each press will show next letters in the display. (No scrolling is made.)
Press and hold the display button (5) for 2
seconds or longer. A title is changed.
5-48
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to Audio for AUX
Display
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A)
80JA007
(1) Aux button (CD/AUX)
(2) Aux input connector
(A) Mode indicator
(1)
(2)
79KA006
5-49
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Aux function
This system has an external input terminal
so you can listen to audio from an external
device connected to this unit.
Press the aux button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
selected mode is switched as follows:
CD
AUX1
NOTE:
• AUX1 is displayed when an external
component is connected to the frontpanel AUX input connector.
• Use a stereo 3.5 mm miniplug cord to
connect external components to the
AUX input connector.
CAUTION
• Do not attempt to connect or operate an external component while
engaged in driving.
• Do not allow the cord to interfere
with the driver’s actions.
• If an external component is connected when its audio volume has
been set to a high level, a loud
sound volume may suddenly be
produced.
80JA008
5-50
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option)
Display
(C)
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A)
(B)
66J107
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(8)
(6)
XM button
Category button (CAT)
Seek up button
Seek down button
Manual tuning knob
Display button (DISP)
Preset button (1 to 6)
Scan button (SCAN)
(5)
(A) Band
(B) Channel number
(C) Category indicator
(2)
If you want to purchase XM Satellite Radio
Service, contact your SUZUKI dealer.
It is necessary to buy a special tuner to
receive XM broadcasting.
(7)
79KA007
Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM
Satellite Radio anywhere in the United
States except Hawaii, Alaska, and Canada.
5-51
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
XM MODE
Selecting a band
Press the XM button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the band
changes in the following order.
XM1
XM2
Selecting a category
Press the seek up button (3) or seek down
button (4) to select a category.
Displaying the category
Press the category button (2) to have the
currently selected category appear on the
display.
XM3
Selecting a channel
Turn the manual tuning knob (5) to select a
channel.
66J129
Selecting a category
Press the seek up button (3) or the seek
down button (4). The category is changed.
Turning the category function on/off
Press and hold the category button (2) for
2 seconds or longer, and “CATEGORY
ON” appears on the display, the CAT indicator (C) lights up and the CATEGORY
function is activated.
Press and hold the category button (2) for
2 seconds or longer again, and “CATEGORY OFF” appears on the display and
the CAT indicator (C) turns off, indicating
that the CATEGORY function has been
turned off.
NOTE:
The first time you use the radio, turn the
category function on.
NOTE:
When the category function is on, only
those channels included in the selected
category can be selected.
Selecting the item to be displayed
Press the display button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the item
on display changes in the following order.
CH NUMBER
TITLE
CH NAME
and hold the button for 2 seconds or
longer.
Scan tuning
1) Press the scan button (8).
Stations are automatically searched for
in a sequential order, starting from the
station being currently received, and
scan tuning stops for 5 seconds at the
frequency where there is a station available.
2) Press the scan button (8) again to stop
scanning at the frequency currently
being received.
Satellite Radio Reception
Satellite radio receives signals from two
satellites in orbit over the equator. Therefore, satellite radio reception can be interrupted when there are objects south of
your vehicle. To help compensate for this,
ground-based repeaters are placed in
major metropolitan areas, but depending
on the geographic situation (for example, if
mountains or buildings are on the south
side of your vehicle), you may experience
reception problems.
NAME
66J130
Preset memory
1) Select the desired station.
2) Select the preset button (7) to which
you want to store the station and press
5-52
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to Audio for AUX (Option)
Display
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A)
80JA011
(1) Aux button (CD/AUX)
(A) Mode indicator
Aux function
This system has an external input terminal
so you can listen to audio from an external
device connected to this unit.
(1)
Press the aux button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
selected mode is switched as follows:
CD
AUX2
80JA012
79KA008
NOTE:
• AUX2 is displayed when an external
component is connected to the AUX
(Option) input connector.
• Use a stereo 3.5 mm miniplug cord to
connect external components to the
AUX input connector.
5-53
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option)
Display
(G)
(E) (F)
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(A) (B)
(C)
(D)
66J113
(5)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(6)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Disc button (CD/AUX)
Disc select buttons (1 to 6)
Track up button/Fast forward button
Track down button/Rewind button
Repeat button (RPT)
Category button (CAT)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
(G)
Mode indicator
Disc number
Track number
Play time
Repeat indicator
Random indicator
CD changer number
(2)
79KA009
5-54
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting a CD changer mode
Press the disc button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
selected CD plays as follows:
Built-in CD player
Selecting a track
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to
the next track.
• Press the track down button (4) twice to
listen to the previous track.
When the track down button (4) is
pressed once, the track currently being
played will start again at the beginning.
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to
advance a track rapidly.
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a
track.
CD changer 1
To cancel random play, press the category
button (6) several times to change the random play mode to OFF.
• TRACK RANDOM
The tracks in the disc that is loaded are
played at random.
• DISC RANDOM
The tracks in all discs are played at random.
NOTE:
The random play can be operated with the
External CD Changer (Option) only.
CD changer 2
52D300
• When only one CD changer is connected to this unit, CD changer 2 is
skipped.
• When no CD is loaded in the built-in CD
player, the built-in CD player is skipped.
Selecting a disc
Press the disc select button (2) corresponding to the disc number you want to
listen to.
Play starts from the first track on the disc. If
a disc number having no disc is pressed,
the selection will be invalid.
Random play
Press the category button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
changes in the following order.
Repeat play
Press the repeat button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, repeat
play mode changes as follows:
TRACK RANDOM
OFF
TRACK REPEAT
OFF
DISC RANDOM
DISC REPEAT
66J131
66J144
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
NOTE:
This operation should be performed within
2 seconds.
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (5) several times to change the repeat
play mode to OFF.
5-55
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
• TRACK REPEAT
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (E) lights.
The track being currently played is
played repeatedly.
Remote Audio Controls
(if equipped)
To control the volume:
• To increase the volume, push the upper
part of the switch (1). The volume continues to increase until you release the
switch.
• To decrease the volume, push the lower
part of the switch (1). The volume continues to decrease until you release the
switch.
• To mute, push the switch (2).
• DISC REPEAT
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in
the display for 2 seconds and then the
repeat indicator (E) lights.
When all the tracks on a disc being currently played finish playing, play starts
again at the beginning of the disc.
To select the mode (AM1, AM2, FM1, FM2,
XM (option), CD, AUX1, External CDchanger (option), AUX2 (option)), push the
switch (3).
You can also turn on the audio system by
pushing the switch (3).
(2)
(3)
(1)
(4)
79K052
You can control basic functions of the
audio system with the switches on the
steering wheel.
To change the radio station:
• To advance to the next preset station,
push the upper part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To select the previous preset station,
push the lower part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To scan to a higher frequency radio station, push and hold the upper part of the
switch (4).
• To scan to a lower frequency radio station, push and hold the lower part of the
switch (4).
5-56
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
To change the selection on a CD:
• To advance to the next track on a CD,
push the upper part of the switch (4)
briefly.
• To select the previous track on a CD,
push the lower part of the switch (4).
Anti-Theft Feature
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player)
(2)
(1)
(3)
79KA010
5-57
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
(1) Power on/off knob
(2) Track up button/Fast forward button
(3) Preset buttons (1 to 6)
The anti-theft feature is intended to discourage theft or the audio system by preventing the system from operating when it
is moved to a different vehicle.
This feature works by allowing you to enter
a Personal Identification Number (PIN).
When the audio system is disconnected
from its power source, such as when the
audio system is removed or the battery is
disconnected, the system will not operate
again unless the PIN is reentered.
Setting the Anti-Theft Function
NOTE:
Establish your PIN by combining numbers
from 1 to 6 into any 4-digit number. If you
forget your PIN, when you remove the battery for repair etc., you will no longer be
able to operate the audio system.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66J117
5) Input the same 4-digit number you previously entered.
66J117
3) Input the four digit PIN using preset buttons 1 to 6.
1) Turn off the power by pressing the
power on/off knob (1).
66J120
6) The power of the audio system will turn
off.
66J118
66J118
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while
pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “ENTRY 0000” will blink
and the audio system enter PIN-input
mode.
4) After you enter your four digit PIN, the
display will return to “0000”.
NOTE:
Write down your PIN for the future use.
Canceling Your Established PIN
Setting
This operation is to be done when you
want to cancel the anti-theft function or
change your PIN.
1) Turn off the power by pressing the
power on/off knob (1).
5-58
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Confirming Your Personal Identification Number (PIN)
When the main power source is disconnected such as when you exchange your
battery, etc, you will have to confirm your
PIN to be able to use the audio system.
66J121
To confirm your PIN:
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while
pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “DELETE 0000” will blink
and the audio system will enter the cancel mode.
EXAMPLE
66J122
registered PIN, the power of the audio
system will turn off, and you will be able
to operate the audio system.
NOTE:
• If you input your PIN incorrectly, “----” will
be displayed and the anti-theft function
lock mode is entered. If you enter an
incorrect PIN fewer than 6 times, the
locking time will be for 15 seconds; if you
enter an incorrect PIN more than 6
times, the locking time will be for 15 minutes.
• If you forget your PIN and enter a wrong
PIN, you cannot perform any further
operation.
1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC”
position.
EXAMPLE
66J124
3) Input your PIN. The power of the audio
system will turn off and your PIN will be
deleted.
To change your PIN, first delete your
current PIN, then set a new one.
66J125
2) Input your PIN.
If the PIN that you input matches the
5-59
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Troubleshooting
Applicable to every device
Phenomenon
Power is not turned on.
(No sound is produced)
Cause
Remedy
Fuse is blown.
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.
Connections are not properly made.
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.
Radio
Phenomenon
Cause
Remedy
Too much noise.
Not tuned correctly to the frequency of a station.
Tune correctly to the station frequency.
Stations cannot be selected by
seek tuning.
There is no station with strong radio waves.
Select stations by manual tuning.
CD
Phenomenon
Cause
Remedy
Compact disc cannot be loaded.
Another compact disc is already loaded.
Eject the compact disc before loading a new
one.
Sound skips or is noisy.
Compact disc is dirty.
Clean the compact disc with a soft cloth.
Compact disc is heavily scratched or warped.
Replace with a compact disc with no scratches.
Water droplets may form on the internal lens
when the car is parked in a humid place.
Let dry for about 1 hour with the power on.
Sound is bad directly after power
is turned on.
5-60
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Error display
This unit has a number of self-diagnostic functions to protect the system.
If a problem should occur, the display shows the type of error. Refer to the table below and take proper measures to correct the problem.
If the problem is corrected, the unit will operate normally.
Error display
Measures to be taken
CD/CD changer “Mechanical error”.
This error display indicates a mechanical failure in the CD changer
(failure to change or eject a disc).
The mechanism is probably damaged. Contact your authorized
SUZUKI dealer.
CD/CD changer “Focus error”.
The pick-up-focus is not properly functioning during playback due to
damage on the disc or for other reasons.
Check disc for damage.
CD/CD changer “Disc error”.
The CD is inserted upside down or only an eight-centimeter CD
adapter is equipped.
Check disc for correct loading.
If an error display not listed above appears, turn off the unit and contact your SUZUKI dealer.
5-61
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Fuel Filler Cap
of the driver’s seat and can be locked by
simply closing the door.
EXAMPLE
(1)
EXAMPLE
Open
Close
(2)
78K156
78K145
79K053
To remove the fuel filler cap:
1) Open the fuel filler door.
2) Remove the cap by turning it counterclockwise.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Remove the fuel filler cap slowly. The
fuel may be under pressure and may
spray out, causing injury.
NOTE:
The cap holder (1) can hold the fuel filler
cap (2) when refueling.
To reinstall the fuel filler cap:
1) Turn the cap clockwise until you hear
several clicks.
2) Close the fuel filler door.
WARNING
Fuel is extremely flammable. Do not
smoke when refueling, and make
sure there are no open flames or
sparks in the area.
64J253
The fuel filler cap is located on the right
rear side of the vehicle. The fuel filler door
can be unlocked by pulling up on the
opener lever located on the outboard side
5-62
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
WARNING
Engine Hood
If you need to replace the fuel cap,
use a genuine SUZUKI cap. Use of an
improper cap can result in a malfunction of the fuel system or emission
control system. It may also result in
fuel leakage in the event of an accident.
64J111
64J110
To open the engine hood:
1) Pull the hood release handle located on
the outboard side of the driver’s side of
the instrument panel. This will disengage the engine hood lock halfway.
2) Push the under-hood release lever
sideways with your finger, as shown in
the illustration. While pushing the lever,
lift up the engine hood.
5-63
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Sun Visor
Interior Light Switch
Center
EXAMPLE
(3)
(2)
(1)
(1)
64J112
3) Continue to lift up the hood until it is
high enough to support with the prop
rod.
To close the engine hood:
1) Lift the hood up slightly and remove the
prop rod from the hole. Put the prop rod
back to the holding clip.
2) Lower the hood close to the bumper,
then let it drop down.
Make sure the hood is securely latched
after closing.
WARNING
Make sure the hood is fully closed
and latched before driving. If it is not,
it can fly up unexpectedly during
driving, obstructing your view and
resulting in an accident.
79K055
The sun visors can be pulled down to block
glare coming through the windshield, or
they can be unhooked and turned to the
side to block glare coming through the side
window.
The extension (1) can be drawn out to
block glare widely.
64J104
Rear
(3)
(2)
(1)
CAUTION
When unhooking and hooking a sun
visor, be sure to handle it by the hard
plastic parts or the sun visor can be
damaged.
64J211
This light switch has three positions which
function as described below:
5-64
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
ON (1)
The light comes on and stays on regardless of whether the door is open or closed.
DOOR (2)
The light comes on when the door is
opened.
After closing all doors (including the tailgate), the light will remain on for about 15
seconds and then fade out. If you push in
the ignition switch or insert the key during
this time, the light will start to fade out
immediately.
After removing the key from the ignition
switch, the light will turn on for about 15
seconds and then fade out.
OFF (3)
The light remains off even when the door is
opened.
Luggage Compartment Light
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
78K146
NOTE:
The number of doors involved in the lighting operation of the interior light depends
on the vehicle specification. If there is a
switch (rubber projection) at the door
opening as shown, the door is involved in
the lighting operation.
66J047
The luggage compartment light is located
at the left side of the rear luggage compartment.
When you open any of the doors including
the tailgate with the luggage compartment
light switch in the “DOOR” position (1), the
light comes on and remains on as long as
you keep the door open.
After closing all doors, the light will remain
on for about 15 seconds and then fade out.
If you push in the ignition switch or insert
the key during this time, the light will start
to fade out immediately.
After removing the key from the ignition
switch, the light will turn on for about 15
seconds and then fade out.
When the luggage compartment light
switch is in the “OFF” position (2), the light
5-65
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
remains off regardless of whether the
door(s) is(are) opened or closed.
Spot Light
Accessory Socket
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(1)
65J093
Push the switch (1) to turn on the light and
push it again to turn off the light.
78K141
EXAMPLE
64J120
5-66
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
The accessory socket will work when the
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray
(if equipped)
12-volt accessory sockets are located both
on the center console and on the left side
of the luggage compartment.
Cigarette Lighter
EXAMPLE
Depending on the specification, there are
two sockets on the center console.
Each socket can be used to provide 12
volt/120 watt power for electrical accessories when used alone. Make sure that the
cap remains on the socket when the socket
is not in use.
CAUTION
• To avoid damage to the cigarette
lighter socket, do not use it as
other accessories’ power source.
Some accessories’ power plug can
damage the inner mechanism of
the cigarette lighter socket.
• Holding the cigarette lighter in can
overheat and damage the lighter.
Release the lighter after you push it
in.
CAUTION
• To prevent the fuse from being
blown, when using sockets at the
same time, do not exceed the total
combined power capacity of 120
watts.
• Use of inappropriate electrical
accessories can cause damage to
your vehicle’s electrical system.
Make sure that any electrical accessories you use are designed to
plug into this type of socket.
78K139
The cigarette lighter will work when the
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
To use the cigarette lighter, push it all the
way into the receptacle and release it. It
will automatically heat up and will pop out
to its normal position when it is ready for
use.
5-67
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Sunroof (if equipped)
Ashtray
EXAMPLE
64J201
You can fit the ashtray into any of the cup
holders on the center console.
WARNING
Make sure tobacco is fully extinguished before closing the ashtrays.
Never throw waste in the ashtrays: it
could create a fire hazard.
You can tilt or slide the sunroof by operating the “TILT” part of the sunroof switch or
the “SLIDE” part of the sunroof switch
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
There is a system to prevent being pinched
by the sunroof.
When the system senses that something is
pinched when the sunroof is sliding forward, the sunroof will automatically reverse
direction and slide rearward. This system
will operate when the sunroof is closing
automatically. This system does not operate when tilting the sunroof down.
Make sure there are no hands or other
obstructions in the path of the sunroof
when you close the sunroof even though
there is a system to prevent being pinched
by the sunroof.
WARNING
• The system to prevent being
pinched by the sunroof does not
work in the area where the sunroof
is almost completely closed.
• The system to prevent being
pinched by the sunroof may not
work if the battery is not sufficiently charged.
(1)
(2)
79K097
To tilt the sunroof up, slide the sun shade
rearward by hand and push the “TILT UP”
part (1) of the sunroof switch. To tilt the
sunroof down, push the “SLIDE OPEN”
part (2) of the sunroof switch.
If you push the switch for more than a second, the sunroof will automatically tilt up or
down fully. To stop the sunroof halfway,
push the switch briefly.
5-68
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
movement stops completely, release
the switch. The features are reactivated.
3) Make sure you can open or close the
sunroof automatically by pushing the
sunroof switch for more than about a
second.
(1)
(2)
79K098
64J109
To slide the sunroof rearward, push the
“SLIDE OPEN” part (2) of the sunroof
switch. To side the sunroof forward, push
the “TILT UP” part (1) of the sunroof
switch.
If you push the switch for more than a second, the sunroof will automatically slide
fully rearward or forward. To stop the sunroof halfway, push the switch briefly.
The sun shade will open automatically and
cannot be closed when the sunroof is slid
rearward.
How to reactivate the system to prevent
being pinched by the sunroof
When you disconnect the negative (–) terminal from the battery or change the fuses,
the features below will not operate.
• The system to prevent being pinched by
the sliding sunroof.
• The system to automatically open or
close the sunroof fully.
In this case, you must reactivate the features using the following procedures.
1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”
position.
2) Push and hold the “TILT UP” part (1) of
the sunroof switch, the sunroof will tilt
up fully and then down slightly. After the
65D612
WARNING
• Never allow any part of your body
such as hands or head to get out of
the sunroof opening while the vehicle is moving.
• Be sure there are no hands or other
obstructions in the path of the sunroof when you close the sunroof.
(Continued)
5-69
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
WARNING
Assist Grips (if equipped)
Coat Hooks (if equipped)
(Continued)
• Always remove the ignition key
when leaving the vehicle even if for
a short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle.
Unattended children could use the
sunroof switches and get trapped
by the sunroof.
CAUTION
Do not put your body weight on the
roof around the sunroof such as by
sitting on it.
64J136
Assist grips are provided for convenience.
• Be sure to close the sunroof when you
leave the vehicle unattended.
• Periodically inspect the guide rail for dirt
and clean it if any dirt has accumulated.
64J137
You can hang clothing on the coat hooks.
These hooks are not designed for large or
heavy items.
WARNING
If your vehicle is equipped with side
curtain air bags, do not hang sharp
items like a hanger on the coat hook.
When hanging the clothes, hang it on
the hook without using a hanger.
5-70
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Glove Box
Overhead Console Box
(if equipped)
CAUTION
If you park your vehicle outdoors in
direct sunlight or in hot weather, the
eyeglasses compartment can get
very hot since it is close to the roof.
So, when parking in such conditions:
• Do not leave eyeglasses in the
compartment. The heat may distort
plastic lenses or frames.
• Do not place flammable items, such
as a lighter, in the compartment.
The heat may cause a fire.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(1)
78K136
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
79K056
To open the glove box, pull the latch lever.
To close it, push the lid until it latches
securely. If a lock is equipped on the latch
lever, lock the glove box by inserting the
key and turning it clockwise and unlock the
glove box by turning the key counterclockwise.
WARNING
To use the overhead console box, push on
the front edge (1) and open the lid. To
close the lid, push the front edge (1) until it
latches. Do not put heavy or sharp items in
the box.
NOTE:
An aftermarket garage door opener can be
installed in the front side overhead console
box.
WARNING
Never drive with the overhead console box lid open. It could cause
injury if an accident occurs.
Never drive with the glove box lid
open. It could cause injury if an accident occurs.
5-71
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Cup Holder and Storage Bin
(if equipped)
WARNING
Do not use the cup holder or the storage bin to hold cups containing hot
liquids or sharp-edged, hard or
breakable objects. Objects in these
bins may be thrown about during a
sudden stop or impact, and could
cause personal injury.
Cup holders and a storage bin are provided as shown.
EXAMPLE
Bottle holder
64J115
To use the console bin, pull the lever up
and open the lid.
79K140
To access a bin, push the release button.
EXAMPLE
64J200
You should hold a bottle with a cap in the
bottle holder.
64J116
To use the rear cup holders, open the lid.
5-72
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Front Seat Back Pocket
(if equipped)
Shopping Hook (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Armrest
CAUTION
To avoid damage to the armrest, do
not lean on it or allow a child to sit on
it.
EXAMPLE
Center Console Armrest
66J049
64J127
This pocket is provided for holding light
and soft things such as gloves, newspapers or magazines.
The shopping hooks are located on both
sides of the luggage compartment.
You can hang the shopping bag or other
suitable objects on the hook. This hook is
not designed for large or heavy items.
WARNING
Do not put hard or breakable objects
in the pocket. If an accident occurs,
objects such as bottles, cans, etc.
can injure the occupants in the rear
seat.
64J263
5-73
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Floor Mats (if equipped)
WARNING
Failure to take the following precautions may result in the driver’s side
floor mat interfering with the pedals
and causing a loss of vehicle control
or an accident.
• Make sure that the floor mat grommet(s) is(are) hooked to the fastener(s).
• Never place additional floor mats
on top of the existing floor mats.
EXAMPLE
80J2014
Your vehicle has a fastener to keep the
driver’s side floor mat from sliding forward
and possibly interfering with the pedals.
Whenever you put the driver’s side floor
mat back in the vehicle after it has been
removed, be sure to hook the floor mat
grommet(s) to the fastener(s) and position
the floor mat properly in the footwell.
When you replace the floor mats in your
vehicle with a different type such as allweather floor mats, we highly recommend
using genuine SUZUKI floor mats for
proper fitting.
Luggage Compartment Cover
Luggage or other cargo placed in the luggage compartment can be hidden from
view by a luggage compartment cover.
However, the luggage compartment covers
are not designed to support items loaded
on top of them, and may get damaged if
used as a shelf.
WARNING
Do not carry items on top of the luggage compartment cover, even if they
are small and light. Objects on top of
the cover could be thrown about in an
accident, causing injury, or could
obstruct the driver’s rear view.
CAUTION
To avoid damaging the luggage compartment cover:
• Do not place items on top of it.
• Do not push down on it or lean on
it.
• Handle it carefully when installing
or removing.
NOTE:
The seatback should always be securely
latched in a fairly upright position when
removing or installing the luggage compartment cover.
5-74
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
To remove the luggage compartment
cover:
rear
front
(b)
(a)
(a)
66J205
3) Lift up both ends of the cover to disengage the attachment points (b).
66J203
1) Release the three hooks (a) from the
rear seat backs.
(c)
66J204
2) Fold and roll the cover forward.
66J228
4) Place one end of the cover in the quarter window opening (c) so enough
5-75
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
clearance is established on the other
end to swing the cover down and out.
To stow a luggage compartment cover
on the floor of the rear luggage room:
To reinstall the luggage compartment
cover:
(c)
78K147
78K148
5) Tilt the luggage compartment cover,
and then remove the compartment
cover from the vehicle.
1) Fold/roll the luggage compartment
cover, and place one end in the quarter
window opening (c) to swing the other
end into position.
CAUTION
When you place the end of the cover
in the quarter window opening (c), be
careful not to damage the window or
other materials while positioning the
compartment cover.
66J207
Tilt the cover, and fit it onto floor of the rear
luggage room.
5-76
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Underfloor Bins (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
(d)
(e)
(A)
(b)
66J209
66J210
2) Align the attachment points (d) on the
cover with the attachment points (b) on
the vehicle and push down both ends.
Make sure that the cover securely fits in
the attachment points.
3) Unroll/unfold the cover as you secure
the other latches (e).
64J132
Pull up the strap (A) to open the bin.
CAUTION
Do not allow items in the bins to
extend above the top of the bin. Otherwise, the bin or luggage floor may
be damaged.
(a)
(a)
66J229
4) Reattach the three hooks (a) to the rear
seat backs.
5-77
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Luggage Restraint Loops
(if equipped)
WARNING
The luggage restraint loops and
optional rubber net can be used to
help keep lightweight cargo from
moving around in the luggage compartment during normal driving. They
are neither capable of nor intended
for preventing cargo from being
thrown around in a crash.
Place heavier objects on the floor
and as far forward in the cargo area
as possible. Never pile cargo higher
than the top of the seat backs.
64J129
Four luggage restraint loops are provided
on the luggage compartment floor. An
optional rubber net can be hooked to these
loops to help keep cargo from moving
around in the luggage compartment during
normal driving.
Roof Rails or Roof Rack
Anchors (if equipped)
Roof rails
WARNING
Do not attach the child restraint top
strap to the luggage restraint loops.
Incorrectly attached top strap will
reduce the intended effectiveness of
the child restraint system.
64J133
Roof rack anchors
(1)
64J224
5-78
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
You can use the roof rails or the roof rack
anchors to attach the optional roof rack
which is available at your SUZUKI dealer. If
you use a roof rack, observe the instructions and precautions in this section and
provided with the roof rack.
(For vehicles with roof rack anchors)
To remove the cap, slide the cap in the
direction of the arrow (1) and then lift the
edge of the cap up as shown in the illustration. To install the cap, put in the front part
of the cap, slide the cap in the opposite
direction of the arrow (1) and then push
down the rear part of the cap.
• Make sure the roof rack is securely
installed.
• To mount various types of cargo (such
as skis, bicycles, etc.) properly, use suitable attachments which are available
from your SUZUKI dealer. Be sure to
install the attachments properly and
securely according to the instructions
provided. Do not mount cargo directly on
the roof panel. The cargo can damage
the roof panel.
• The gross weight of the roof rack plus
cargo must not exceed the loading
capacity (75 kg (165 lbs)). Also, do not
let the gross vehicle weight (fully loaded
vehicle including driver, passengers,
cargo, roof load and trailer tongue
weight) exceed the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the
driver’s door lock pillar.
• Mount and secure the cargo onto the
roof rack properly according to the
instructions provided. Be sure to stow
the heaviest items at the bottom and distribute the cargo as evenly as possible.
• Do not carry items so large that they
hang over the bumpers or the sides of
the vehicle, or block your view.
• Secure the front and rear ends of long
items – such as wood panels, surfboards
and so forth – to both the front and rear
of the vehicle. You should protect the
painted surfaces of the vehicle from
scuffing caused by tie-down ropes.
• Check periodically to make sure the roof
rack is securely installed and free from
damage.
• For vehicles with roof rack anchors,
make sure the anchors are covered with
the caps when not in use.
WARNING
• Abrupt maneuvers or failure to
properly secure cargo can allow the
cargo to fly off the vehicle and hit
others, causing personal injury or
property damage.
• Mount cargo securely and avoid
abrupt maneuvers such as “jackrabbit” starts, sharp turns, fast cornering and sudden braking. Check
periodically to make sure that
cargo is securely fastened.
• Large, bulky, long, or flat items can
affect vehicle aerodynamics or be
caught by the wind, and can reduce
vehicle control resulting in an accident and personal injury. Drive cautiously at reduced speed when
carrying this type of cargo.
5-79
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
HomeLink® (if equipped)
any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door
that cannot detect an object – signaling the
door to stop and reverse – does not meet
current U.S. federal safety standards. For
more information, contact HomeLink® at
www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515.
66J092
HomeLink® and the HomeLink® house are
registered
trademarks
of
Johnson
Controls, Inc.
The HomeLink® Wireless Control System
provides a convenient way to replace up to
three hand-held radio-frequency (RF)
transmitters used to activate devices such
as gate operators, garage door openers,
entry door locks, security systems, even
home lighting. Additional HomeLink® information can be found on the Internet at
www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515.
Before programming HomeLink® to a
garage door opener or gate operator, make
sure that people and objects are out of the
way of the device to prevent potential harm
or damage. When programming a garage
door opener, it is advised to park outside of
the garage. Do not use HomeLink® with
any garage door opener that lacks safety
stop and reverse features as required by
U.S. federal safety standards (this includes
Retain the original transmitter of the RF
device you are programming for use in
other vehicles as well as for future
HomeLink® programming. It is also suggested that upon the sale of the vehicle,
the programmed HomeLink® buttons be
erased for security purposes. Refer to
“Programming HomeLink®” (step 1) only)
or, for assistance, contact HomeLink® at
www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515.
Programming HomeLink®
NOTE:
Some vehicles may require the ignition
switch to be turned to the second (or
“accessories”) position or the “on” position
for programming and/or operation of
HomeLink®. It is also recommended that a
new battery be placed in the hand-held
transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink® for quicker training and accurate transmission of the radiofrequency signal. Do not repeat “Programming HomeLink®” – step 1) to train additional devices to a second or third
HomeLink® button. Begin with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2).
66J050
1) Press and hold the two outer
HomeLink® buttons (buttons one and
three) – releasing only when the indicator light begins to flash (after 20 seconds). Do not hold the buttons for
longer than 30 seconds and do not
repeat step 1) to program a second
and/or third hand-held transmitter to the
remaining two HomeLink® buttons.
2) Position the end of your hand-held
transmitter 5–14 cm (1–3 inches) away
from the HomeLink® button you wish to
program while keeping the indicator
light in view.
3) Simultaneously press and hold both the
chosen HomeLink® and hand-held
transmitter buttons. Do not release the
buttons until step 4) has been completed.
5-80
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
Some gate operators and garage door
openers may require you to replace this
Programming step 3) with procedures
noted in the “Gate Operator / Canadian
Programming” section.
HomeLink®” steps 6–8 to complete the
programming of a rolling code
equipped device (most commonly a
garage door opener).
4) After the HomeLink® indicator light
changes from a slow to a rapidly blinking light, release both the HomeLink®
and hand-held transmitter buttons.
NOTE:
There are 30 seconds in which to initiate
step 8).
NOTE:
If the HomeLink® indicator light does not
change to a rapidly blinking light, contact
HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or call
1-800-355-3515 for assistance.
5) Press and hold the just-trained
HomeLink® button and observe the
indicator light.
– If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and
your device should activate when the
HomeLink® button is pressed and
released.
66J051
NOTE:
To program the remaining two HomeLink®
buttons,
begin
with
“Programming
HomeLink®” – step 2). Do not repeat step
1).
– If the indicator light blinks rapidly for
two seconds and then turns to a constant light continue with “Programming
6) At the garage door opener receiver
(motor-head unit) in the garage, locate
the “learn” or “smart” button. This can
usually be found where the hanging
antenna wire is attached to the motorhead unit.
7) Firmly press and release the “learn” or
“smart” button. (The name and color of
the button may vary by manufacturer.)
8) Return to the vehicle and firmly press,
hold for two seconds and release the
programmed
HomeLink®
button.
Repeat
the
“press/hold/release”
sequence a second time, and, depending on the brand of the garage door
opener (or other rolling code equipped
device), repeat this sequence a third
time to complete the programming process.
HomeLink® should now activate your
rolling code equipped device.
NOTE:
To program the remaining two HomeLink®
buttons,
begin
with
“Programming
HomeLink®” – step 2). Do not repeat step
1).
66J052
For questions or comments, please contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or
1-800-355-3515.
5-81
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Gate Operator / Canadian Programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require
transmitter signals to “time-out” (or quit)
after several seconds of transmission –
which may not be long enough for
HomeLink® to pick up the signal during
programming. Similar to this Canadian law,
some U.S. gate operators are designed to
“time-out” in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties programming a gate operator by
using the Programming procedures
(regardless of where you live), replace
“Programming HomeLink®” step 3) with
the following:
NOTE:
If programming a garage door opener or
gate operator, it is advised to unplug the
device during the “cycling” process to prevent possible overheating.
3) Continue to press and hold the
HomeLink® button while you press and
release – every two seconds (“cycle”)
your hand-held transmitter until the frequency signal has successfully been
accepted by HomeLink®. (The indicator
light will flash slowly and then rapidly.)
Using HomeLink®
To operate, simply press and release the
programmed HomeLink® button. Activation
will now occur for the trained device (i.e.
garage door opener, gate operator, security system, entry door lock, home/office
lighting, etc.). For convenience, the handheld transmitter of the device may also be
used at any time. In the event that there
are still programming difficulties or questions,
contact
HomeLink®
at
www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515.
Erasing HomeLink® Buttons
To erase programming from the three buttons (individual buttons cannot be erased
but can be “reprogrammed” as outlined
below), follow the step noted:
Reprogramming a Single
HomeLink® Button
To program a device to HomeLink® using a
HomeLink® button previously trained, follow these steps:
1) Press and hold the desired HomeLink®
button. DO NOT release the button.
2) The indicator light will begin to flash
after 20 seconds. Without releasing the
HomeLink® button, proceed with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2).
For questions or comments, contact
HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or 1800-355-3515.
Press and hold the two outer HomeLink®
buttons until the indicator light begins to
flash-after 20 seconds. Release both buttons. Do not hold for longer that 30 seconds. HomeLink® is now in the train (or
learning) mode and can be programmed at
any time beginning with “Programming
HomeLink®” – step 2).
Proceed with “Programming HomeLink®”
step 4) to complete.
5-82
79K21-03E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Frame Hooks
Frame hooks are provided at the front and
rear of the vehicle.
Front
To access the front hook, unhook the lower
part of the cover (1) and then remove the
cover (1).
(1)
WARNING
Do not use the frame hooks to tow
another vehicle or to have your vehicle towed on the road or highway.
The hooks are designed for use in
emergency situations only, such as if
your vehicle or another vehicle gets
stuck in deep mud or snow.
(2)
(2)
78K052
Rear
78K053
The frame hooks (2) are provided for shipping purposes only.
78K149
5-83
79K21-03E
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Vehicle Loading ................................................................... 6-1
Trailer Towing ...................................................................... 6-2
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) ...................... 6-7
6
54G215
79K21-03E
Vehicle Loading: 11
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Vehicle Loading
GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum permissible weight on an individual axle.
Vehicle Capacity Weight – Maximum permissible load weight a vehicle can carry
including the weight of all the occupants,
accessories, cargo, plus trailer tongue
weight (if towing a trailer).
54G307
Your vehicle was designed for specific
weight capacities. The weight capacities of
your vehicle are indicated by the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), the Gross
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR, front and rear)
and the Vehicle Capacity Weight. The
GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) are
listed on the Safety Certification Label
which is located below the driver’s side
door latch striker. The Vehicle Capacity
Weight is listed on the Tire Information
Label which is located below the Safety
Certification Label.
GVWR – Maximum permissible overall
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all the occupants, accessories and cargo
plus the trailer tongue weight if towing a
trailer).
The weight of any accessories already
installed on your vehicle at the time of purchase, or that you or the dealer install after
purchase, must be subtracted from the
Vehicle Capacity Weight to determine how
much capacity remains available for occupants, cargo, and trailer tongue weight (if
towing a trailer).
Contact your dealer for further information.
Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and
actual loads at the front and rear axles can
only be determined by weighing the vehicle
using a vehicle scale. To measure the
weight and load, try taking your vehicle to
a highway weighing station, shipping company or inspection station for trucks, etc.
Compare these weights to the GVWR and
GAWR (front and rear) listed on the Safety
Certification Label. If the gross vehicle
weight or the load on either axle exceeds
these ratings, you must remove enough
weight to bring the load down to the rated
capacity.
WARNING
Never overload your vehicle. The
gross vehicle weight (sum of the
weights of the loaded vehicle, driver
and passengers) must never exceed
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. In addition, never distribute a load so that the weight on either
the front or rear axle exceeds the
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
listed on the Safety Certification
Label.
WARNING
• Always distribute cargo evenly.
• To avoid personal injury or damage
to your vehicle, always secure
cargo to prevent it from shifting if
the vehicle moves suddenly.
• Place heavier objects on the floor
and as far forward in the cargo area
as possible. Never pile cargo
higher than the top of the seat
backs.
6-1
79K21-03E
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Trailer Towing
You can use your SUZUKI to tow a trailer,
but you should always observe the requirements and recommendations in this section. If you intend to tow a trailer, it is
essential to select a trailer and trailer towing equipment which are compatible. A
reputable trailer dealer can help you.
cool down. Refer to “If the Engine Overheats” section for details on how to deal
with overheating.
CAUTION
Towing in “D” range up a steep hill
can cause coolant overheating which
may result in engine/automatic transmission damage.
CAUTION
Trailer towing puts additional stress
on the engine, drive train and brakes
of your vehicle. Never tow a trailer
during the first 960 km (600 miles) of
vehicle operation.
CAUTION
Because towing a trailer puts additional stress on your vehicle, more
frequent
maintenance
will
be
required than under normal driving
conditions. Follow the schedule for
Maintenance Recommended Under
Severe Driving Conditions or perform
more frequent maintenance as necessary.
For Automatic transmission vehicles, shift
into “3” (Low 2) or “L” (Low 1) (if necessary)
and frequently monitor the coolant temperature gauge when towing up a steep hill. If
the gauge indicates overheating, park the
vehicle in a safe place and let the engine
Hitches
Use only a trailer hitch bracket that is
designed to bolt to the frame of your vehicle, and a hitch that is designed to bolt to
this bracket. We recommend that you use
a genuine SUZUKI trailer hitch bracket and
trailer hitch (available as options), or equivalent.
WARNING
Never use a bumper hitch or a hitch
which attaches to the axle of your
vehicle.
Safety Chains
Always attach safety chains between your
vehicle and trailer. Cross safety chains
under the tongue of the trailer so that the
tongue will not drop to the road if the trailer
becomes separated from the hitch. Follow
the manufacturer’s recommendation for
attaching safety chains. Always leave just
enough slack to permit full turning. Never
allow safety chains to drag on the road.
WARNING
Never attach safety chains to the
bumper of your vehicle. Secure connections so that they can’t come
loose.
Trailer Lights
Make sure your trailer is equipped with
lights which meet federal, state and local
requirements. Always check for the proper
operation of all trailer lights before you
start to tow.
WARNING
Never splice trailer lights directly into
your vehicle’s electrical system, or
electrical system damage may occur.
Brakes
WARNING
If trailer brakes are used, you should
follow all instructions provided by the
manufacturer. Never tap into the
brake system of your vehicle.
6-2
79K21-03E
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Tires
Gross Trailer Weight
Gross Combined Weight
WARNING
When towing a trailer, it is very
important for your vehicle and trailer
to have properly inflated tires. Your
vehicle’s tires should be inflated to
the recommended pressures listed
on your vehicle’s Tire Inflation Pressure label. Inflate trailer tires according to the specifications provided by
the trailer manufacturer.
Mirrors
Check to see if your vehicle’s mirrors meet
federal, state and local requirements for
mirrors used on towing vehicles. If they do
not, you must install required mirrors
before you tow.
Vehicle/Trailer Weight Limits
Before towing, you must make sure that
gross trailer weight, gross combined
weight, trailer tongue weight, gross vehicle
weight and gross axle weight (front and
rear) are within specified limits as
described below. You can measure vehicle
and trailer weights using a vehicle scale
and can measure tongue weight using a
bathroom scale.
60A378
60A381
Gross Trailer Weight is the weight of the
trailer plus all cargo in it (measured with
the trailer disconnected from the towing
vehicle). Gross trailer weight must never
exceed 1360 kg (3000 pounds).
Gross Combined Weight is the weight of
the fully loaded vehicle (including all the
occupants, accessories and cargo) plus
the weight of the fully loaded trailer. Gross
combined weight must never exceed:
• 2.4 L – 3460 kg (7628 pounds)
• 3.2 L – 3530 kg (7782 pounds)
If you intend to tow a trailer having a gross
trailer weight greater than 450 kg (1000
pounds), the trailer must be equipped with
trailer brakes.
6-3
79K21-03E
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Gross Vehicle Weight
Tongue Weight
Gross Axle Weight
60A380
60A379
60A382
Tongue Weight is the downward force
exerted on the hitch by the trailer coupler,
with the trailer fully loaded and the coupler
at its normal towing height. Cargo should
be distributed so that tongue weight is
approximately 10% of gross trailer weight.
Gross Vehicle Weight is the weight of the
fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the
trailer tongue weight). The gross vehicle
weight must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the
Safety Certification Label.
Gross Axle Weight (Front and Rear) is the
weight supported by an individual axle with
the vehicle fully loaded and the trailer connected. Gross axle weight for the front and
rear axles must never exceed the Gross
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed on the
Safety Certification Label.
NOTE:
You can usually get tongue weight to be
about 10% of gross trailer weight by placing about 60% of the total cargo weight in
the front half of the trailer. You should measure gross trailer weight and tongue weight
before towing, however, to make sure that
your load is properly distributed.
WARNING
Improper distribution of cargo in your
trailer may result in poor vehicle handling and swaying of the trailer.
Always make sure that trailer tongue
weight is about 10% of gross trailer
weight. Failure to observe this
requirement may result in an accident.
6-4
79K21-03E
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Additional Trailer Towing Warnings
WARNING
Never overload your trailer or your
vehicle. Gross Trailer Weight must
never exceed 1350 kg (3000 pounds).
Gross Combined Weight must never
exceed 3400 kg (7500 pounds) for
2WD or 3450 kg (7600 pounds) for
4WD.
Gross vehicle weight must never
exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. Gross axle weight for
the front and rear axles must not
exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label.
WARNING
Do not tow a trailer having a gross
trailer weight greater than 450 kg
(1000 pounds) unless the trailer is
equipped with trailer brakes.
WARNING
WARNING
Connect trailer lights and hook up
safety chains every time you tow.
WARNING
Your vehicle will handle differently
when towing a trailer. For your safety
and the safety of others, you should
observe the following precautions:
• Practice turning, stopping and
backing up before you begin towing in traffic. Do not tow in traffic
until you are confident that you can
handle the vehicle and trailer
safely.
• Never exceed posted towing speed
limits or 72 km/h (45 mph), whichever is lower.
• Never drive at a speed that causes
shaking or swaying of the trailer. If
you notice even the slightest sign
of shaking or swaying, slow down.
• Always have someone guide you
when backing.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Allow adequate stopping distance.
Stopping distance is increased
when you tow a trailer. For each 16
km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow at
least one vehicle and trailer length
between you and the vehicle ahead.
Follow at a greater distance if roads
are wet or slippery.
• Slow down when making turns.
Remember that a larger than normal turning radius is needed
because the trailer wheels will be
closer than the vehicle wheels to
the inside of the turn.
• Avoid sudden acceleration and
stopping of the vehicle. Do not
make quick maneuvers unless they
are necessary.
• Slow down in cross winds and be
prepared for wind blasts from large
passing vehicles.
• Be careful when passing other
vehicles. Be sure to allow enough
room for your trailer before you
change lanes, and signal well in
advance.
• Slow down and shift into a lower
gear before you reach long or steep
downhill grades. It is hazardous to
attempt downshifting while you are
descending a hill.
(Continued)
6-5
79K21-03E
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
WARNING
(Continued)
• Avoid “riding” the brakes. “Riding”
the brakes could cause the brakes
to overheat, resulting in reduced
braking efficiency. Use engine
braking as much as possible.
• Because of the added trailer
weight, your engine may overheat
on hot days when going up long or
steep hills. Pay attention to your
engine temperature gauge. If it indicates overheating, pull off the road
and stop in a safe place. Refer to
the “If the Engine Overheats” in
“EMERGENCY SERVICE” section
for details on how to proceed.
WARNING
60A186
WARNING
When parking your vehicle and connected trailer, always use the following procedure:
1) Apply the vehicle’s brakes firmly.
2) Have another person place wheel
chocks under the wheels of the
vehicle and the trailer while you
are holding the brakes.
3) Slowly release the brakes until the
wheel chocks absorb the load.
4) Fully engage the parking brake.
5) Manual transmission – turn off the
engine, then shift into reverse or
first gear.
Automatic transmission – shift
into “P” (Park) and turn off the
engine.
(Continued)
(Continued)
6) If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle, make sure the transfer switch
is not in “N” (Neutral).
When starting out after parking:
1) Push in the clutch (if equipped)
and start the engine.
2) Depress the brake pedal, shift into
gear, release the parking brake
and slowly pull away from the
chocks.
3) Stop, apply the brakes firmly and
hold the brakes while you have
another person remove the
chocks.
6-6
79K21-03E
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Towing Your Vehicle
(recreational towing)
4WD Vehicle With a Transfer Switch
TOWING INSTRUCTION TABLE
Your vehicle may be towed behind another
vehicle (such as a motorhome), provided
you use the proper towing method specified for your vehicle. The towing method
you must use depends on the specifications of your vehicle: whether it is a 2wheel drive (2WD), 4-wheel drive (4WD)
with a transfer switch or 4-wheel drive
(4WD) without a transfer switch vehicle.
DRIVE TRAIN
Use the towing instruction table to select
the proper towing method for your vehicle,
and carefully follow the corresponding
instructions. Be sure to use proper towing
equipment designed for recreational towing and make sure that towing speed does
not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph).
2WD
4WD
with a transfer
switch
4WD
without a
transfer switch
TRANSMISSION
TOWING
METHOD
A/T
A
M/T
A
A/T
none
M/T
none
A/T
B
M/T
B
54G585
CAUTION
Never tow your 4WD vehicle without
a transfer switch using recreational
towing methods. If you do, the transmission will be permanently damaged.
64J234
6-7
79K21-03E
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
To tow a vehicle equipped with a transfer switch with all four wheels on the
ground:
1) Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
2) Place the transmission in “N” (Neutral)
and depress the brake pedal and the
clutch pedal fully (if equipped).
3) Use the transfer switch to shift into neutral.
Before towing
WARNING
When you tow your vehicle, follow
the instructions below to avoid accidents and damage to your vehicle. In
addition, be sure to observe government and local requirements regarding vehicle lighting and trailer hitches
or tow bars.
WARNING
A safety chain should always be used
when you tow your vehicle.
CAUTION
Do not tow your vehicle with either
front wheels or rear wheels directly
on the ground (and the transmission
in neutral). If you do, the transmission will be damaged fatally.
(1)
64J147
Vehicles equipped with a transfer switch
may be towed from the front with all four
wheels on the ground. Be sure to use
proper towing equipment designed for recreational towing and make sure that towing
speed does not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph).
64J218
NOTE:
First, push in and turn the switch to the
mark (1) at the left of the “N” position, and
hold the switch in this position for 5 seconds until the “N” indicator blinks, then turn
the switch to the “N” position.
When you turn the transfer switch to the
“N” position, “N” indicator will come on with
the buzzer sound.
4) Make sure the “N” light on the instrument cluster comes on.
5) Shift the manual transmission lever into
2nd gear or the automatic transmission
lever into “P” (Park).
6) Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position to unlock the steering wheel.
6-8
79K21-03E
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
7) Release the parking brake.
Stop towing the vehicle every 300 km (200
miles). Start the engine. With the manual
transmission lever in 2nd gear (or the automatic transmission lever in “D”) and the
transfer switch in neutral, rev the engine for
about one minute with the clutch engaged
(if equipped), to circulate oil in the transfer
case.
TOWING METHOD A
FOUR WHEELS ON THE GROUND
64J148
6-9
79K21-03E
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
4WD Vehicle Without a Transfer
Switch
2WD Vehicle
1) Secure the rear wheels on a towing
dolly according to the instructions provided by the dolly manufacturer.
2) Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position to unlock the steering wheel.
3) Make sure the front wheels are facing
straight forward and secure the steering
wheel with a steering wheel clamping
device designed for towing.
CAUTION
64J234
54G586
You cannot tow your vehicle behind
another vehicle using recreational towing
methods.
The steering column is not strong
enough to withstand shocks transmitted from the front wheels during
towing. Always unlock the steering
wheel before towing.
CAUTION
Never tow your vehicle using recreational towing methods. If you do, the
transmission will be permanently
damaged.
54G585
6-10
79K21-03E
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
TOWING METHOD B
FRONT WHEELS ON THE GROUND
AND REAR WHEELS ON A DOLLY.
52D082
6-11
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
60G410
Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2
Periodic Maintenance Schedule ........................................ 7-3
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving
Conditions ........................................................................... 7-7
Drive Belt ............................................................................. 7-9
Engine Oil and Filter ........................................................... 7-10
Engine Coolant .................................................................... 7-13
Air Cleaner ........................................................................... 7-16
Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-16
Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-17
Clutch Pedal ........................................................................ 7-20 7
Automatic Transmission Fluid ........................................... 7-20
Brakes .................................................................................. 7-22
Steering Wheel .................................................................... 7-24
Tires ...................................................................................... 7-25
Battery .................................................................................. 7-36
Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36
Headlight Aiming ................................................................. 7-39
Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-40
Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-46
Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-49
Air Conditioning System .................................................... 7-49
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
WARNING
60A187S
WARNING
You should take extreme care when
working on your vehicle to prevent
accidental injury. Here are a few precautions that you should be especially careful to observe:
• To prevent damage or unintended
inflation of the air bag system, be
sure the battery is disconnected
and the ignition switch has been in
the “LOCK” position for at least 90
seconds before performing any
electrical service work on your
SUZUKI. Do not touch air bag system components or wires. The
wires are wrapped with yellow tape
or yellow tubing, and the couplers
are yellow for easy identification.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not leave the engine running in
garages or other confined areas.
• When the engine is running, keep
hands, clothing, tools and other
objects away from the moving fan
and fan belt.
• When it is necessary to do service
work with the engine running, make
sure that the parking brake is set
fully and the transmission is in
Neutral (for manual transmission
vehicles) or Park (for automatic
transmission vehicles).
• Do not touch ignition wires or other
ignition system parts when starting
the engine or when the engine is
running, or you could receive an
electric shock.
• Be careful not to touch a hot
engine, exhaust manifold and
pipes, muffler, radiator and water
hoses.
• Do not allow smoking, sparks or
flames around fuel or the battery.
Flammable fumes are present.
• Do not get under your vehicle if it is
supported only with the portable
jack provided in your vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Be careful not to cause accidental
short circuits between the positive
and negative battery terminals.
• Keep used oil, engine coolant and
other fluids away from children and
pets. Dispose of used fluids properly; never pour them on the
ground, into sewers, etc.
7-1
79K21-03E
Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTICE (for U.S.A.)
Maintenance, replacement or repair of
the emission control devices and systems may be performed by any automobile repair establishment or individual
using any part which has been certified
under the provisions in the Clean Air
Act sec. 207. (a) (2).
Maintenance Schedule
The following table shows the times when
you should perform regular maintenance
on your vehicle. This table shows in miles,
kilometers and months when you should
perform inspections, adjustments, lubrication and other services. These intervals
should be shortened if driving is usually
done under severe conditions (refer to
“Maintenance
Recommended
Under
Severe Driving Conditions”).
WARNING
The shock absorbers are filled with
high pressure gas. Never attempt to
disassemble them or throw them into
a fire. Avoid storing them near a
heater or heating device. When
scrapping the absorber, the gas must
be released from the absorber safely.
Ask your dealer for assistance.
WARNING
SUZUKI recommends that maintenance on items marked with an asterisk (*) be performed by your
authorized SUZUKI dealer or a qualified service technician. If you are
qualified, you may perform maintenance on the unmarked items by
referring to the instructions in this
section. If you are not sure whether
you can successfully complete any of
the unmarked maintenance jobs, ask
your authorized SUZUKI dealer to do
the maintenance for you.
CAUTION
Whenever it becomes necessary to
replace parts on your vehicle, it is
recommended that you use genuine
SUZUKI replacement parts or their
equivalent.
7-2
79K21-03E
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Periodic Maintenance Schedule
R: Replace or change
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary
Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000)
7.5
15
22.5
30
37.5
45
52.5
60
67.5
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)
12.5
25
37.5
50
62.5
75
87.5
100
112.5
first.
months
7.5
15
22.5
30
37.5
45
52.5
60
67.5
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL
1. Drive belt
Inspect for damage
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
*2. Valve lash (clearance) (for 2.4 L engine)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
3. Engine oil and oil filter
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
5. Engine coolant
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)
–
–
–
R
–
–
–
R
–
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#2) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I&(R)
–
*7. EVAP canister
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
9. Spark plugs
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
R
–
*10. Ignition coil (Plug cap)
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
*11. Fuel tank & cap
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
12. Air cleaner filter element
–
–
–
R
–
–
–
R
–
*13. Fuel filter
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
*14. Fuel lines and connections
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
*15. Canister air suction filter
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months
75
125
75
–
–
R
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
#2: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).
7-3
79K21-03E
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
R: Replace or change
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary
Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000)
82.5
90
97.5
105
112.5
120
127.5
135
142.5
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)
137.5
150
162.5
175
187.5
200
212.5
225
237.5
first.
months
82.5
90
97.5
105
112.5
120
127.5
135
142.5
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL
1. Drive belt
Inspect for damage
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
*2. Valve lash (clearance) (for 2.4 L engine)
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
3. Engine oil and oil filter
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
5. Engine coolant
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)
–
R
–
–
–
R
–
–
–
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#2) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings
–
I
–
–
–
I&(R)
–
–
–
*7. EVAP canister
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
9. Spark plugs
–
–
–
–
–
R
–
–
–
*10. Ignition coil (Plug cap)
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
*11. Fuel tank & cap
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
12. Air cleaner filter element
–
R
–
–
–
R
–
–
–
*13. Fuel filter
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
*14. Fuel lines and connections
–
I
–
–
–
I
–
–
–
*15. Canister air suction filter
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months
150
250
150
I
–
R
I
R
I
I
–
I
I (#1)
R
R
I (#1)
#1: Inspect at 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months.
#2: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).
NOTE:
The maintenance services enclosed with rectangle are recommended maintenance items.
Item 6 (R) is applicable to the exhaust mounting rubber only.
The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform recommended maintenance items enclosed with a rectangle will not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion
of the vehicle’s useful life. SUZUKI, however, urges that all recommended maintenance services be performed at the indicated intervals and the maintenance recorded.
7-4
79K21-03E
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
R: Replace or change
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary
Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000)
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)
first.
months
CHASSIS AND BODY
1. Clutch (for manual transmission)
Pedal and fluid level
*2. Brake discs and pads (front, rear)
Brake drums and shoes (if equipped)
*3. Brake hoses and pipes
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment
6. Parking brake lever and *cable
Lever movement check, *adjustment
7. Tires (including tire rotation)
*8. Wheel discs
*9. Wheel bearings
*10. Suspension system
*11. Propeller shafts/Drive shafts
*12. Manual transmission oil
13. Automatic transmission (A/T)
Fluid level
*Fluid change
*Fluid hose
*14. Transfer oil
*15. Differential & Extension (for 2WD) oil
16. Steering system
Steering wheel movement,
*linkage
*17. Power steering (if equipped)
18. All Latches, Hinges and Locks
19. Air conditioner filter (if equipped)
7.5
12.5
7.5
15
25
15
22.5
37.5
22.5
30
50
30
37.5
62.5
37.5
45
75
45
52.5
87.5
52.5
60
100
60
67.5
112.5
67.5
75
125
75
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
R
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
–
*I
–
I
–
*I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
I
–
–
R
–
I
–
R
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
Replace every 175000 km (105000 miles)-----4-speed A/T or 5-speed A/T
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
–
I
–
–
I
–
I
–
R
R
–
–
I
–
I
–
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
R
7-5
79K21-03E
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
R: Replace or change
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary
Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000)
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)
first.
months
CHASSIS AND BODY
1. Clutch (for manual transmission)
Pedal and fluid level
*2. Brake discs and pads (front, rear)
Brake drums and shoes (if equipped)
*3. Brake hoses and pipes
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment
6. Parking brake lever and *cable
Lever movement check, *adjustment
7. Tires (including tire rotation)
*8. Wheel discs
*9. Wheel bearings
*10. Suspension system
*11. Propeller shafts/Drive shafts
*12. Manual transmission oil
13. Automatic transmission (A/T)
Fluid level
*Fluid change
*Fluid hose
*14. Transfer oil
*15. Differential & Extension (for 2WD) oil
16. Steering system
Steering wheel movement,
*linkage
*17. Power steering (if equipped)
18. All Latches, Hinges and Locks
19. Air conditioner filter (if equipped)
82.5
137.5
82.5
90
150
90
97.5
162.5
97.5
105
175
105
112.5
187.5
112.5
120
200
120
127.5
212.5
127.5
135
225
135
142.5
237.5
142.5
150
250
150
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
R
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
–
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
R
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
*I
–
I
–
*I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
R
–
I
–
R
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
Replace every 175000 km (105000 miles)-----4-speed A/T or 5-speed A/T
–
I
–
–
–
–
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
R
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
–
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
–
I
I
I
I
NOTE:
This table shows the service schedule up to 250000 km (150000 miles).
Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), perform the same services at the same intervals shown in the chart.
Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), the maintenance services enclosed with a rectangle are required.
Item 9 *I - inspect for wear.
7-6
79K21-03E
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions
If the vehicle is usually used under the conditions corresponding to any severe condition code given below, it is recommended that applicable maintenance operation be performed at the particular interval shown in the chart below.
Severe condition code
A – Repeated short trips
B – Driving on rough and/or muddy roads
C – Driving on dusty roads
D – Driving in extremely cold weather and/or on salted roads
E – Repeated short trips in extremely cold weather
H – Towing a trailer
Severe
Condition Code
A –
Maintenance
C D E H Engine oil and oil filter
A B –
D –
H Exhaust pipes and mountings
Maintenance
Operation
R
I
I
–
–
C –
–
–
Air cleaner filter element *1
R
–
–
C –
–
–
Canister air suction filter
R
A B C –
–
H
Brake discs and pads (front)
Brake drums and shoes (rear)
I
–
B –
D E H Propeller shafts/Drive shafts
I
–
B –
–
R
E H Manual transmission oil
Maintenance Interval
Every 5000 km (3000 miles)
or 3 months
Every 10000 km (6000 miles)
or 6 months
Every 5000 km (3000 miles)
or 3 months
Every 25000 km (15000 miles)
or 15 months
Every 100000 km (60000 miles)
or 60 months
Every 10000 km (6000 miles)
or 6 months
Every 10000 km (6000 miles)
or 6 months
Every 25000 km (15000 miles)
or 15 months
7-7
79K21-03E
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Severe
Condition Code
Maintenance
Maintenance
Operation
–
B –
–
E H Automatic transmission (A/T) fluid
R
–
B –
–
E H Transfer, Differential and Extension oil
R
–
B –
–
–
–
Bolts and nuts on suspension
T
–
B C D –
–
Drive belt (Engine accessory)
I
–
–
–
Air conditioner filter element *2
I
C D –
R
Maintenance Interval
Every 25000 km (15000 miles)
or 15 months
Every 25000 km (15000 miles)
or 15 months
Every 10000 km (6000 miles)
or 6 months
Every 25000 km (15000 miles)
or 15 months
Every 10000 km (6000 miles)
or 6 months
Every 50000 km (30000 miles)
or 30 months
NOTE:
I – Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary
T – Tighten to the specified torque
R – Replace or change
L – Lubricate
*1 Inspect more frequently if the vehicle is used under dusty conditions.
*2 Clean more frequently if the air flow from the air conditioner decreases.
7-8
79K21-03E
Drive Belt: 1, 2
Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Drive Belt
WARNING
L4 2.4 L
When the engine is running, keep
hands, hair, clothing, tools, etc. away
from the moving fan and drive belts.
V6 3.2 L
PS
ADB
Check the accessory drive belt only for
damage. You do not need check it for tension as it has an automatic tensioner.
If you need to replace or adjust the belt
have it done by your SUZUKI dealer.
PS
ADB
GE
GE
AC
AC
→: 100 N (22 lbs, 10 kg) press
ADB: Accessory drive belt
GE: Generator
PS: Power steering pump
AC: Air conditioner compressor
79K041
7-9
79K21-03E
Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Engine Oil and Filter
Oil Level Check
Specified Oil
Engine oil dipstick
EXAMPLE
FULL
ADD
“Starburst”
52D084
52D030
79K096
Use engine oil with the American Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline
Engines “Starburst” symbol.
We highly recommend you use SAE 5W30 oil.
CAUTION
It is important to keep the engine oil at the
correct level for proper lubrication of your
vehicle’s engine. Check the oil level with
the vehicle on a level surface. The oil level
indication may be inaccurate if the vehicle
is on a slope. The oil level should be
checked either before starting the engine
or at least 5 minutes after stopping the
engine.
The handle of the engine oil dipstick is colored yellow for easy identification.
Pull out the oil dipstick, wipe oil off with a
clean cloth, insert the dipstick all the way
into the engine, then remove it again. The
oil on the stick should be between the
upper and lower limits shown on the stick.
If the oil level indication is near the lower
limit, add enough oil to raise the level to the
upper limit.
Failure to use the recommended oil
can result in engine damage.
7-10
79K21-03E
Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Refilling
Changing Engine Oil and Filter
WARNING
EXAMPLE
Open
EXAMPLE
Close
81A147
60G306
Remove the oil filler cap and pour oil slowly
through the filler hole to bring the oil level
to the upper limit on the dipstick. Be careful
not to overfill. Too much oil is almost as
bad as too little oil. After refilling, start the
engine and allow it to idle for about a
minute. Stop the engine, wait about 5 minutes and check the oil level again.
Drain the engine oil while the engine is still
warm.
1) Remove the oil filler cap.
2) Remove the engine under cover.
3) Place a drain pan under the drain plug.
4) Using a wrench, remove the drain plug
and drain out the engine oil.
New and used oil and solvent can be
hazardous. Children and pets may be
harmed by swallowing new or used
oil or solvent. Repeated, prolonged
contact with used engine oil may
cause skin cancer. Brief contact with
used oil or solvent may irritate skin.
• Keep new and used oil and solvent
away from children and pets.
• Wear a long-sleeve shirt and waterproof gloves.
• Wash with soap if oil or solvent
contacts your skin.
5) Reinstall the drain plug and gasket.
Tighten the plug with a wrench to the
specified torque.
6) Reinstall the engine under cover.
Tightening torque specification
35 Nm (25.3 lb-ft, 3.5 kg-m)
WARNING
The engine oil temperature may be
high enough to burn your fingers
when the drain plug is loosened. Wait
until the drain plug is cool enough to
touch with your bare hands.
7-11
79K21-03E
Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Replace the Oil Filter
NOTE:
• When it is difficult to remove the oil filter,
we recommend you take your vehicle to
your SUZUKI dealer for oil filter replacement.
• For 3.2 L engine, since special procedures are required, we recommend you
take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer
for oil filter replacement.
2.4 L engine
EXAMPLE
Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks
54G093
78K055
1) Using an oil filter wrench, turn the oil filter counterclockwise and remove it.
2) Using a clean rag, wipe off the mounting surface on the engine where the
new filter will be seated.
3) Smear a little engine oil around the rubber gasket of the new oil filter.
4) Screw on the new filter by hand until the
filter gasket contacts the mounting surface.
(1) Oil filter
(2) 3/4 turn
5) Tighten the filter 3/4 turn from the point
of contact with the mounting surface (or
to the specified torque) using an oil filter
wrench.
6) Reinstall the engine under cover.
Tightening torque specification
14 Nm (10.1 lb-ft, 1.4 kg-m)
CAUTION
CAUTION
To tighten the oil filter properly, it is
important to accurately identify the
position at which the filter gasket
first contacts the mounting surface.
To prevent oil leakage, make sure
that the oil filter is tight, but do not
overtighten it.
1) Pour oil through the filler hole and
install the filler cap.
For the approximate capacity of the oil,
refer to the “Capacities” item in the
“SPECIFICATIONS” section.
2) Start the engine and look carefully for
leaks at the oil filter and drain plug. Run
the engine at various speeds for at least
5 minutes.
3) Stop the engine and wait about 5 minutes. Check the oil level again and add
oil if necessary. Check for leaks again.
CAUTION
When replacing the oil filter, it is recommended that you use a genuine
SUZUKI replacement filter. If you use
an after-market filter, make sure it is
of equivalent quality and carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions
and precautions.
7-12
79K21-03E
Gear Oil: 6, 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Engine Coolant
EXAMPLE
Selection of Coolant
CAUTION
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant;
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant is
already diluted to the proper percentage. Do not dilute with distilled water
additionally. Doing so may result in
the possibility of freezing coolant
and/or overheating.
To maintain optimum performance and
durability of your engine, use SUZUKI
Genuine Coolant or equivalent.
83E010
64J151
CAUTION
Oil leaks from around the oil filter or
drain plug indicate incorrect installation or gasket damage. If you find any
leaks or are not sure that the filter
has been properly tightened, have
the vehicle inspected by your SUZUKI
dealer.
EXAMPLE
FULL
LOW
60A208
NOTE:
If you replace the engine coolant other
than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow
the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard
(Green). To see the detail of the maintenance schedule, refer to “Periodic Maintenance Schedule” in this section.
This type of coolant is best for your cooling
system as it:
• Helps maintain proper engine temperature.
• Gives proper protection against freezing
and boiling.
• Gives proper protection against corrosion and rust.
Failure to use the proper coolant can damage your cooling system. Your authorized
SUZUKI dealer can help you select the
proper coolant.
7-13
79K21-03E
Gear Oil: 6, 10
Automatic Transmission Fluid: 10
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Engine Coolant Level Check
CAUTION
To avoid damaging your cooling system:
• Always use a high quality ethylene
glycol base phosphate type coolant
diluted with distilled water at the
correct mixture concentration.
• Make sure that the proper mix is 50/
50 coolant to distilled water and in
no case higher than 70/30. Concentrations greater than 70/30 coolant
to distilled water will cause overheating conditions.
• Do not use straight coolant nor
plain water (except SUZUKI LLC:
Super (Blue)).
• Do not add extra inhibitors or additives. They may not be compatible
with your cooling system.
• Do not mix different types of base
coolants. Doing so may result in
accelerated seal wear and/or the
possibility of severe overheating
and extensive engine/automatic
transmission damage.
Check the engine coolant level at the
reserve tank, not at the radiator. With the
engine cool, the engine coolant level
should be between the “FULL” and “LOW”
marks.
Adding Engine Coolant
If the engine coolant level is below the
“LOW” mark, more engine coolant should
be added. Remove the reserve tank cap
and add engine coolant until the reserve
tank level reaches the “FULL” mark. Never
fill the reserve tank above the “FULL” mark.
CAUTION
WARNING
Engine coolant is harmful or fatal if
swallowed or inhaled. Do not drink
antifreeze or coolant solution. If swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control
center or a physician. Avoid inhaling
mist or hot vapors; if inhaled, remove
to fresh air. If coolant gets in eyes,
flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after
handling. Solution can be poisonous
to animals. Keep out of the reach of
children and animals.
• The mixture you use should contain 50% concentration of antifreeze.
• If the lowest ambient temperature
in your area is expected to be –35
°C (–31°F) or below, use higher
concentrations up to 60% following
the instructions on the antifreeze
container.
• When putting the cap on the
reserve tank, line up the arrow on
the cap and the arrow on the tank.
Failure to follow this can result in
coolant leakage.
7-14
79K21-03E
Automatic Transmission Fluid: 10
Engine Coolant: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Engine Coolant Replacement
EXAMPLE
Open
Close
66J191
66J151
1) When the engine is cool, remove the
radiator cap by turning it slowly to the
left until a “stop” is felt. Do not press
down while turning the cap. Wait until
any pressure is released, then press
down on the cap and continue turning it
to the left.
WARNING
It is hazardous to remove the radiator
cap when the engine coolant temperature is high, because scalding fluid
and steam may be blown out under
pressure. Wait until the engine coolant temperature has lowered before
removing the cap.
2) Remove the reservoir by lifting it up,
and drain the reservoir completely.
64J191
3) Loosen the drain plug attached to the
lower part of the radiator and drain the
engine coolant into a suitable container.
4) Reinstall the reservoir and fill it with
engine coolant to the “FULL” line.
5) Tighten the drain plug on the radiator,
fill the radiator with engine coolant and
install the radiator cap.
6) After filling, let the engine idle for about
2 – 3 minutes to get rid of air in the
cooling system. Then, stop the engine.
7) Check the engine coolant level in the
radiator again. If the level has gone
down, add more engine coolant.
CAUTION
The engine coolant must be replaced
with the vehicle on level ground.
7-15
79K21-03E
Engine Coolant: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Air Cleaner
CAUTION
Spark Plugs
The air cleaner element should be
replaced every 50000 km (30000
miles). More frequent replacement is
necessary when you drive under
dusty conditions.
EXAMPLE
66J167
78K056
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there
will be greater intake resistance, resulting
in decreased power output and increased
fuel consumption.
NOTE:
For 3.2 L engine, to approach the spark
plugs, you need to remove the bolts shown
in the illustration.
Check and clean periodically according to
the following procedure:
1) Take off the air cleaner case cover.
Remove the element from the air
cleaner case cover.
2) This air cleaner element is of dry type.
Remember that it needs cleaning
according to the following method.
3) Blow off dust on cleaner element by
compressed air from inside the element, or replace the element as necessary.
7-16
79K21-03E
Engine Coolant: 1, 2
Windshield Washer Fluid: 3
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Gear Oil
Specified Gear Oil
When replacing gear oil, use gear oil with
the appropriate viscosity and grade as
shown in the charts below. We highly recommend you use SAE 75W-90 gear oil
(SAE 80W-90 for front differential oil, rear
differential oil and transfer gear oil).
1.0 – 1.1 mm
(0.039 – 0.043 in.)
Transmission/Extension case
65D434
You should inspect spark plugs periodically
for carbon deposits. When carbon accumulates on a spark plug, a strong spark
may not be produced. Remove carbon
deposits with a wire or pin and adjust the
spark plug gap.
To access the spark plugs:
1) Remove the engine cover.
2) Disconnect the coupler (1) while pushing the release lever.
3) Remove the bolt.
4) Pull the ignition coil out.
80G093
CAUTION
When replacing spark plugs, you
should use the brand and type specified for your vehicle. For the specified
plugs,
refer
to
the
“SPECIFICATIONS” section at the
end of this book. If you wish to use a
brand of spark plug other than the
specified plugs, consult your SUZUKI
dealer.
54G095
Differential/Transfer case
65D594
7-17
79K21-03E
Windshield Washer Fluid: 3
Air Cleaner: 1, 2
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Extension case (2WD)
Manual transmission
API GRADE
Transmission/
Extension case
(1)
GL-4
Transfer case
Differential
Front
GL-5
(Hypoid gear oil)
Rear
(2)
52D087
Transfer case
66J165
(1) Oil filler and level plug
(2) Oil drain plug
(1)
(2)
66J005
(1) Oil filler and level plug
(2) Oil drain plug
7-18
79K21-03E
Spark Plugs: 1, 2
Brakes: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Front differential
(1)
(2)
79K133
Rear differential
(1)
Gear Oil Level Check
Gear Oil Replacement
The manual transmission, transfer gears,
extension case and differentials (front and
rear) are lubricated with gear oil. To check
the gear oil level in any of the above locations, use the following procedure:
To change the gear oil in the manual transmission, transfer case, extension case or
differential(s), use the following procedure:
1) Park the vehicle on a level surface. Set
parking brake and stop the engine.
2) Remove the oil filler plug (1).
3) Check the inside of the hole with your
finger. If the oil level comes up to the
bottom of the plug hole, the oil level is
correct. If so, reinstall the plug.
4) If the oil level is low, add gear oil
through the filler plug hole (1) until the
oil level reaches the bottom of the filler
hole, then reinstall the plug.
1) Remove the oil filler plug (1).
2) Remove the drain plug (2), drain the oil
and reinstall the drain plug.
3) Pour new gear oil of the specified type
through the filler hole until the oil level
reaches the bottom of the filler hole.
4) Reinstall the filler plug.
WARNING
After driving the vehicle, gear oil temperature may be high enough to burn
you. Wait until the oil filler plug is
cool enough to touch with your bare
hands before inspecting or replacing
gear oil.
CAUTION
(2)
When tightening these plugs, apply
sealing compound “SUZUKI Bond
No. 1217G” or equivalent to the plug
threads to prevent oil leakage and
tighten them to the specified torque
shown below.
79K134
(1) Oil filler and level plug
(2) Oil drain plug
7-19
79K21-03E
Brakes: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Clutch Pedal
Tightening torque
Manual
transmission
Transfer
Extension
case
Front
differential
Rear
differential
Oil Filler
Plug
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
Oil Drain
Plug
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
23 Nm
(17.0 lb-ft)
(2.3 kg-m)
Automatic Transmission
Fluid
Specified Fluid
Use an automatic transmission fluid
SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309.
Fluid Level Check
CAUTION
Driving with too much or too little
fluid can damage the transmission.
64J154
Check the clutch pedal for smooth operation and clutch fluid level from time to time.
If clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully
depressed, have the clutch inspected by
your SUZUKI dealer. If the clutch fluid level
is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX”
line with DOT3 brake fluid.
You must check the fluid level with the
automatic transmission fluid at normal
operating temperature.
To check the fluid level:
1) To warm up the transmission fluid, drive
the vehicle or idle the engine until the
temperature gauge indicates normal
operating temperature.
2) Then drive for ten more minutes.
CAUTION
Be sure to use the specified automatic transmission fluid. Using automatic transmission fluid other than
SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309
may damage the automatic transmission of your vehicle.
7-20
79K21-03E
Brakes: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTE:
Do not check the fluid level if you have just
driven the vehicle for a long time at high
speed, if you have driven in city traffic in
hot weather, or if the vehicle has been pulling a trailer. Wait until the fluid cools down
(about 30 minutes), or the fluid level indication will not be correct.
3) Park your vehicle on level ground.
4) Apply the parking brake and then start
the engine in “P” (Park). Let it idle for
two minutes and keep it running during
the fluid level check.
5) With your foot on the brake pedal, move
the gearshift lever through each gear,
pausing for about three seconds in
each range. Then move it back to the
“P” (Park) position.
EXAMPLE
The fluid level should be between the
two marks in the “HOT” range on the
dipstick.
7) Add just enough specified fluid through
the dipstick hole to fill the transmission
to the proper level.
or
CAUTION
After checking or adding oil, be sure
to insert the dipstick securely.
Changing Oil
60A205
The handle of the A/T fluid dipstick is colored red for easy identification.
Since special procedures, materials and
tools are required to change the automatic
transmission oil, it is recommended that
you trust this job to your authorized
SUZUKI dealer.
WARNING
Be sure to depress the brake pedal
when moving the gearshift lever, or
the vehicle can move suddenly.
FULL HOT
LOW HOT
65D109
6) Remove the dipstick, clean it and push
it back in until the cap seats. Pull out
the dipstick and read the fluid level.
7-21
79K21-03E
Steering Wheel: 6
Clutch Pedal: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Brakes
WARNING
Brake Fluid
65D477
WARNING
64J154
Check the brake fluid level by looking at
the reservoir in the engine compartment.
Check that the fluid level is between the
“MAX” and “MIN” lines. If the brake fluid
level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the
“MAX” line with DOT3 brake fluid.
Failure to follow the guidelines below
can result in personal injury or serious damage to the brake system.
• If the brake fluid in the reservoir
drops below a certain level, the
brake warning light on the instrument panel will come on (the
engine must be running with the
parking brake fully disengaged.)
Should the light come on, immediately ask your SUZUKI dealer to
inspect the brake system.
• A rapid fluid loss indicates a leak in
the brake system which should be
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer
immediately.
• Brake fluid can harm your eyes and
damage painted surfaces. Use caution when refilling the reservoir.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not use any fluid other than
DOT3 brake fluid. Do not use
reclaimed fluid or fluid that has
been stored in old or open containers. It is essential that foreign particles and other liquids are kept out
of the brake fluid reservoir.
WARNING
Brake fluid is harmful or fatal if swallowed, and harmful if it comes in contact with skin or eyes. If swallowed,
do not induce vomiting. Immediately
contact a poison control center or a
physician. If brake fluid gets in eyes,
flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after
handling. Solution can be poisonous
to animals. Keep out of the reach of
children and animals.
CAUTION
The brake fluid should be replaced
according to the maintenance schedule. Have the brake fluid replaced by
your SUZUKI dealer.
7-22
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTE:
With disc brakes, the fluid level can be
expected to gradually fall as the brake
pads wear.
measured above is less than the minimum
distance required, have your vehicle
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer.
NOTE:
When measuring the distance between the
brake pedal and floor wall, push in the floor
carpet as far as it goes and measure the
distance between the carpet surface and
the brake pedal.
Brake Pedal
60G104
“a”
WARNING
Floor carpet
79K138
Pedal to floor carpet minimum distance
“a”
80 mm (3.1 in.)
With the engine running and the parking
brake set, measure the distance between
the brake pedal and floor carpet when the
pedal is depressed with approximately 300
N (66 lbs, 30 kg) of force. The minimum
distance required is as specified. Since
your vehicle’s brake system is self-adjusting, there is no need for pedal adjustment.
If the pedal to floor carpet distance as
If you experience any of the following
problems with your vehicle’s brake
system, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by your SUZUKI dealer.
• Poor braking performance
• Uneven braking (brakes not working uniformly on all wheels.)
• Excessive pedal travel
• Brake dragging
• Excessive noise
• (Except ABS equipped vehicle)
Pedal pulsation (pedal pulsates
when pressed for braking.)
7-23
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Steering Wheel
Parking Brake Lever
EXAMPLE
Power Steering (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
200 N (44 lbs, 20 kg)
(1)
“c”
“b”
(2)
60A226
Ratchet tooth specification “b”
64J155
78K080
Steering wheel play “c”
5th – 7th
0 – 30 mm (0.0 – 1.2 in.)
Check the parking brake for proper adjustment by counting the number of clicks
made by the ratchet teeth as you slowly
pull up on the parking brake lever to the
point of full engagement. The parking
brake lever should stop between the specified ratchet teeth and the rear wheels
should be securely locked. If the parking
brake is not properly adjusted or the
brakes drag after the lever has been fully
released, have the parking brake inspected
and/or adjusted by your SUZUKI dealer.
Check the play of the steering wheel by
gently turning it from left to right and measuring the distance that it moves before
you feel slight resistance. The play should
be between the specified values. Check
that the steering wheel turns easily and
smoothly without rattling by turning it all the
way to the right and to the left while driving
very slowly in an open area. If the amount
of free play is outside the specification or
you find anything else to be wrong, an
inspection must be performed by your
SUZUKI dealer.
(1) UPPER
(2) LOWER
Check the steering box case, vane pump
and hose connections for leaks or damage.
Power Steering Fluid
Check the fluid level by looking at the reservoir in the engine compartment when the
fluid is cold (about room temperature).
Check that the fluid level is between the (1)
and (2) lines. If the fluid level is near the (2)
line, fill it up to the (1) line with an automatic transmission fluid equivalent to ATF
DEXRON®-II (Esso JWS 2326) or
DEXRON®-III. Do not overfill.
7-24
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Tires
For safe operation of your vehicle, it is
important that the tires be the correct
type and size, in good condition, and
properly inflated. Be sure to follow the
requirements and recommendations in
this section.
Tire Sidewall Labeling
Useful information about a tire is
molded into its sidewall. The example
below shows a typical passenger car
tire.
Typical Passenger Car Tire Sidewall
I
C
D
J
B
H
G
A
E
F
EXAMPLE
67D027
A. Tire Manufacturer
The name of the tire manufacturer
is shown here.
B. Tire Name/Model
The tire name or model is shown
here.
C. Tire Size
The tire size code is a combination of letters and numbers used
to define a particular tire’s width,
height, aspect ratio, construction
type, and service description. See
the “Tire Size” explanation later in
this section for more details.
D. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number
The Department of Transportation
(DOT) marking indicates that the
tire is in compliance with the U.S.
Department of Transportation
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
The letters and numbers following
the DOT marking is the Tire Identification Number (TIN). The TIN
identifies the tire manufacturer
and plant, tire size, and date the
tire was manufactured.
E. Uniform Tire Quality Grading
(UTQG)
Tire manufacturers are required to
grade tires based on three performance factors: treadwear, traction
and
temperature
resistance.
Refer to the “Uniform Tire Quality
Grading” section for more details.
F. Load Rating
Load rating is the maximum
weight a tire is designed to support in normal service.
G. Max Inflation Pressure
Max inflation pressure is the maximum inflation pressure a tire is
designed for.
H. Tire Ply Material
These tire markings describe the
type of cord and number of plies
in the sidewall and under the
tread.
I. Load Index and Speed Rating
The two- or three-digit number is
the tire’s load index, the maximum
load a tire can carry at the speed
indicated by its speed symbol at
the maximum inflation pressure.
The higher the number is, the
greater the load carrying capacity.
The letter symbol denotes the
speed at which a tire is designed
to be driven for extended periods
of time. (Ratings are listed below.)
7-25
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Letter Rating
Speed Rating
Q
99 mph
R
106 mph
S
112 mph
T
118 mph
U
124 mph
H
130 mph
V
149 mph
W
168 mph*
Y
186 mph*
*The letters ZR may be used on tires
with a maximum speed capability over
149 mph and will always be used on
tires with a maximum speed capability
over 186 mph.
J. M+S Marking
This marking indicates the tire
has some mud and snow capabilities and is designed for all-season
use.
Tire Size
The following illustration shows an
example of a typical passenger car tire
size.
EXAMPLE
A
B
C
D
D. Construction Code
This letter code is used to indicate
the type of ply construction in the
tire. The letter “R” means radial
ply tire construction, the letter “D”
means diagonal or bias ply construction, and the letter “B” means
belted-bias ply construction.
E. Rim Diameter
This two-digit number is the wheel
or rim diameter in inches.
WARNING
E
67D028
A. Tire Type
This letter code indicates the primary intended use of the tire. The
letter “P” identifies a tire primarily
intended for use on a passenger
vehicle.
B. Tire Width
This three-digit number indicates
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall to sidewall.
C. Aspect Ratio
This two-digit number represents
the tire section height divided by
the tire section width.
Your SUZUKI is equipped with
tires which are all the same type
and size. This is important to
ensure proper steering and handling of the vehicle. Never mix
tires of different size or type on
the four wheels of your vehicle.
Mixing tires could cause you to
lose control while driving which
may lead to an accident. The size
and type of tires used should be
only those approved by SUZUKI
Motor Corporation as standard or
optional equipment for your vehicle.
7-26
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Tire Inflation Pressure
Tire inflation pressure should be
checked when the tire is cold. “Cold
tire inflation pressure” is the pressure
in a tire that has been driven less than
1 mile (1.6 km) or has been standing
for three hours or more.
54G307
The front, rear and spare tire pressure
specifications for your vehicle are
shown below and are listed on the Tire
and Loading Information Label, which
is located on the driver’s door lock pillar. The Tire and Loading Information
Label contains the following information:
• Seating Capacity
• Maximum
Allowed
Combined
Weight of Occupants and Cargo
• Original Tire Size
• Recommended Cold Tire Inflation
Pressure of Original Tires
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation
Pressures
Front Tires
230 kPa
33 psi
Rear Tires
230 kPa
33 psi
Spare
230 kPa
33 psi
NOTE:
The tire inflation pressure will change
due to changes in atmospheric pressure, temperature or tire temperature
when driving. To reduce the chance
that the low tire pressure warning light
will come on due to normal changes in
temperature and atmospheric pressure, it is important to check and
adjust the tire pressures when the tires
are cold. Tires that appear to be at the
specified pressure when checked after
driving, when the tires are warm, could
have pressure below the specification
when the tires cool down. Also, tires
that are inflated to the specified pressure in a warm garage may have pressure below the specification when the
vehicle is driven outside in very cold
temperature. If you adjust the tire
pressure in a garage that is warmer
than the outside temperature, you
should add 1 psi to the recommended
cold tire inflation pressure for every
10°F difference between garage temperature and outside temperature.
Measuring air pressure
Use the following steps to achieve
proper tire inflation:
1) Identify the recommended tire pressure on the vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information Label or in the
owner’s manual.
2) Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem.
3) Using a reliable pressure gauge,
measure the tire inflation pressure
by pressing the tire gauge firmly
onto the valve to get a pressure
measurement. Remember that
inflation pressures should be
checked when the tires are “cold”,
meaning before they have been
driven one mile or after sitting for
three hours or more allowing the
tire to cool to ambient air temperature.
4) If the air pressure is too high, slowly
release the air by pressing on the
tire valve stem with the edge of the
7-27
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
tire gauge until you reach the correct pressure.
5) If the air pressure is too low, fill the
tire with air at a service station until
it reaches the recommended pressure.
6) Make sure all tires have the same
air pressure (unless the owner’s
manual indicates otherwise).
WARNING
• Air
pressures
should
be
checked when the tires are cold
or you may get inaccurate readings.
• Check the inflation pressure
from time to time while inflating
the tire gradually, until the specified pressure is obtained.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Never underinflate or overinflate the tires.
Underinflation
can
cause
unusual handling characteristics or can cause the rim to slip
on the tire bead, resulting in an
accident or damage to the tire
or rim.
Underinflation can also cause
tires to overheat, leading to tire
failure.
Overinflation can cause the tire
to burst, resulting in personal
injury.
Overinflation can also cause
unusual handling characteristics which may result in an accident.
Tire Inspection
Inspect your vehicle’s tires at least
once a month by performing the following checks:
1) Measure the air pressure with a tire
gauge. Adjust the pressure if necessary. Remember to check the
spare tire, too. Refer to the “Measuring Air Pressure” section.
54G136
(1) Tread wear indicator
(2) Indicator location mark
2) Check that the depth of the tread
groove is more than 1.6 mm (0.06
in.). To help you check this, the tires
have molded-in tread wear indicators in the grooves. When the indicators appear on the tread surface,
the remaining depth of the tread is
7-28
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
1.6 mm (0.06 in.) or less and the
tire should be replaced.
3) Check for abnormal wear, cracks
and damage. Any tires with cracks
or other damage should be
replaced. If any tires show abnormal wear, have them inspected by
your SUZUKI dealer.
WARNING
Hitting curbs and running over
rocks can damage tires and affect
wheel alignment. Be sure to have
tires
and
wheel
alignment
checked periodically by your
SUZUKI dealer.
4) Check for loose wheel nuts.
5) Check that there are no nails,
stones or other objects sticking into
the tires.
WARNING
Your SUZUKI is equipped with
tires which are all the same type
and size. This is important to
ensure proper steering and handling of the vehicle. Never mix
tires of different size or type on
the four wheels of your vehicle.
The size and type of tires used
should be only those approved by
SUZUKI Motor Corporation as
standard or optional equipment
for your vehicle.
WARNING
Replacing the wheels and tires
equipped on your vehicle with
certain combinations of aftermarket wheels and tires can significantly change the steering and
handling characteristics of your
vehicle. Oversized tires may also
rub against the fender over
bumps, causing vehicle damage
or tire failure. Therefore, use only
those wheel and tire combinations approved by SUZUKI Motor
Corporation as standard or
optional equipment for your vehicle. For information regarding the
specified tires, refer to the Tire
Information Label located on the
driver’s side door pillar or the
“SPECIFICATIONS” section.
CAUTION
Replacing the original tires with
tires of a different size may result
in false speedometer or odometer
readings. Check with your
SUZUKI dealer before purchasing replacement tires that differ in
size from the original tires.
7-29
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
The U.S. National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration has developed a
grading system for evaluating the performance of passenger car tires. The
following information will help you
understand the grading system, which
applies to vehicles sold in the U.S.
Consult your SUZUKI dealer or tire
retailer for help in choosing the correct
replacement tires for your vehicle.
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum section
width. For example:
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A
DOT Quality Grades
Treadwear
Traction AA A B C
Temperature A B C
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform
To Federal Safety Requirements in
Addition To These Grades
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative
rating based on the wear rate of the
tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test
course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2)
times as well on the government
course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use,
however and may depart significantly
from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and
climate.
Traction – AA, A, B, C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those
grades represent the tire’s ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C
may have poor traction performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to
this tire is based on straightahead braking traction tests, and
does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning or peak
traction characteristics.
Temperature – A, B, C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C, representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance
which all passenger car tires must
meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B
and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel
than the minimum required by law.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this
tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and
possible tire failure.
7-30
79K21-03E
Tires: 6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Tire Rotation
WARNING
4-tire rotation
65D459
To avoid uneven wear of your tires and
to prolong their life, rotate the tires as
illustrated. Tires should be rotated as
recommended in the periodic maintenance schedule. After rotation, adjust
front and rear tire pressures to the
specification listed on your vehicle’s
Tire and Loading Information Label.
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the
parts to which it is fastened, can
make wheel nuts become loose
after a time. The wheel could
come off and cause an accident.
When you change a wheel,
remove any rust or dirt from
places where the wheel attaches
to the vehicle. In an emergency,
you can use a cloth or a paper
towel to do this; but be sure to
use a scraper or wire brush later,
if you need to, to get all the rust
or dirt off.
WARNING
Vehicle equipped with P225/
65R17 tires have a spare wheel
and tire that are a different size
than the wheels and tires on the
vehicle. The spare wheel and tire
on these vehicles are intended for
temporary emergency use only.
The wheel is painted yellow to
remind you that the wheel and
tire are for temporary use only.
Continuous use of this spare can
result in tire failure and loss of
control. Always observe these
precautions when using this
spare:
• Be aware that your vehicle will
handle differently with this temporary spare.
• Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph)
speed.
• Replace the temporary spare
with a standard tire and wheel
as soon as possible.
• Do not operate your vehicle in
“4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” with
this temporary spare.
(Continued)
7-31
79K21-03E
Battery: 9
Fuses: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
WARNING
(Continued)
• Do not use tire chains on the
spare tire. If you must use tire
chains, rearrange the wheels so
standard tires and wheels are
fitted to the rear axle.
• Replace the spare tire with a
new one as soon as the tread
wear indicator appears.
• When replacing the spare tire,
use a replacement tire with the
exact same size and construction.
Snow Tires
Your vehicle is equipped with all-season tires which are designed for use in
summer and most winter conditions.
For improved traction in severe winter
conditions, SUZUKI recommends
mounting radial snow tires on all four
wheels. Snow tires must be the same
size as the standard tires. Also be sure
to use the tires of the same type and
brand on all four wheels of your vehicle.
GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOLOGY
always face outward when mounted
on a vehicle.
Accessory Weight – the combined
weight (in excess of those standard
items which may be replaced) of automatic transmission, power steering,
power brakes, power windows, power
seats, radio, and heater, to the extent
that these items are available as factory-installed equipment (whether
installed or not).
Maximum Inflation Pressure – the
maximum cold inflation pressure a tire
is designed to support in normal service.
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure – the pressure in a tire that has been driven less
than 1 mile or has been standing for
three hours or more.
Curb Weight – the weight of a motor
vehicle with standard equipment
including the maximum capacity of
fuel, oil, and coolant, and, if so
equipped, air conditioning and additional weight optional engine.
Intended Outboard Sidewall – (1) the
sidewall that contains a whitewall,
bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name
molding that is higher or deeper than
the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire
that has a particular side that must
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight –
the sum of curb weight, accessory
weight, vehicle capacity weight (total
load capacity), and production options
weight.
Normal Occupant Weight – 68 kilograms times the number of occupants
specified in the second column of
Table 1 (shown below).
Occupant distribution – distribution of
occupants in a vehicle as specified in
the third column of Table 1 (shown
below).
Production Options Weight – the combined weight of those installed regular
production options weighing over 2.3
kilograms in excess of those standard
items which they replace, not previously considered in curb weight or
accessory weight, including heavy
duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack,
heavy duty battery, and special trim.
7-32
79K21-03E
Fuses: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Recommended Inflation Pressure –
the cold tire inflation pressure recommended by a manufacturer.
Rim – metal support for a tire or tire
and tube assembly upon which the tire
beads are seated.
Vehicle Capacity Weight – the rated
cargo and luggage load plus 68 kilograms (150 lbs) times the vehicle’s
designated seating capacity.
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire –
the load on an individual tire that is
determined by distributing to each axle
its share of the maximum loaded vehicle weight and dividing by two.
Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire – the
load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its
share of the curb weight, accessory
weight, and normal occupant weight
(distributed in accordance with Table 1
shown below) and dividing by 2.
TABLE 1 – Occupant Loading and
Distribution For Vehicle Normal
Load For Various Designated Seating Capacities
Vehicle
normal
load,
number of
occupants
Occupant
distribution
in a
normally
loaded
vehicle
2 through 4
2
2 in front
5 through 10
3
2 in front,
1 in second seat
Designated
seating
capacity,
number of
occupants
Vehicle Loading
Your vehicle was designed for specific
load capacities. The load capacities of
your vehicle are indicated by the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),
the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR,
front and rear), and the total load
capacity, the seating capacity, and the
cargo load capacity. The GVWR and
GAWR (front and rear) are listed on
the Safety Certification Label which is
located below the driver’s side door
latch striker. The total load capacity
and seating capacity are listed on the
Tire and Loading Information Label
which is located below the Safety Certification Label. The cargo load capacity can be determined as described
below.
Cargo Load Capacity – Maximum
weight of cargo and luggage that the
vehicle can safely carry. Cargo load
capacity is the difference between the
total load capacity of the vehicle and
the total combined weight of all vehicle
occupants. Refer to “Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit” for details
on how to determine cargo load
capacity.
GVWR – Maximum permissible overall
weight of the fully loaded vehicle
(including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the trailer tongue
weight if towing a trailer).
GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum
permissible weight on an individual
axle.
Seating Capacity – Maximum number
of occupants the vehicle is designed to
carry.
NOTE:
Even though the number of occupants
is within the seating capacity, you still
must make sure that you do not
7-33
79K21-03E
Fuses: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
exceed the total load capacity of the
vehicle.
Total Load Capacity – Maximum permissible weight a vehicle can carry
including the weight of all the occupants, accessories, cargo, plus trailer
tongue weight (if towing a trailer).
The weight of any accessories already
installed on your vehicle at the time of
purchase, or that you or the dealer
install after purchase, must be subtracted from the total load capacity to
determine how much capacity remains
available for occupants, cargo, and
trailer tongue weight (if towing a
trailer). Contact your dealer for further
information.
Actual weight of the loaded vehicle
and actual loads at the front and rear
axles can only be determined by
weighing the vehicle using a vehicle
scale. To measure the weight and
load, try making your vehicle to a highway weighing station, shipping company or inspection station for trucks,
etc. Compare these weights to the
GVWR and GAWR (front and rear)
listed on the Safety Certification Label.
If the gross vehicle weight or the load
on either axle exceeds these ratings,
you must remove enough weight to
bring the load down to the rated
capacity.
WARNING
Never overload your vehicle.
Overloading your vehicle can
cause damage to your tires and
lead to poor steering and braking
which can result in an accident.
The gross vehicle weight (sum of
the weights of the loaded vehicle,
driver and passengers) must
never exceed the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on
the Safety Certification Label. In
addition, never distribute a load
so that the weight on either the
front or rear axle exceeds the
Gross
Axle
Weight
Rating
(GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label.
WARNING
• Always distribute cargo evenly.
• To avoid personal injury or
damage to your vehicle, always
secure cargo to prevent it from
shifting if the vehicle moves
suddenly.
• Place heavier objects on the
floor and as far forward in the
cargo area as possible. Never
pile cargo higher than the top of
the seatbacks.
Steps for Determining Correct Load
Limit
1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg
or XXX lbs” on your vehicle’s placard.
2) Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will
be riding in your vehicle.
3) Subtract the combined weight of
the driver and passengers from
XXX kg or XXX lbs.
4) The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
the “XXX” amount equals 1400 lbs
and there will be five 150 lb passen-
7-34
79K21-03E
Fuses: 7
Headlight Aiming:
Bulb Replacement: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
gers in your vehicle, the amount of
available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs (1400 – 750 (5 x
150) = 650 lbs).
5) Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo
and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.
6) If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
Vehicle Loading Example
As an example, suppose that the Tire
and Loading Information label on your
vehicle indicates that your vehicle’s
total load capacity is 950 lbs. If you
were to drive your vehicle with one
passenger, and the total combined
weight of you and your passenger was
350 lbs, then the cargo and luggage
capacity of your vehicle would be 600
lbs (950 – 350 = 600 lbs).
If you later added 2 more passengers,
having a combined weight of 325 lbs,
the cargo and luggage capacity of
your vehicle would be reduced from
600 lbs to 275 lbs (600 – 325 = 275
lbs). As you can see, as the number
and combined weight of vehicle occupants increase, the vehicle’s cargo
and luggage capacity decreases.
Suppose again, that you were to take
a trip in your vehicle with the same
three passengers described above,
and you decided to tow a trailer having
a trailer tongue weight of 75 lbs. The
cargo and luggage capacity would be
reduced again, to 200 lbs (275 – 75 =
200 lbs).
NOTE:
Use of replacement tires with a higher
load-carrying capacity than the original tires, or using a tire inflation pressure higher than the recommended
tire inflation pressure, will not increase
the GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehicle.
Determining Compatibility of Tire
and Vehicle Load Limits
The tires on your vehicle, when they
are inflated to the recommended tire
inflation pressure, have a load-carrying capacity that is greater than the
load that will be on the tires when the
vehicle is at its GVWR or GAWR limit.
Never use replacement tires that have
a load-carrying capacity less than the
original tires on your vehicle. Tire loadcarrying capacity information is
molded into the tire sidewall typically
shown as “Max. Load”. Use of replacement tires with a lower load-carrying
capacity than the original tires, or failure to keep the tires inflated to recommended tire pressure, may reduce the
GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehicle.
7-35
79K21-03E
Bulb Replacement: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Battery
WARNING
To avoid harm to yourself or damage
to your vehicle or battery, follow the
jump starting instructions in the
“EMERGENCY SERVICE” section of
this manual if it is necessary to jump
start your vehicle.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
60A269
WARNING
Batteries produce flammable hydrogen gas. Keep flames and sparks
away from the battery or an explosion
may occur. Never smoke when working near the battery.
WARNING
When checking or servicing the battery, disconnect the negative cable.
Be careful not to cause a short circuit
by allowing metal objects to contact
the battery posts and the vehicle at
the same time.
Battery posts, terminals and related
accessories contain lead and lead
compounds. Wash hands after handling.
Fuses
Your vehicle has three types of fuses, as
described below:
Main Fuse – The main fuse takes current
directly from the battery.
Primary Fuses – These fuses are between
the main fuse and individual fuses, and are
for electrical load groups.
Individual Fuses – These fuses are for individual electrical circuits.
For details on protected circuits, refer to
the “FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS” section in this manual.
Your vehicle is equipped with a battery that
requires infrequent maintenance. You will
never have to add water. You should, however, periodically check the battery, battery
terminals and battery hold-down bracket
for corrosion. Remove corrosion using a
stiff brush and ammonia mixed with water,
or baking soda mixed with water. After
removing corrosion, rinse with clean water.
The test indicator on the top of the battery
provides information on the condition of
the battery.
If your vehicle is not going to be driven for
a month or longer, disconnect the cable
from the negative terminal of the battery to
help prevent discharge.
7-36
79K21-03E
Bulb Replacement: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Main Fuse Box
64J157
Main Fuse / Primary Fuse
(1)
15A CPRSR
A/C compressor fuse
(2)
20A O2 HTR
O2 sensor heater
fuse
(3)
15A THR MOT Throttle motor fuse
(4)
20A AT
Automatic transmission fuse
(5)
25A RR DEF
Rear defogger fuse
(6)
15A HORN
Horn fuse
(7)
20A FR FOG
Front fog light fuse
(8)
20A MRR HTR Mirror heater fuse
(9)
40A FR BLW
(10) 30A ABS 2
(11) 50A ABS 1
ABS actuator fuse
(12) 20A FI
Main fuse
PRIMARY
FUSE
(13)
Blank
60A LAMP
Head light, Accessory,
Dome light, Sunroof,
Hazard light, Door lock,
Rear fog light, Stop
lamp, Tail light
50A IGN 2
Wiper/Washer, Power
window, Seat heater
40A 4WD
4WD actuator
30A RDTR 1
Radiator fan
30A RDTR 2
Radiator fan
–
–
(14) 10A H/L L
Head light high beam
fuse, left
(15) 10A H/L R
Head light high beam
fuse, right
(16) 10A H/L
Head light fuse
(17) 40A ST
Starter motor fuse
(18) 40A IGN
Ignition fuse
(19) 15A H/L LO L
Head light low beam
fuse, left
(20) 15A H/L LO R
Head light low beam
fuse, right
The main fuse, primary fuses and some of
the individual fuses are located in the
engine compartment. If the main fuse
blows, no electrical component will function. If a primary fuse blows, no electrical
component in the corresponding load
group will function. When replacing the
main fuse or a primary fuse, use a genuine
SUZUKI replacement.
INDIVIDUAL FUSE
WARNING
If a fuse in the main fuse box blows,
be sure to have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI
dealer. Always use a genuine SUZUKI
replacement. Never use a substitute
such as a wire even for a temporary
fix, or extensive electrical damage
and a fire can result.
Front blower motor
fuse
ABS actuator fuse
7-37
79K21-03E
Bulb Replacement: 7
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Fuse under the Dash Board
Fuse box
64J192
(J)
(I)
(V) (U) (T)
(H) (G) (F)
(E) (D) (C) (B) (A)
SPARE
SPARE
SPARE SPARE SPARE
SPARE
USE THE DESIGNATED
FUSES AND RELAYS ONLY
(K)
(S) (R) (Q) (P) (O) (N) (M) (L)
(X)
(W)
79K057
ACC
Radio, Remote door
mirror fuse
10A
METER
Meter fuse
15A
IG COIL
Ignition coil fuse
–
Blank
P/W
Power window fuse
(A)
10A
DOME
Dome lamp fuse
(T)
(B)
10A
STOP
Stop lamp fuse
(U)
(C)
–
–
Blank
(V)
(W)
–
(X)
30A
(D)
15A
ACC 3
Accessory socket
fuse
(E)
10A
CRUISE
Cruise control fuse
(F)
15A
ACC 2
Cigar or Accessory
socket fuse
(G)
20A
WIP
Wiper fuse
(H)
15A
IG2 SIG
Ignition signal & Seat
heater fuse
(I)
10A
BACK
Back lamp fuse
(J)
10A
ABS/ESP
ABS or ESP controller fuse
(K)
10A
A/B
Air bag fuse
(L)
15A
RADIO
Radio fuse
(M)
15A
HAZ
Hazard light fuse
(N)
7.5A ST SIG
Starter signal fuse
(O)
10A
Engine control
module fuse
ECM
(P)
25A
S/R
Sun roof motor fuse
(Q)
25A
B/U
Buck up fuse
(R)
10A
TAIL
Tail light fuse
(S)
20A
D/L
Door lock actuator
fuse
15A
65D045
The fuse box is located under the driver’s
side of the dashboard. To remove a fuse,
use the fuse puller provided in the fuse
box.
7-38
79K21-03E
Bulb Replacement: 7
Wiper Blades: 3
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Headlight Aiming
WARNING
Since special procedures are required, we
recommend you take your vehicle to your
SUZUKI dealer for headlight alignment.
Always be sure to replace a blown
fuse with a fuse of the correct amperage. Never use a substitute such as
aluminum foil or wire to replace a
blown fuse. If you replace a fuse and
the new one blows in a short period
of time, you may have a major electrical problem. Have your vehicle
inspected immediately by your
SUZUKI dealer.
OK
BLOWN
NOTE:
Make sure that the fuse box cover always
carries spare fuses.
60A243
OK
BLOWN
81A283
7-39
79K21-03E
Wiper Blades: 3
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Bulb Replacement
Center Interior Light (if equipped)
Rear Interior Light (if equipped)
WARNING
• Light bulbs can be hot enough to
burn your finger right after being
turned off. This is true especially
for halogen headlight bulbs.
Replace the bulbs after they
become cool enough.
• The headlight bulbs are filled with
pressurized halogen gas. They can
burst and injure you if they are hit
or dropped. Handle them carefully.
CAUTION
The oils from your skin may cause a
halogen bulb to overheat and burst
when the lights are on. Grasp a new
bulb with a clean cloth.
CAUTION
64J159
64J160
Pull down the lens by using a flat blade
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as
shown. To install it, simply push it back in.
Pull down the lens by using a flat blade
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as
shown. To install it, simply push it back in.
The bulb can be removed by simply pulling
it out. When replacing the bulb, make sure
that the contact springs are holding the
bulb securely.
The bulb can be removed by simply pulling
it out.
Frequent replacement of a bulb indicates the need for an inspection of
the electrical system. This should be
carried out by your SUZUKI dealer.
NOTE:
If it is difficult to replace headlight bulbs or
clearance light bulbs due to under-hood
components trust this job to your dealer.
7-40
79K21-03E
Wiper Blades: 3
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Spot Light (if equipped)
Headlights
Pull down the lens by using a flat blade
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as
shown.
Low beam
(Halogen headlamp)
Open the engine hood. Disconnect the
coupler. Remove the sealing rubber.
Push the retaining spring forward and
unhook it. Then remove the bulb. Install a
new bulb in the reverse order of removal.
Ceiling-mount type (if equipped)
High beam
79K089
79K061
Remove the bulb holder by turning it counterclockwise. Pull out the bulb.
78F072
Open the engine hood. Disconnect the
coupler while pushing the lock release.
Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise to
remove it.
66J108
7-41
79K21-03E
Wiper Blades: 3
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Front Fog Light
(1)
(4)
(3)
(2)
79K090
1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver into the
hole (2) and remove the clips (1) by
twist the driver as shown in the illustration.
2) Remove the bolt (3) by a Phillips-head
screwdriver.
65J357
78F072
3) Remove the clip (4) with the same way
as No.1).
4) Open the fender cover. Disconnect the
coupler with pushing the lock release.
Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise
and remove it.
7-42
79K21-03E
Air Conditioning System: 4
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Other General Lights
Position/Turn signal light
Bulb
Bulb holder
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
(1)
(3)
(2)
(4)
(1)
(2)
54G124
54G123
(1) Removal
(2) Installation
To remove a bulb holder from a light housing, turn the holder counterclockwise and
pull it out. To install the holder, push the
holder in and turn it clockwise.
(3) Removal
(4) Installation
There are two types of bulb, “Full glass
type” (1) and “Glass/metal type” (2).
To remove and install a full glass type bulb
(1), simply pull out or push in the bulb.
64J163
To replace the bulb of position/turn signal
light, follow the procedure for the bulb
replacement of the “Front Fog Light”.
Rear combination light
EXAMPLE
To remove a glass metal type bulb (2) from
a bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it
counterclockwise. To install a new bulb,
push it in and turn it clockwise.
You can access the individual bulb or bulb
holders as follows.
78K124
7-43
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Door illumination light
License plate light
High-mount stop light (if equipped)
The followings are the general procedure
for replace the bulbs of high-mount stop
light.
Since special procedures are required, we
recommend you take your vehicle to your
SUZUKI dealer for the bulbs of high-mount
stop light replacement.
(1)
(1)
(2)
65J345
Turn the cover (1) counterclockwise to
remove it.
64J165
Luggage compartment light
NOTE:
When reinstalling, put the packing (2)
between the cover and bulb holder.
64J181
To remove a high-mounted stop light housing the following procedure:
1) Open the tailgate, and remove the trim
(1) as shown in the illustration.
64J166
7-44
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
(2)
64J182
64J183
64J184
2) Release the claws of the light housing
by the flat head etc. through the service
holes as shown in the illustration.
3) Close the tailgate. Remove a highmounted stop light housing (2) from the
tailgate.
4) Remove the each bulb.
5) Replace the bulbs.
To install a high-mounted stop light
housing in the reverse order of removal.
7-45
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Wiper Blades
For windshield wipers:
52D102
54G129
If the wiper blades become brittle or damaged, or make streaks when wiping,
replace the wiper blades.
70G119
1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window.
2) Squeeze lock lever (1) towards wiper
arm (2) and remove the wiper frame
from the arm as shown.
To install new wiper blades, follow the procedures below.
CAUTION
To avoid scratching or breaking the
window, do not let the wiper arm
strike the window while replacing the
wiper blade.
NOTE:
Some wiper blades may be different from
the ones described here depending on
vehicle specifications. If so, consult your
SUZUKI dealer for proper replacement
method.
7-46
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Installation
60A260
3) Pull the locked end of the wiper blade
firmly to unlock the blade and slide the
blade out as shown.
52D124
(3) Retainer
4) If the new blade is provided without the
two metal retainers, move them from
the old blade to the new one.
52D125
(4) Locked end
5) Install the new blade in the reverse
order of removal, with the locked end
positioned toward the wiper arm. Make
sure the blade is properly retained by
all the hooks. Grasp the blade near the
locked end and pull in the direction of
the arrows to lock the end into place.
6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm, making
sure that the lock lever is snapped
securely into the arm.
7-47
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
For rear wipers:
65D151
NOTE:
Do not flex the wiper blade frame end more
than necessary. If you do, it can break off.
54G135
(1) Retainer
4) If the new blade is provided without the
two metal retainers, move them from
the old blade to the new one.
5) Install the new blade in the reverse
order of removal.
Make sure the blade is properly
retained by all the hooks.
6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm in the
reverse order of removal.
80G146
1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window.
2) Remove the wiper frame from the arm
as shown.
3) Slide the blade out as shown.
7-48
79K21-03E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Windshield Washer Fluid
fluid tank. If the fluid level is near empty,
refill it.
Front and rear (if equipped)
Use a good quality windshield washer
fluid, diluted with water as necessary.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Do not use “anti-freeze” solution in
the windshield washer reservoir. This
can severely impair visibility when
sprayed on the windshield, and also
damage your vehicle’s paint.
Air Conditioning System
If you do not use the air conditioner for a
long period, such as during winter, it may
not give the best performance when you
start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.
Operate the air conditioner at least once a
month for one minute with the engine
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil
and helps protect the internal components.
CAUTION
(or opposite side)
66J008
Damage may result if the washer
motor is operated with no fluid in the
washer tank.
66J116
Check that there is washer fluid in the tank
by looking at the washer fluid level gauge
which is attached to the cap of the washer
7-49
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Tire Changing Tool ............................................................. 8-1
Spare Tire Nut Lock (if equipped) ...................................... 8-1
Jacking Instructions ........................................................... 8-2
Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-3
Jump Starting Instructions ................................................ 8-7
Towing a Disabled Vehicle ................................................. 8-8
If the Starter Does Not Operate .......................................... 8-8
If the Engine is Flooded ...................................................... 8-9
If the Engine Overheats ...................................................... 8-9
8
60G411
79K21-03E
Jacking Instructions: 5
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Tire Changing Tool
WARNING
After using the tire changing tools,
be sure to stow them securely, or
they could be thrown about in an
accident, causing injury.
Spare Tire Nut Lock
(if equipped)
To UNLOCK
To LOCK
64J124
The jack, wheel brace and jack handle are
stowed in the rear left corner of the luggage compartment. Remove the cover to
access the tools.
To remove the jack, turn its shaft counterclockwise and pull the jack out of the storage bracket. To stow the jack, place it in
the storage bracket and turn the shaft
clockwise until the jack is securely held in
place.
64J172
A nut lock is used for the spare tire. To
unlock the spare tire nut, insert the ignition
key into the lock as far as the key will go
and remove the lock with the key in. To lock
the spare tire nut, put the lock on the nut
and push the lock in.
WARNING
The tire changing tools should be
used only to change wheels. It is
important to read the jacking instructions in this section before attempting to use the jack.
8-1
79K21-03E
Jacking Instructions: 5
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Jacking Instructions
jack-head groove fits around the jacking
point beneath the vehicle body.
(3)
(1)
(2)
64J194
75F062
1) Place the vehicle on level, hard ground.
2) Set the parking brake firmly and shift
into “P” (Park) if your vehicle has an
automatic transmission, or shift into “R”
(Reverse) if your vehicle has a manual
transmission.
3) Turn on the hazard warning flasher if
your vehicle is near traffic.
4) Block the front and rear of the wheel
diagonally opposite of the wheel being
lifted.
5) Place the spare wheel near the wheel
being lifted as shown in the illustration
in case that the jack slips.
79K059
(2) Jack handle
(3) Wheel brace
7) Continue to raise the jack slowly and
smoothly until the tire clears the
ground. Do not raise the vehicle more
than necessary.
(1)
79K058
(1) Jacking point
6) Position the jack as shown in the illustration and raise the jack by turning the
8-2
79K21-03E
Jump Starting Instructions: 7
EMERGENCY SERVICE
WARNING
• Use the jack only to change wheels
on level, hard ground.
• Never jack up the vehicle on an
inclined surface.
• Never raise the vehicle with the
jack in a location other than the
designated jacking point near the
wheel to be changed.
• Make sure that the jack is raised at
least 51 mm (2 inches) before it
contacts the flange. Use of the jack
when it is within 51 mm (2 inches)
of being fully collapsed may result
in failure of the jack.
• Never get under the vehicle when it
is supported by the jack.
• Never run the engine when the
vehicle is supported by the jack
and never allow passengers to
remain in the vehicle.
Changing Wheels
To change a wheel, use the following procedure:
To remove the spare wheel:
1) Remove the jack and tools from the
vehicle.
(2)
(A)
(1)
78K151
3) Unhook the under claws (1) and the
middle claws (2) one by one.
(3)
78K150
2) Release the lock at the underneath of
the spare wheel full cover (A) as shown
in the illustration.
78K152
4) Unhook the upper claws (3), and
remove the wheel full cover.
8-3
79K21-03E
Jump Starting Instructions: 7
Towing a Disabled Vehicle: 6
If the Starter Does Not Operate: 2, 9
EMERGENCY SERVICE
NOTE:
Remove the full wheel cover from the bottom part to the upper part. Otherwise, the
claws may be broken.
facing the wheel. Tighten each nut
snugly by hand until the wheel is
securely seated on the hub.
(B)
(Half cover type)
78K153
(4)
(5)
78K060
NOTE:
If your vehicle is equipped with the half
cover, remove the center bolt (4), then
remove the outer cover (5) of the spare
wheel half cover.
5) Pull out the lock cover (B) fitted on the
lock nut of the spare wheel while inserting the key full into the key hole of the
lock cover (B).
6) Remove the lock nut and wheel nuts of
the spare wheel, then remove the spare
wheel with both hands.
To change the wheel:
1) Loosen, but do not remove the wheel
nuts.
2) Jack up the vehicle (follow the jacking
instructions in this section)
3) Remove the wheel nuts and wheel.
4) Before installing the new wheel, clean
any mud or dirt off from the surface of
the wheel and hub with a clean cloth.
Clean the hub carefully; it may be hot
from driving.
5) Install the new wheel and replace the
wheel nuts with their cone shaped end
EXAMPLE
81A057
Tightening torque for wheel nut
100 Nm (10.0 kg-m, 72.3 lb-ft)
6) Lower the jack and fully tighten the nuts
in a crisscross fashion with a wrench as
shown in the illustration.
8-4
79K21-03E
If the Engine is Flooded: 2, 9
If the Engine Overheats: 2, 9
EMERGENCY SERVICE
WARNING
Use genuine wheel nuts and tighten
them to the specified torque as soon
as possible after changing wheels.
Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly
tightened wheel nuts may come
loose or fall off, which can result in
an accident. If you do not have a
torque wrench, have the wheel nut
torque checked by an authorized
SUZUKI dealer.
To install the wheel:
(1)
(2)
(4)
(5)
78K155
78K063
2) Put the spare tire nut lock (4) on the
spare tire nut and push the lock in.
3) Install the wheel cover in the reverse
order to removal.
NOTE:
When you install the spare tire full cover,
make sure the position of the upper claws
marked on outside (5) and holes, then
hook them first.
(3)
78K154
1) Install the wheel with both hands to the
spare tire carrier (1) as shown in the
illustration.
Then tighten the wheel nuts (2) and
spare tire nut (3).
8-5
79K21-03E
If the Engine Overheats: 2, 9
If You Cannot Shift Automatic Transmission Gearshift Lever Out of “P” (PARK): 2, 9
EMERGENCY SERVICE
WARNING
(3)
(4)
64J196
CAUTION
To avoid the removal of the spare
wheel full cover while driving, be
sure to fit the claws (3) of the outer
cover of the spare wheel full cover to
each hole (4) of the inner cover of the
spare wheel full cover.
Vehicle equipped with P225/65R17
tires have a spare wheel and tire that
are a different size than the wheels
and tires on the vehicle. The spare
wheel and tire on these vehicles are
intended for temporary emergency
use only. The wheel is painted yellow
to remind you that the wheel and tire
are for temporary use only. Continuous use of this spare can result in tire
failure and loss of control. Always
observe these precautions when
using this spare:
• Be aware that your vehicle will handle differently with this temporary
spare.
• Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph)
speed.
• Replace the temporary spare with a
standard tire and wheel as soon as
possible.
• Do not operate your vehicle in “4H
LOCK” or “4L LOCK” with this temporary spare.
• Do not use tire chains on the spare
tire. If you must use tire chains,
rearrange the wheels so standard
tires and wheels are fitted to the
rear axle.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Replace the spare tire with a new
one as soon as the tread wear indicator appears.
• When replacing the spare tire, use
a replacement tire with the exact
same size and construction.
Snow Tires
Your vehicle is equipped with all-season
tires which are designed for use in summer
and most winter conditions. For improved
traction in severe winter conditions,
SUZUKI recommends mounting radial
snow tires on all four wheels. Snow tires
must be the same size as the standard
tires. Also be sure to use the tires of the
same type and brand on all four wheels of
your vehicle.
8-6
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Jump Starting Instructions
WARNING
• Never attempt to jump start your
vehicle if the battery appears to be
frozen. Batteries in this condition
may explode or rupture if jump
starting is attempted.
• When making jumper cable connections, be certain that your
hands and the jumper cables
remain clear from pulleys, belts or
fans.
• Batteries
produce
flammable
hydrogen gas. Keep flames and
sparks away from the battery or an
explosion may occur. Never smoke
when working near the battery.
• If the booster battery you use for
jump starting is installed in another
vehicle, make sure the two vehicles
are not touching each other.
• If your battery discharges repeatedly, for no apparent reason, have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer.
• To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump starting instructions
below precisely and in order. If you
are in doubt, call for qualified road
service.
CAUTION
Your vehicle should not be started by
pushing or towing. This starting
method could result in permanent
damage to the catalytic converter.
Use jumper cables to start a vehicle
with a weak or run-down battery.
When jump starting your vehicle, use
the following procedure:
2) Turn off all vehicle accessories, except
those necessary for safety reasons (for
example, headlights or hazard lights).
EXAMPLE
Engine Hook
Discharged
Battery
12V BATTERY
Charged Battery
60A270
60A269
1) Use only a 12-volt battery to jump start
your vehicle. Position the good 12-volt
battery close to your vehicle so that the
jumper cables will reach both batteries.
When using a battery installed on
another vehicle, DO NOT LET THE
VEHICLES TOUCH. Set the parking
brakes fully on both vehicles.
EXAMPLE
52D129
8-7
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
3) Make jumper cable connections as follows:
1. Connect one end of the first jumper
cable to the positive (+) terminal of
the discharged battery (1).
2. Connect the other end to the positive
(+) terminal of the booster battery
(2).
3. Connect one end of the second
jumper cable to the negative (–) terminal of the booster battery (2).
4. Make the final connection to an
unpainted, heavy metal part (i.e.
engine hook (3)) of the engine of the
vehicle with the discharged battery
(1).
WARNING
Never connect the jumper cable
directly to the negative (–) terminal of
the discharged battery, or an explosion may occur.
4) If the booster battery you are using is
installed on another vehicle, start the
engine of the vehicle with the booster
battery. Run the engine at moderate
speed.
5) Start the engine of the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
6) Remove the jumper cables in the exact
reverse order in which you connected
them.
Towing a Disabled Vehicle
Emergency Towing
If your vehicle is disabled, it may be towed
by a tow truck using one of the following
methods:
1) Tow the vehicle with two wheels lifted
by the tow truck and the other two
wheels on a towing dolly.
2) Use the appropriate towing method
specified for your vehicle in the “Towing
Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section, but with the wheels lifted by the
tow truck instead of on a towing dolly.
Be sure to carefully follow the specific
instructions provided in the “Towing
Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section.
If the Starter Does Not
Operate
1) Try turning the ignition switch to the
“START” position with the headlights
turned on to determine the battery condition. If the headlights go excessively
dim or go off, it usually means that
either the battery has run down or battery terminal contact is poor. Recharge
the battery or correct battery terminal
contact if necessary.
2) If the headlights remain bright, check
the fuses. If the reason for failure of the
starter is not obvious, there may be a
major electrical problem. Have the vehicle inspected by your authorized
SUZUKI dealer.
CAUTION
If vehicle damage (such as steering
or drivetrain damage, inability to
operate free axle mechanism, etc.)
prevent normal use of the towing procedures for your vehicle described in
the “Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section, have your
vehicle towed with two wheels lifted
by the tow truck and the other two
wheels on a towing dolly.
8-8
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
If the Engine is Flooded
If the Engine Overheats
If the engine is flooded with gasoline, it
may be hard to start. If this happens, press
the accelerator pedal all the way to the
floor and hold it there while cranking the
engine. (Do not operate the starter motor
for more than 15 seconds).
The engine could overheat temporarily
under severe driving conditions. If the
engine coolant temperature gauge indicates overheating during driving:
1) Turn off the air conditioner, if equipped.
2) Take the vehicle to a safe place and
park.
3) Let the engine run at normal idle speed
for a few minutes until the indicator is
within the normal, acceptable temperature range shown by the white band
between “H” and “C”.
WARNING
If you see or hear escaping steam,
stop the vehicle in a safe place and
immediately turn off the engine to let
it cool. Do not open the hood when
steam is present. When the steam
can no longer be seen or heard, open
the hood to see if the coolant is still
boiling. If it is, you must wait until it
stops boiling before you proceed.
Also, be careful not to touch hot
engine parts (radiator, water hoses,
engine etc.).
If the temperature indication does not
come down to within the normal, acceptable range:
1) Turn off the engine and check that the
water pump belt and pulleys are not
damaged or slipping. If any abnormality
is found, correct it.
2) Check the coolant level in the reservoir.
If it is found to be lower than the “LOW”
line, look for leaks at the radiator, water
pump and radiator and heater hoses. If
you locate any leaks that may have
caused the overheating, do not run the
engine until these problems have been
corrected.
3) If you do not find a leak, carefully add
coolant to the reservoir and then the
radiator, if necessary. (Refer to “Engine
Coolant” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section.)
8-9
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
66J191
WARNING
• It is hazardous to remove the radiator cap when the water temperature
is high, because scalding fluid and
steam may be blown out under
pressure. The cap should only be
taken off when the coolant temperature has lowered.
• To prevent personal injury, keep
hands, tools and clothing away
from the engine cooling fan and airconditioner fan (if equipped). These
electric fans can automatically turn
on without warning.
8-10
79K21-03E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
MEMO
8-11
79K21-03E
APPEARANCE CARE
APPEARANCE CARE
Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1
Vehicle Cleaning ................................................................. 9-3
60G412
9
79K21-03E
Corrosion Prevention: 5
APPEARANCE CARE
Corrosion Prevention
It is important to take good care of your
vehicle to protect it from corrosion.
vehicle which are not well ventilated to
permit quick drying.
Listed below are instructions for how to
maintain your vehicle to prevent corrosion.
Please read and follow these instructions
carefully.
Wash your vehicle immediately after using
it off-road. For washing instructions, refer
to the “Vehicle Cleaning” section.
Important Information About Corrosion
Common causes of corrosion
1) Accumulation of road salt, dirt, moisture
or chemicals in hard-to-reach areas of
the vehicle underbody or frame.
2) Chipping, scratches and any damage to
treated or painted metal surfaces
resulting from minor accidents or
impact from stones and gravel.
Environmental conditions which accelerate corrosion
1) Road salt, dust control chemicals, sea
air or industrial pollution will all accelerate the corrosion of metal.
2) High humidity will increase the rate of
corrosion particularly when the temperature range is just above the freezing
point.
3) Moisture in certain areas of a vehicle
for an extended period of time may promote corrosion even though other body
sections may be completely dry.
4) High temperatures will cause an accelerated rate of corrosion to parts of the
If you frequently drive on salted roads, your
vehicle should be washed at least once a
month during the winter. If you live near the
ocean, your vehicle should be washed at
least once a month throughout the year.
52D151
This information illustrates the necessity of
keeping your vehicle (particularly the
underbody) as clean and dry as possible. It
is equally important to repair any damage
to the paint or protective coatings as soon
as possible.
How to Help Prevent Corrosion
Wash your vehicle frequently
The best way to preserve the finish on your
vehicle and to help avoid corrosion is to
keep it clean with frequent washing.
Wash your vehicle at least once during the
winter and once immediately after the winter. Keep your vehicle, particularly the
underside, as clean and dry as possible.
Remove foreign material deposits
Foreign material such as salts, chemicals,
road oil or tar, tree sap, bird droppings and
industrial fall-out may damage the finish of
your vehicle if it is left on painted surfaces.
Remove these types of deposits as quickly
as possible. If these deposits are difficult to
wash off, an additional cleaner may be
required. Be sure that any cleaner you use
is not harmful to painted surfaces and is
specifically intended for your purposes.
Follow the manufacturer’s directions when
using these special cleaners.
WARNING
Foreign material can lodge between
the fuel tank of your vehicle and the
skid plate which covers it. You should
periodically clean out any foreign
material which has accumulated in
this area, since it could create a fire
hazard.
9-1
79K21-03E
Corrosion Prevention: 5
APPEARANCE CARE
Repair finish damage
Carefully examine your vehicle for damage
to the painted surfaces, especially if it is
used off-road. Should you find any chips or
scratches in the paint, touch them up
immediately to prevent corrosion from
starting. If the chips or scratches have
gone through to the bare metal, have a
qualified body shop make the repair.
Keep passenger and cargo compartments clean
Moisture, dirt or mud can accumulate
under the floor mats and may cause corrosion. Occasionally, check under these
mats to ensure that this area is clean and
dry. More frequent checks are necessary if
the vehicle is used off road or in wet
weather.
Certain cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers, cleaners, salts, etc. are extremely corrosive by nature. These products should
be transported in sealed containers. If a
spill or leak does occur, clean and dry the
area immediately.
Use mud and gravel shields
The use of mud and gravel shields will help
protect your vehicle, especially if you frequently drive on gravel or salted roads.
Full-size shields, which extend as close to
the road as is practical, are the best. The
fittings for such shields should also be corrosion resistant. Please check with your
authorized SUZUKI dealer for information
on these shields.
Cover your vehicle
Store your vehicle in a dry, well-ventilated area
Do not park your vehicle in a damp, poorly
ventilated area. If you often wash your
vehicle in the garage or if you frequently
drive it in when wet, your garage may be
damp. The high humidity in the garage
may cause or accelerate corrosion. A wet
vehicle may corrode even in a heated
garage if the ventilation is poor.
WARNING
Do not apply additional undercoating
or rust preventive coating on or
around exhaust system components
such as the catalytic converter,
exhaust pipes, etc. A fire could be
started if the undercoating substance
becomes overheated.
50G203
If you cannot regularly park your vehicle in
a garage, we recommend you use a vehicle cover. Years of exposure to midday sun
can cause the colors in paint, plastic parts
and fabrics to fade. Covering your vehicle
with a high-quality, “breathable” vehicle
cover can help protect the finish from the
harmful UV rays in sunlight, and can
reduce the amount of dust and air pollution
reaching the surface. Your SUZUKI dealer
can help you select the right cover for your
vehicle.
9-2
79K21-03E
Vehicle Cleaning: 5
APPEARANCE CARE
Vehicle Cleaning
damp cloth to remove dirt and the soap
solution. If some dirt still remains on the
surface, repeat this procedure.
Fabric upholstery
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Using a mild soap solution, rub stained
areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove
soap, rub the areas again with a cloth
dampened with water. Repeat this until the
stain is removed, or use a commercial fabric cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a
fabric cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions.
76G044S
WARNING
When cleaning the interior or exterior
of the vehicle, NEVER USE flammable
solvents such lacquer thinners, gasoline, benzene or cleaning materials
such as bleaches and strong household detergents. The materials could
cause personal injury or damage to
the vehicle.
Cleaning Interior
Vinyl upholstery
Prepare a solution of soap or mild detergent mixed with warm water. Apply the
solution to the vinyl with a sponge or soft
cloth and let it soak for a few minutes to
loosen dirt. Rub the surface with a clean,
Leather upholstery
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Using a mild soap or saddle soap solution,
wipe dirt off with a clean damp soft cloth.
To remove soap, wipe the areas again with
a soft cloth dampened with water. Wipe the
areas dry with a soft dry cloth. Repeat this
until the dirt or stain is removed, or use a
commercial leather cleaner for tougher dirt
or stains. If you use a leather cleaner, carefully follow the manufacture’s instructions
and precautions. Do not use solvent type
cleaners or abrasive cleaners.
Vinyl floor mats
Ordinary dirt can be removed from vinyl
with water or mild soap. Use a brush to
help loosen dirt. After dirt is loosened,
rinse the mat thoroughly with water and
dry it in the shade.
Carpets
Remove dirt and soil as much as possible
with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap
solution, rub stained areas with a clean
damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas
again with a cloth dampened with water.
Repeat this until the stain is removed, or
use a commercial carpet cleaner for
tougher stains. If you use a carpet cleaner,
carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions.
Instrument panel and console
NOTE:
Wipe up spills containing chemicals, alcohol, etc., immediately with a soft, damp
cloth. Use a mild soap solution if necessary. Do not use cleaners or polishes containing strong solvents or acidic solutions.
These chemicals may stain and discolor
the instrument panel and console.
Seat belts
Clean seat belts with a mild soap and
water. Do not use bleach or dye on the
belts. They may weaken the fabric in the
belts.
9-3
79K21-03E
Vehicle Cleaning: 5
APPEARANCE CARE
Cleaning the Exterior
CAUTION
CAUTION
It is important that your vehicle be
kept clean and free from dirt. Failure
to keep your vehicle clean may result
in fading of the paint or corrosion to
various parts of the vehicle body.
Washing
WARNING
When washing the vehicle:
• Avoid directing steam or hot water
of more than 80°C (176°F) on plastic parts.
• To avoid damaging engine components, do not use pressurized
water in the engine compartment.
• Do not pour the water on the battery. And wipe off the water which
remains on the battery. The water
entering inside the battery possibly
causes fluid leakage.
• Never attempt to wash and wax
your vehicle with the engine running.
• When cleaning the underside of the
body and fender, where there may
be sharp-edged parts, you should
wear gloves and a long-sleeved
shirt to protect your hands and
arms from being cut.
• After washing your vehicle, carefully test the brakes before driving
to make sure they have maintained
their normal effectiveness.
2) Rinse the body to loosen the dirt.
Remove dirt and mud from the body
exterior with running water. You may
use a soft sponge or brush. Do not use
hard materials which can scratch the
paint or plastic. Remember that the
headlight covers or lenses are made of
plastic in many cases.
When washing the vehicle, follow the
instructions below:
To avoid damage to the paint or plastic surface, do not wipe the dirt off
without ample water. Be sure to follow above procedure.
1) Flush the underside of body and wheel
housings with pressurized water to
remove mud and debris. Use plenty of
water.
CAUTION
cloth should be frequently soaked in the
soap solution.
CAUTION
When using a commercial car wash
product, observe the cautions specified by the manufacturer. Never use
strong household detergents or
soaps.
4) Once the dirt has been completely
removed, rinse off the detergent with
running water.
5) After rinsing, wipe off the vehicle body
with a wet chamois or cloth and allow it
to dry in the shade.
6) Check carefully for damage to painted
surfaces. If there is any damage,
“touch-up” the damage following the
procedure below:
1. Clean all damaged spots and allow
them to dry.
2. Stir the paint and “touch-up” the
damaged spots lightly using a small
brush.
3. Allow the paint to dry completely.
3) Wash the entire exterior with a mild
detergent or car wash soap using a
sponge or soft cloth. The sponge or
9-4
79K21-03E
APPEARANCE CARE
Waxing
60B211S
After washing the vehicle, waxing and polishing are recommended to further protect
and beautify the paint.
• Only use waxes and polishes of good
quality.
• When using waxes and polishes,
observe the precautions specified by the
manufacturers.
9-5
79K21-03E
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION
Identification Numbers ....................................................... 10-1
Safety Certification Label ................................................... 10-2
Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ........................... 10-2
Warranties ............................................................................ 10-2
On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data
Recorders ............................................................................ 10-3
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................... 10-4
54G072
10
79K21-03E
Identification Numbers: 2, 5
GENERAL INFORMATION
Identification Numbers
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
may be found in the two locations shown in
the above illustrations. This number is
used to register the vehicle. It is also used
to assist your dealer when ordering parts
or referring to special service information.
Vehicle Identification Number
EXAMPLE (for some vehicles)
3.2 L engine model
Engine Serial Number
2.4 L engine model
79K060
The engine serial number is stamped on
the cylinder block as shown in the above
illustration.
60G152
60G128
64J197
10-1
79K21-03E
Safety Certification Label: 6
Emission Compliance Label (For U.S.A.): 1, 2
Warranties: NO
GENERAL INFORMATION
Safety Certification Label
Emission Compliance Label
(for U.S.A.)
Warranties
The warranties covering your vehicle are
explained in a separate New Vehicle Warranty Information booklet given to you at
the time of sale. Please read this booklet
carefully so you can understand your rights
and responsibilities.
For U.S.A.
The following warranties are provided with
your vehicle:
• New Vehicle Limited Warranty
• Limited Warranty For SUZUKI Parts or
Accessories
• Emission Components Defect Warranty
• Emission Performance Warranty
52D059
This label contains important safetyrelated information about your vehicle. The
label is located on the driver’s door lock pillar.
60A412
The EPA emission compliance label is
located under the hood.
10-2
79K21-03E
Reporting Safety Defects: NO
GENERAL INFORMATION
On-Board Vehicle Computers
and Event Data Recorders
Your vehicle is equipped with on-board
computer systems which monitor and
control several aspects of vehicle performance, including the following:
• Emission-related components and
engine parameters such as engine
speed and throttle position are monitored to provide emissions control
and to provide optimum fuel economy. Your vehicle also has an onboard diagnostic system which monitors and records information about
emission-related malfunctions.
• Signals from various sensors are
monitored to provide air bag deployment.
• If your vehicle is equipped with
antilock brakes, conditions such as
vehicle speed and brake performance are monitored, so that the
ABS system can provide effective
antilock braking. If your vehicle has
an Electronic Stability Program
(ESP®) system, conditions such as
yaw rate, lateral acceleration, and
brake fluid pressure are monitored,
so that the ESP® system can help
the driver control the vehicle in difficult driving situations.
Some information may be stored by
the on-board computers during normal
operation of the vehicle. This stored
information can assist technicians in
repairing the vehicle when malfunctions occur. Other information is stored
only in the event of crash, by computer
systems that are commonly called
Event Data Recorders (EDRs).
In a crash event, EDRs such as the
Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) in your vehicle may record
information about the condition of the
vehicle and how it was operated, such
as data related to airbag readiness,
airbag performance, safety belt usage,
and the severity of the collision. These
data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which
crashes and injuries occur and lead to
the designing of safer vehicles. The
SDM in your vehicle does not collect
or store personal information.
In addition, once SUZUKI collects or
receives data, SUZUKI may use the
data for research conducted by
SUZUKI, make the data available for
outside research if need is shown and
confidentiality is assured, or make
summary data which does not identify
specific vehicles available for outside
research.
Others, such as law enforcement personnel, may have access to the special equipment that can read the
information if they have access to the
vehicle or storage device.
To read the stored information, special
equipment is needed and access to
the vehicle or storage device is
required. SUZUKI will not access information about a crash event or share it
with others other than with the consent
of the vehicle owner or lessee, in
response to an official request from
the police or similar government office,
as part of SUZUKI’s defense of litigation through the discovery process, or
as required by law.
10-3
79K21-03E
GENERAL INFORMATION
Reporting Safety Defects
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you
should
immediately
inform
the
National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Suzuki Motor Corp.
To contact American Suzuki, owners
in the continental United States can
call toll-free 1-800-934-0934, or write
to:
American Suzuki Motor Corporation
Automotive Customer Relations
3251 East Imperial Highway
Brea, CA 92821-6795
If NHTSA receives similar complaints,
it may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a
group of vehicles, it may order a recall
and remedy campaign. However,
NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your
dealer, or American Suzuki Motor
Corp.
For owners outside the continental
United States, please refer to the distributor’s address listed in your Warranty Information booklet.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write
to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New
Jersey Ave., SE., Washington, D.C.
20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety
from http://www.safercar.gov.
Suzuki Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
100 East Beaver Creek Road
Richmond Hill, On
L4B 1J6
For vehicles registered for use and
principally operated in Canada please
contact Suzuki Canada Inc. at 1-905889-2677 extension 2254 or write to:
10-4
79K21-03E
GENERAL INFORMATION
MEMO
10-5
79K21-03E
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
64J157
MAIN
FUSE BOX
No.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
COLOR (AMPS)
BLUE (15)
YELLOW (20)
BLUE (15)
YELLOW (20)
CLEAR (25)
BLUE (15)
YELLOW (20)
YELLOW (20)
GREEN (40)
PINK (30)
CPRSR
O2 HTR
THR MOT
AT
RR DEF
HORN
FR FOG
MRR HTR
FR BLW
ABS 2
FUSES
PROTECTED CIRCUIT
A/C compressor fuse
O2 sensor heater fuse
Throttle motor fuse
Automatic transmission fuse
Rear defogger fuse
Horn fuse
Front fog light fuse
Mirror heater fuse
Front blower motor fuse
ABS actuator fuse
11
In engine
compartment
11-1
79K21-03E
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
64J157
MAIN
FUSE BOX
No.
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(19)
(20)
COLOR (AMPS)
RED (50)
YELLOW (20)
–
RED (10)
RED (10)
RED (10)
GREEN (40)
GREEN (40)
BLUE (15)
BLUE (15)
ABS 1
FI
–
H/L L
H/L R
H/L
ST MTR
IGN
H/L LO L
H/L LO R
FUSES
PROTECTED CIRCUIT
ABS actuator fuse
Main fuse
Blank
Head light high beam fuse, left
Head light high beam fuse, right
Head light fuse
Starter motor fuse
Ignition fuse
Head light low beam fuse, left
Head light low beam fuse, right
In engine
compartment
11-2
79K21-03E
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
(J)
(I)
(V) (U) (T)
(H) (G) (F)
(E) (D) (C) (B) (A)
SPARE
SPARE
SPARE SPARE SPARE
SPARE
USE THE DESIGNATED
FUSES AND RELAYS ONLY
(K)
(S) (R) (Q) (P) (O) (N) (M) (L)
(X)
(W)
79K057
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
(G)
(H)
(I)
(J)
(K)
(L)
FUSES IN FUSE BOX
DOME
Dome lamp fuse
STOP
Stop lamp fuse
–
Blank
ACC 3
Accessory socket fuse
CRUISE
Cruise control fuse
Cigar or Accessory socket
BLUE (15)
ACC 2
fuse
YELLOW (20) WIP
Wiper fuse
Ignition signal & Seat
BLUE (15)
IG2 SIG
heater fuse
RED (10)
BACK
Back lamp fuse
RED (10)
ABS/ESP ABS or ESP controller fuse
RED (10)
A/B
Air bag fuse
BLUE (15)
RADIO
Radio fuse
RED (10)
RED (10)
–
BLUE (15)
RED (10)
FUSES IN FUSE BOX
HAZ
Hazard light fuse
ST SIG
Starter signal fuse
ECM
Engine control module fuse
S/R
Sun roof motor fuse
B/U
Buck up fuse
(M)
(N)
(O)
(P)
(Q)
BLUE (15)
BROWN (7.5)
RED (10)
CLEAR (25)
CLEAR (25)
(R)
RED (10)
TAIL
Tail light fuse
(S)
YELLOW (20)
D/L
(T)
BLUE (15)
ACC
(U)
(V)
(W)
(X)
RED (10)
BLUE (15)
–
PINK (30)
METER
IG COIL
–
P/W
Door lock actuator fuse
Radio, Remote door mirror
fuse
Meter fuse
Ignition coil fuse
Blank
Power window fuse
11-3
79K21-03E
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS
MEMO
11-4
79K21-03E
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE:
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
ITEM: Dimensions
Overall length
Overall width
Overall height
Wheelbase
Tread
Minimum running ground clearance
ITEM: Weight
Gross axle weight rating
Gross vehicle weight rating
Vehicle capacity weight
4WD: 4-wheel drive
2WD: 2-wheel drive
M/T: Manual transmission
A/T: Automatic transmission
UNIT: mm (in.)
4WD
2WD
Front
Rear
4WD
2WD
4500 (177.1)
1810 (71.3)
1695 (66.7)
1683 (66.3)
2640 (103.9)
1540 (60.6)
1560 (61.4)
200 (7.9)
188 (7.4)
See the safety certification label and the tire information label which
are located on the driver’s door lock pillar.
12
12-1
79K21-03E
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Engine
Type
Number of cylinders
Bore
Stroke
Piston displacement
Compression ratio
ITEM: Electrical
Ignition timing
Standard spark plug
Battery
Fuses
J24B (16V DOHC)
4
92.0 mm (3.62 in.)
90.0 mm (3.54 in.)
2393 cm3 (146.0 cu.in, 2393 cc)
10.0 : 1
2.4 L
3.2 L
N32A (24V DOHC)
6
89.0 mm (3.50 in.)
85.6 mm (3.37 in.)
3195 cm3 (194.9 cu.in, 3195 cc)
10.0 : 1
5° B.T.D.C.
NGK SILFR6A11
AC DELCO 41-990
12V GP24
See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” and “FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS” sections
12-2
79K21-03E
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Lights
Headlight
Front fog light
Turn signal light
Position light
Brake/tail light
License plate light
Reversing light
High mount stop light
Door illumination light
Dome light
Luggage compartment light
ITEM: Wheel
Tire size, front and rear
Tire pressure
Low beam
High beam
Front
Rear
Spot light
Center light
Rear light
Halogen
WATTAGE
12V 55W
12V 60W
12V 55W
12V 21W
12V 21W
12V 5W
12V 21/5W
12V 5W
12V 21W
12V 5W
12V 5W
12V 8W
12V 10W
12V 10W
12V 5W
BULB No.
H7
HB3
H11
WY21W
WY21W
WY5W
7443
W5W
7440
W5W
–
–
–
–
W5W
P225/70R16, P225/65R17, P225/60R18
For the specified tire pressure, see the Tire Information Label located
on the driver’s door lock pillar.
12-3
79K21-03E
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Steering
Toe-in
Camber angle
Caster angle
ITEM: Capacities (approx.)
Coolant
Fuel tank
Engine oil (replaced with filter)
Transmission oil
Differential gear oil
2.4 L
3.2 L
7.3 L (15.4 US pt)
9.5 L (20.1 US pt)
66 L (17.4 US gal)
4.8 L (10.1 US pt)
6.0 L (12.7 US pt)
1.9 L (4.0 US pt)
2.5 L (5.3 US pt)
3.0 L (6.3 US pt)
0.95 L (2.0 US pt)
1.1 L (2.3 US pt)
0.8 L (1.7 US pt)
0.8 L (1.7 US pt)
1.5 L (3.2 US pt)
1.6 L (3.4 US pt)
0.47 L (1.0 US pt)
2.4 L
3.2 L
Front
2WD
Extension case oil
0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.)
6 ± 2 mm (0.24 ± 0.08 in.)
0° 00’
–1° 15’ ± 40’
2° 30’
2.4 L
3.2 L
M/T
A/T
Rear
Transfer gear box oil
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Front
5M/T, 5A/T
4A/T
4WD
with a transfer switch
without a transfer switch
12-4
79K21-03E
INDEX
INDEX
Symbols
“AIR BAG” Light ..................................................................2-61
“CRUISE” Indicator Light ...................................................2-62
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light ........................................ 2-59, 3-33
“ESP” (Electronic Stability Program) Warning Light .......2-59
“ESP” Warning Light ...........................................................3-33
“SET” Indicator Light ..........................................................2-62
Numerics
4-Speed Automatic Transmission ......................................3-13
5-Speed Automatic Transmission ......................................3-11
A
A/T Selector Position ..........................................................2-68
Accelerator Pedal ................................................................3-8
Accessory Socket ................................................................5-66
Adding Engine Coolant .......................................................7-14
Adjusting Seat Position ......................................................2-19
Adjusting Seatbacks ................................................. 2-19, 2-22
Air Cleaner ...........................................................................7-16
Air Conditioning System .....................................................7-49
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) ..........................................3-29
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light .................2-58
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) .......................................3-32
Armrest .................................................................................5-73
Assist Grips .........................................................................5-70
Audio Systems (type A) ......................................................5-8
Audio Systems (type B) ......................................................5-36
Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System
(Climate Control) .................................................................5-1
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) .................................. 2-28
Automatic Transmission Fluid .......................................... 7-20
Auto-On Headlight System ................................................ 2-77
Average Speed .................................................................... 2-68
B
Basic Operations .......................................................5-11, 5-38
Battery .................................................................................. 7-36
Brake Assist System .......................................................... 3-29
Brake Fluid .......................................................................... 7-22
Brake Pedal ..................................................................3-8, 7-23
Brake System Warning Light ............................................. 2-57
Brakes .................................................................................. 7-22
Braking ................................................................................. 3-28
Break-In ................................................................................ 4-2
Brightness Control ............................................................. 2-66
Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-40
C
Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-2
Changing Engine Oil and Filter ......................................... 7-11
Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-3
Charging Light .................................................................... 2-60
Child Lock System (rear doors) ......................................... 2-3
Child Restraint Systems ..................................................... 2-33
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray ........................................... 5-67 13
Clutch Pedal .................................................................3-8, 7-20
Coat Hooks .......................................................................... 5-70
Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1
Cruise Control ..................................................................... 3-26
13-1
79K21-03E
INDEX
Daily Inspection Checklist ..................................................3-2
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) Indicator Light ...............2-63
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) System ............................2-78
Door Locks ...........................................................................2-1
Drive Belt ..............................................................................7-9
Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light .....................................2-61
Driving Range ......................................................................2-68
Front Seats .......................................................................... 2-18
Fuel Consumption .............................................................. 2-68
Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-62
Fuel Gauge .......................................................................... 2-65
Fuel Pump Labeling ............................................................ 1-1
Fuel Recommendation ....................................................... 1-1
Fuse under the Dash Board ............................................... 7-38
Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS ................................ 11-1
E
G
Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) .................................3-31
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) .................................2-28
Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ...........................10-2
Engine Block Heater ............................................................3-10
Engine Coolant ....................................................................7-13
Engine Coolant Level Check ..............................................7-14
Engine Coolant Replacement .............................................7-15
Engine Hood ........................................................................5-63
Engine Oil and Filter ............................................................7-10
Engine Serial Number .........................................................10-1
Exhaust Gas Warning .........................................................3-1
Gasoline Containing MTBE ................................................ 1-1
Gasoline/Ethanol blends .................................................... 1-1
Gasoline/Methanol blends ................................................. 1-1
Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-17
Gear Oil Level Check .......................................................... 7-19
Gear Oil Replacement ......................................................... 7-19
GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOLOGY ............................... 7-32
Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-71
Cup Holder and Storage Bin ...............................................5-72
D
F
Floor Mats ............................................................................5-74
Fluid Level Check ................................................................7-20
Folding Rear Seats ..............................................................2-24
Frame Hooks ........................................................................5-83
Front Air Bags ......................................................................2-45
Front Fog Light Switch .......................................................2-78
Front Passenger’s Seat Belt Reminder Light ...................2-55
Front Seat Back Pocket ......................................................5-73
Front Seat Heater .................................................................2-21
H
Hazard Warning Switch ...................................................... 2-79
Head Restraints ..........................................................2-20, 2-23
Headlight Aiming ................................................................ 7-39
High Beam Indicator Light ................................................. 2-63
Hill descent control Indicator Light ................................... 2-60
Hill descent control System ............................................... 3-35
Hill hold control System ..................................................... 3-37
HomeLink® .......................................................................... 5-80
Horn ...................................................................................... 2-82
I
Identification Numbers ....................................................... 10-1
If the Engine is Flooded ..................................................... 8-9
13-2
79K21-03E
INDEX
If the Engine Overheats ......................................................8-9
If the Starter Does Not Operate ..........................................8-8
If You Cannot Shift Automatic Transmission Gearshift
Lever Out of “P” (PARK) .....................................................3-15
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck ..................................................4-6
Ignition Key Reminder ........................................................2-1
Ignition Switch .....................................................................3-3
Illumination Indicator Light ................................................2-64
Important Vehicle Design Features To Know ...................4-1
Improving Fuel Economy ....................................................4-3
Information Display .............................................................2-67
Inside Rearview Mirror ........................................................2-17
Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat Belts
(Child Restraint with No Top Strap) ...................................2-35
Installation with the LATCH System ..................................2-38
Installation-Child Restraint with Top Strap .......................2-40
Instrument Cluster ...............................................................2-54
Interior Light Switch ............................................................5-64
Lighting Operation .............................................................. 2-76
Lights “On” reminder ......................................................... 2-78
Listening to a CD .......................................................5-15, 5-42
Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer
(Option) .......................................................................5-28, 5-54
Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option) ..............5-25, 5-51
Listening to Audio for AUX (Option) .............. 5-27, 5-49, 5-53
Listening to the Radio ...............................................5-13, 5-40
Low Fuel Warning Light ..................................................... 2-62
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light .............................2-55, 3-38
Luggage Compartment Cover ........................................... 5-74
Luggage Compartment Light ............................................. 5-65
Luggage Restraint Loops ................................................... 5-78
M
Jacking Instructions ............................................................8-2
Jump Starting Instructions .................................................8-7
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving
Conditions ........................................................................... 7-7
Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2
Malfunction Indicator Light ................................................ 2-61
Manual Transmission ......................................................... 3-11
Master Warning Indicator Light ......................................... 2-64
Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-17
K
N
Keyless Entry System Transmitter (Type B) .....................2-11
Keyless Start System Indicator Light ................................2-63
Keyless Start System Remote Controller (Type A) ..........2-5
Keyless Start System Remote Controller/
Keyless Entry System Transmitter ....................................2-4
Keys ......................................................................................2-1
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) ............................................................................... 10-4
J
L
Lap-Shoulder Belt ................................................................2-28
Lighting Control Lever ........................................................2-75
O
Odometer ............................................................................. 2-70
Off-Road Driving ................................................................. 4-6
Oil Level Check ................................................................... 7-10
Oil Pressure Light ............................................................... 2-60
On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data
Recorders ............................................................................ 10-3
13-3
79K21-03E
INDEX
On-Pavement Driving ..........................................................4-4
Open Door Warning Light ...................................................2-62
Outside Rearview Mirrors ...................................................2-17
Overhead Console Box .......................................................5-71
P
Parking Brake Lever .................................................... 3-7, 7-24
Pedals ...................................................................................3-8
Periodic Maintenance Schedule .........................................7-3
Power Assisted Brakes .......................................................3-29
Power Door Locking System ..............................................2-2
Power Mirror Control ...........................................................2-18
Power Steering ....................................................................7-24
Power Steering Fluid ...........................................................7-24
Power Window Controls .....................................................2-15
R
Radio Antenna .....................................................................5-8
Rear Seats ............................................................................2-22
Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors
Defroster Switch ..................................................................2-82
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch ..................................2-81
Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks ....................................7-12
Remote Audio Controls ............................................ 5-30, 5-56
Replace the Oil Filter ...........................................................7-12
Replacing Tires and/or Wheels ..........................................3-41
Reporting Safety Defects ....................................................10-4
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors ......................................5-78
S
Safety Certification Label ...................................................10-2
Seat Adjustment ........................................................ 2-18, 2-22
Seat Belt Extender ...............................................................2-41
Seat Belt Inspection ............................................................2-33
Seat Belt Pretensioner System .......................................... 2-42
Seat Belt Reminder ............................................................. 2-30
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ........................... 2-26
Selection of Coolant ........................................................... 7-13
Shopping Hook ................................................................... 5-73
Shoulder anchor height adjuster ....................................... 2-32
Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air Bags ......................... 2-46
Side Door Locks .................................................................. 2-1
SLIP Indicator Light ...................................................2-58, 3-32
Snow Tires ..................................................................7-32, 8-6
Spare Tire Nut Lock ............................................................ 8-1
Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-16
SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................ 12-1
Specified Fluid .................................................................... 7-20
Specified Gear Oil ............................................................... 7-17
Specified Oil ........................................................................ 7-10
Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-65
Spot Light ............................................................................ 5-66
Stability Control System .................................................... 3-31
Starting the Engine ............................................................. 3-9
Steering Wheel .................................................................... 7-24
Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-64
Sunroof ................................................................................ 5-68
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ....................... 2-43
T
Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-65
Tailgate ................................................................................ 2-3
Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-66
Theft Deterrent Light .......................................................... 2-15
Thermometer ....................................................................... 2-70
Tilt Steering Lock Lever ..................................................... 2-82
13-4
79K21-03E
INDEX
Tire Chains ...........................................................................4-7
Tire Changing Tool ..............................................................8-1
Tire Inflation Pressure .........................................................7-27
Tire Inspection .....................................................................7-28
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) .........................3-38
Tire Rotation ........................................................................7-31
Tire Sidewall Labeling .........................................................7-25
Tire Size ................................................................................7-26
Tires ......................................................................................7-25
Towing a Disabled Vehicle .................................................8-8
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) .......................6-7
Traction Control System .....................................................3-31
Trailer Towing ......................................................................6-2
Transfer Position Indicator Light .......................................2-64
Trip meter .............................................................................2-70
Troubleshooting ..................................................................5-34,
................................................................................................5-60
Turn Signal Control Lever ..................................................2-78
Turn Signal Indicators .........................................................2-63
Turn Signal Operation .........................................................2-79
W
Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-55
Warning and Indicator Messages ...................................... 2-72
Warranties ........................................................................... 10-2
Washing ............................................................................... 9-4
Waxing ................................................................................. 9-5
Windows .............................................................................. 2-15
Windshield Washer ............................................................. 2-80
Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-49
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ................................ 2-79
Windshield Wipers .............................................................. 2-80
Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-46
U
Underfloor Bins ...................................................................5-77
Uniform Tire Quality Grading .............................................7-30
Using the Transfer Switch ..................................................3-15
Using the Transmission ......................................................3-11
V
Vehicle Cleaning ..................................................................9-3
Vehicle Identification Number ............................................10-1
Vehicle Loading ........................................................... 6-1, 7-33
Vehicle With Keyless Start System ....................................3-4
Vehicle Without Keyless Start System ..............................3-3
13-5
79K21-03E
INDEX
MEMO
13-6
79K21-03E
Prepared by
June, 2009
Part No. 99011-79K21-03E
Printed in Japan
TP334
79K21-03E